1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
173 . ---- It'd be a lot nicer to point to the precise word-location; a chapter
174 . ---- can be pretty big.
177 &<indexterm role="concept">&
178 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
180 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
186 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
187 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
189 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
195 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
199 &<indexterm role="option">&
200 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
202 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
207 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
208 . --- head, or varlist item.
211 &<indexterm role="variable">&
212 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
214 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
220 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
224 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
226 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
227 .cindex "header lines" $1
229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
232 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
233 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
239 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
240 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
244 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
245 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
246 <revhistory><revision>
248 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
249 </revision></revhistory>
252 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
257 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
258 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
259 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
260 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
261 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
263 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
267 <indexterm role="$2">
268 <primary>$3</primary>
270 <secondary>$5</secondary>
272 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
277 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
279 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
282 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
285 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
286 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
287 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
288 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
289 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
290 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
291 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
292 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
293 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
294 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
295 .see concept fallover fallback
296 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
297 .see concept headers "header lines"
298 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
299 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
300 .seealso concept maximum limit
301 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
302 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
303 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
304 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
305 .see concept "process id" pid
306 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
307 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
308 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
309 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
311 .see concept string expansion expansion
312 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
313 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
314 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
317 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
318 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
319 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
320 . chapter "Introduction"
321 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
323 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
324 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
325 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
326 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
328 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
329 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
330 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
331 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
332 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
333 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
334 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
336 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
337 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
338 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
340 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
341 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
342 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
344 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
345 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
346 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
347 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
348 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
350 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
351 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
352 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
353 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
354 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
356 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
357 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
358 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
359 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
363 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
364 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
367 .cindex "documentation"
368 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
369 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
370 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
371 capable of showing a change indicator.
374 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
375 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
376 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
377 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
378 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
379 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
380 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
383 .cindex "books about Exim"
384 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
385 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
386 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
387 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
389 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
390 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
391 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
392 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
394 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
395 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
396 Debian-specific features in the file
397 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
398 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
401 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
402 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
404 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
405 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
406 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
407 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
408 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
410 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
411 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
412 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
413 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
415 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
416 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
418 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
419 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
420 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
424 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
425 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
426 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
427 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
428 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
429 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
430 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
431 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
434 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
435 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
436 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
440 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
443 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
444 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
445 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
449 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
450 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
451 online information is &url(https://wiki.exim.org,the Exim wiki),
452 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
453 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
454 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
455 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
458 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
459 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
460 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
461 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
464 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
465 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
466 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
469 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
470 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
471 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
472 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
473 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
476 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
477 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
478 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
479 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
480 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
483 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
485 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
488 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
489 .cindex "bug reports"
490 .cindex "reporting bugs"
491 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
492 via &url(https://bugs.exim.org,the Bugzilla). However, if you are unsure
493 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
494 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
498 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
500 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
501 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
502 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
503 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
505 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
507 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
508 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
510 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
511 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
512 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
514 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
515 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
516 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
517 here are top-level directories.
519 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
520 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
522 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
523 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
524 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
525 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
529 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
531 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
532 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
533 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
534 most portable to old systems.
536 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
537 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
538 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
539 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
540 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
541 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
542 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
543 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
544 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
545 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
546 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
548 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
549 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
550 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
551 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
553 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
556 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
557 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
559 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
560 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
561 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
563 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
564 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
565 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
566 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
568 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
570 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
573 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
574 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
577 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
579 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
580 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
581 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
582 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
583 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
584 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
585 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
586 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
588 .cindex "domainless addresses"
589 .cindex "address" "without domain"
590 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
591 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
592 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
593 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
596 .cindex "transport" "external"
597 .cindex "external transports"
598 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
599 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
600 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
601 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
602 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
603 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
605 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
606 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
607 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
610 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
611 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
612 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
613 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
614 a number of common scanners are provided.
618 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
619 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
620 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
621 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
622 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
623 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
626 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
627 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
628 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
629 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
630 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
631 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
632 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
633 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
634 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
635 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
636 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
637 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
639 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
640 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
641 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
642 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
646 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
647 .cindex "terminology definitions"
648 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
649 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
650 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
651 below) by a blank line.
653 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
654 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
655 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
656 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
657 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
658 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
659 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
660 rise to further bounce messages.
662 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
663 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
664 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
667 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
668 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
669 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
672 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
673 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
674 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
676 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
677 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
678 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
679 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
680 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
681 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
682 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
683 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
685 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
686 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
687 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
688 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
689 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
690 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
693 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
694 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
695 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from
696 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822), is used to refer to the
697 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
698 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
700 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
701 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
702 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
703 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
704 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
705 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
707 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
708 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
711 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
713 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
714 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
715 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
717 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
718 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
719 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
720 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
721 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
723 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
724 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
725 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
726 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
727 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
728 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
738 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
739 .cindex "incorporated code"
740 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
743 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
746 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
747 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
748 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
749 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
750 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
751 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
753 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
754 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
755 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
756 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
757 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
758 following statements:
761 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
763 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
764 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
765 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
767 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
768 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
769 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
770 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
771 restrictions applied to it).
774 .cindex "SPA authentication"
775 .cindex "Samba project"
776 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
777 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
778 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
779 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
784 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
785 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
786 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
787 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
788 conditions expressed therein.
791 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
793 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
794 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
799 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
801 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
803 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
806 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
807 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
808 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
809 details, please contact
811 Office of Technology Transfer
812 Carnegie Mellon University
814 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
815 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
816 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
819 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
822 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
823 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
825 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
826 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
827 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
828 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
829 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
830 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
831 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
839 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
840 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
841 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
842 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
845 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
846 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
851 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
852 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
853 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
854 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
855 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
856 software without specific, written prior permission.
858 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
859 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
860 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
861 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
862 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
863 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
869 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
870 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
871 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
872 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
877 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
878 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
888 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
889 "Receiving and delivering mail"
892 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
893 .cindex "design philosophy"
894 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
895 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
896 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
897 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
898 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
899 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
902 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
903 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
904 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
905 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
906 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
907 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
908 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
911 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
912 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
913 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
914 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
915 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
916 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
917 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
918 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
919 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
922 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
923 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
925 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
926 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
927 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
928 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
930 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
931 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
932 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
933 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
934 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
936 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
937 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
938 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
940 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
941 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
942 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
948 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
949 .cindex "Sieve filter"
950 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
951 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
952 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
953 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
954 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
955 of filtering are available:
958 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
959 by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
961 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
962 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
965 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
970 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
971 .cindex "format" "of message id"
972 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
978 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
979 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
980 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
981 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
982 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
983 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
984 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
985 not always case-sensitive.
987 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
988 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
989 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
990 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
991 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
992 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
997 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
998 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
999 way of representing the date and time of day).
1001 After the first hyphen, the next
1003 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1005 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1007 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1008 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1009 time of reception, normally in units of
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1017 500000 (250000) and added to
1018 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1028 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1029 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1033 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1034 .cindex "receiving mail"
1035 .cindex "message" "reception"
1036 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1037 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1038 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1039 there are several possibilities:
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1043 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1044 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1046 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1047 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1048 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1049 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1050 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1051 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1053 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1054 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1055 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1056 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1057 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1059 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1060 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1061 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1062 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1066 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1067 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1068 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1069 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1070 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1071 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1072 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1073 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1074 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1075 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1076 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1077 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1078 users to change sender addresses.
1080 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1081 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1082 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1083 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1084 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1085 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1086 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1088 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1089 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1090 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1091 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1092 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1093 message is received.
1099 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1100 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1101 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1102 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1103 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1104 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1105 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1106 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1108 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1109 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1110 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1111 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1112 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1113 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1114 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1115 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1116 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1117 affect file system performance.
1119 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1120 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1121 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1122 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1123 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1125 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1126 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1127 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1128 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1129 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1130 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1131 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1132 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1133 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1134 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1135 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1136 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1140 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1141 .cindex "message" "life of"
1142 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1143 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1144 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1145 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1146 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1147 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1148 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1150 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1151 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1152 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1153 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1154 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1157 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1158 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1159 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1160 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1161 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1163 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1164 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1165 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1166 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1167 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1168 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1169 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1170 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1171 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1172 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1175 .cindex "journal file"
1176 .cindex "file" "journal"
1177 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1178 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1179 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1180 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1181 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1182 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1183 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1184 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1186 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1187 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1188 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1189 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1190 deliveries caused by crashes.
1194 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1195 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1196 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1197 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1198 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1199 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1200 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1201 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1202 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1204 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1205 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1206 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1207 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1208 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1209 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1210 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1211 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1212 the driver's features in general.
1214 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1215 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1216 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1217 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1220 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1221 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1222 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1223 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1224 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1225 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1227 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1228 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1229 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1230 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1231 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1232 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1234 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1235 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1236 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1239 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1240 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1241 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1242 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1243 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1244 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1245 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1246 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1247 configured to fail the address.
1249 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1250 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1251 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1252 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1253 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1254 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1256 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1257 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1258 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1259 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1260 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1261 the address is bounced.
1265 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1266 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1267 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1268 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1269 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1270 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1271 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1272 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1274 .cindex router "verify mode"
1275 .cindex "verify mode" routers
1276 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1277 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1278 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1279 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1280 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1281 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1282 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1283 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1288 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1289 .cindex "router" "running details"
1290 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1291 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1292 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1293 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1294 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1295 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1299 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1300 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1301 original address ceases
1302 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1303 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1304 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1305 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1306 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1309 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1310 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1311 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1312 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1313 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1315 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1316 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1317 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1318 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1319 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1321 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1322 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1323 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1324 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1325 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1327 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1328 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1329 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1331 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1332 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1333 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1334 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1336 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1337 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1340 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1341 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1342 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1343 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1344 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1346 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1347 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1348 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1349 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1350 facility for this purpose.
1353 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1354 .cindex "case of local parts"
1355 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1356 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1357 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1358 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1359 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1360 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1361 routed addresses are shown.
1365 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1366 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1367 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1368 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1369 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1370 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1373 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1374 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1375 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1376 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1377 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1378 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1379 of any other conditions.
1381 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1382 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1383 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1385 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1386 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1387 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1388 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1389 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1391 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1392 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1393 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1394 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1395 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1397 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1398 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1399 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1401 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1402 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1405 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1406 of domains that it defines.
1407 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1408 .cindex de-tainting "using router domains option"
1409 .cindex de-tainting &$domains$&
1410 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1411 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1412 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1413 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1414 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1416 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1417 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1420 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1421 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1422 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1423 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1424 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1425 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1426 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1427 the set of local parts that it defines.
1428 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1429 .cindex de-tainting &$local_parts$&
1430 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1431 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1432 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1433 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1435 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1436 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1438 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1439 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1440 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1441 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1442 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1443 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1444 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1447 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1448 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1450 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1451 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1452 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1453 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1454 remaining preconditions.
1457 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1458 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1459 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1460 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1461 could lead to confusion.
1464 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1465 set of addresses that it defines.
1468 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1469 specified files is tested.
1472 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1473 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1474 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1475 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1477 Note that while using
1478 this option for address matching technically works,
1479 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1480 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1481 for transport options.
1482 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1483 convenient way to obtain them.
1487 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1488 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1489 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1490 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1491 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1492 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1493 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1497 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1498 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1499 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1502 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1503 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1504 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1505 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1506 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1508 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1509 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1511 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1512 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1513 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1514 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1515 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1516 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1519 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1520 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1521 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1522 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1523 processed entirely independently of each other.
1525 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1526 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1527 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1528 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1529 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1530 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1531 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1532 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1533 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1535 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1536 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1537 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1538 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1539 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1540 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1541 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1542 addresses to the same domain.
1544 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1545 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1546 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1547 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1548 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1549 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1550 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1551 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1553 .cindex "queue runner"
1554 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1555 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1556 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1557 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1558 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1559 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1560 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1561 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1562 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1564 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1565 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1566 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1567 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1568 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1569 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1571 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1572 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1573 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1574 messages to other addresses.
1576 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1577 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1578 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1581 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1582 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1583 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1589 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1590 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1591 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1592 .cindex "queue runner"
1593 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1594 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1595 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1596 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1597 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1598 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1599 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1600 passed its retry time.
1601 You can run several queue runners at once.
1603 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1604 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1605 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1606 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1607 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1612 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1613 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1614 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1615 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1616 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1617 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1618 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1619 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1620 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1623 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1624 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1625 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1627 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1628 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1629 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1630 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1631 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1636 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1637 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1638 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1639 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1640 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1641 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1642 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1643 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1644 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1645 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1646 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1648 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1649 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1650 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1653 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1654 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1655 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1656 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1657 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1658 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1659 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1664 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1665 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1666 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1667 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1668 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1669 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1670 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1671 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1680 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1681 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1683 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1684 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1685 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1686 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1689 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1690 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1692 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1693 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1694 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1695 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1699 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1700 following subdirectories are created:
1703 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1704 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1705 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1706 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1707 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1708 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1709 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1712 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1713 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1714 that may be useful to some sites.
1717 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1718 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1719 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1720 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1721 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1722 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1724 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1725 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1726 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1727 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1728 overridden if necessary.
1729 .cindex compiler requirements
1730 .cindex compiler version
1731 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1734 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1735 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1736 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1737 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1738 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1739 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1740 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1741 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1742 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1743 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1744 If your operating system has no
1745 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1746 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1747 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1749 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1750 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1751 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1752 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1753 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1754 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1755 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1757 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1758 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1759 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1760 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1761 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1762 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1763 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1764 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1766 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1767 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1768 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1769 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1770 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1771 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1772 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1773 Berkeley DB library.
1776 Ownership of the Berkeley DB library has moved to a major corporation;
1777 development seems to have stalled and documentation is not freely available.
1778 This is probably not tenable for the long term use by Exim.
1781 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1782 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1786 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1787 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1789 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1790 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1791 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1792 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1793 filename is used unmodified.
1795 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1796 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1797 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1798 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1800 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1801 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1802 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1804 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1805 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1806 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1807 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1808 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1809 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1810 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1811 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1812 page with far newer versions listed.
1813 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1814 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1815 suited to Exim's usage model.
1817 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1818 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1819 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1820 operates on a single file.
1822 It is possible to use &url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html,sqlite3)
1823 for the DBM library.
1827 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1828 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1829 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1830 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1831 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1835 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1836 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1837 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1838 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1840 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1841 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1842 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1843 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1844 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1845 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1847 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1848 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1849 in one of these lines:
1854 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1856 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1857 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1858 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1859 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1860 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1863 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1864 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1866 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1867 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1870 When moving from one DBM library to another,
1871 for the hints databases it suffices to just remove all the files in the
1872 directory named &"db/"& under the spool directory.
1873 This is because hints are only for optimisation and will be rebuilt
1874 during normal operations.
1875 Non-hints DBM databases (used by &"dbm"& lookups in the configuration)
1876 will need individual rebuilds for the new DBM library.
1877 This is not done automatically
1882 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1883 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1884 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1885 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1886 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1887 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1888 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1889 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1890 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1891 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1892 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1893 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1895 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1896 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1897 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1898 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1899 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1900 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1902 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1903 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1904 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1905 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1906 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1907 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1910 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1911 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1912 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1913 facilities, you need to set
1915 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1917 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1918 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1921 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1922 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1923 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1924 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1925 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1926 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1927 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1929 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1930 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1931 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1932 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1933 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1938 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1939 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1941 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1942 described in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
1943 This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1944 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1945 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1946 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1947 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1948 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1950 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1951 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1952 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1953 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1954 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1958 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1962 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1963 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1964 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1965 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1966 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1967 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1968 command as per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 2487).
1969 It can also support clients that expect to
1970 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1971 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1974 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1975 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1978 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1982 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1984 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1987 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1989 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1990 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1993 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1994 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1996 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1997 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2000 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
2002 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
2003 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
2006 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2008 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
2009 library and include files. For example:
2012 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2013 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2015 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
2016 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2019 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2022 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2023 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2024 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2029 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2031 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2032 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2033 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2034 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2035 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2036 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2037 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2038 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2039 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2040 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2041 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2042 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2045 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2046 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2047 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2049 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2050 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2052 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2054 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2055 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2056 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2057 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2058 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2059 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2063 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2064 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2065 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2066 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2067 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2068 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2071 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2072 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2073 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2074 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2075 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2077 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2082 .section "Dynamically loaded module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2083 .cindex "lookup modules"
2084 .cindex "router modules"
2085 .cindex "transport modules"
2086 .cindex "authenticator modules"
2087 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2088 .cindex ".so building"
2089 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2090 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2092 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2093 library dependencies without requiring all systems to install all of those
2096 Any combination of lookup types can be built this way.
2097 Lookup types that provide several variants will be loaded as
2099 Types that provide only one method are not loaded until used by
2100 the runtime configuration.
2104 set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2105 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2106 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2107 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2108 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2109 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2111 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2112 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2113 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2114 only if each is installed:
2120 Set also &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>&` INCLUDE`& and
2121 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>`_LIBS if needed for each lookup type,
2122 ensuring that duplicates are not present in more global values.
2125 Similarly, authenticator, router and transport drivers can be built
2126 as external modules.
2127 Modules will be searched for as demanded by the runtime configuration,
2128 permitting a smaller Exim binary.
2130 For building, as above but using
2131 &`AUTH_*`&, &`ROUTER_*`& and &`TRANSPORT_*`& instead of &`LOOKUP_*`&,
2135 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2136 .cindex "build directory"
2137 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2138 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2139 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2140 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2141 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2142 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2143 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2145 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2146 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2147 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2148 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2149 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2150 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2151 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2152 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2154 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2155 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2156 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2160 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2161 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2162 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2163 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2164 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2165 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2166 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2170 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2171 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2172 given in addition to the short output.
2176 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2177 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2178 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2179 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2180 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2181 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2182 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2185 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2186 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2188 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2189 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2190 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2191 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2193 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2194 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2195 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2196 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2197 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2198 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2199 and are often not needed.
2201 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2202 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2203 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2204 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2205 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2206 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2207 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2208 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2209 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2212 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2213 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2214 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2215 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2219 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2220 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2221 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2222 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2223 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2224 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2225 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2226 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2227 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2228 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2229 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2230 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2231 containing the lines
2236 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2237 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2239 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2240 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2241 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2244 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2245 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2246 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2247 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2248 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2249 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2250 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2251 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2252 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2253 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2259 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2260 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2261 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2262 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2263 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2264 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2265 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2266 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2269 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2270 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2271 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2272 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2273 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2274 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2275 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2276 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2277 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2278 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2279 syntax. For instance:
2282 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2284 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2285 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2286 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2289 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2290 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2291 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2295 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2296 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2298 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2299 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2300 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2301 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2302 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2303 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2306 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2307 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2309 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2310 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2313 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2314 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2316 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2317 definition of all three of these variables into your
2318 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2321 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2322 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2323 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2324 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2326 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2327 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2328 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2329 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2330 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2333 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2334 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2335 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2336 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2337 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2340 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2342 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2343 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2344 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2345 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2346 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2347 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2351 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2352 .cindex "building Eximon"
2353 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2354 where the files that are involved are
2356 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2357 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2358 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2359 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2360 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2361 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2363 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2364 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2365 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2366 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2367 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2368 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2369 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2373 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2374 .cindex "installing Exim"
2375 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2376 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2377 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2378 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2379 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2380 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2381 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2382 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2383 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2384 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2385 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2386 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2388 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2389 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2390 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2391 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2392 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2393 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2394 alternative files, no default is installed.
2396 .cindex "system aliases file"
2397 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2398 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2399 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2400 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2401 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2402 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2403 and outputs a comment to the user.
2405 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2406 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2407 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2408 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2409 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2411 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2412 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2413 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2414 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2415 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2418 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2419 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2422 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2424 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2425 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2426 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2427 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2428 but this usage is deprecated.
2430 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2431 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2432 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2433 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2434 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2435 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2437 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2438 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2439 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2440 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2441 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2442 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2443 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2445 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2446 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2447 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2450 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2452 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2453 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2454 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2455 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2458 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2460 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2461 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2464 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2465 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2467 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2471 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2473 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2475 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2476 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2477 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2479 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2484 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2485 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2486 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2487 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2488 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2491 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2492 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2493 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2497 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2498 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2499 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2500 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2501 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2507 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2508 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2509 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2510 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2511 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2515 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2516 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2517 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2518 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2519 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2522 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2524 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2526 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2528 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2529 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2530 user agent. For example:
2532 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2533 From: user@your.domain.example
2534 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2535 Subject: Testing Exim
2537 This is a test message.
2540 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2541 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2542 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2544 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2545 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2546 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2547 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2548 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2549 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2551 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2553 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2554 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2555 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2556 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2557 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2559 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2560 .cindex "lock files"
2561 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2562 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2563 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2564 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2565 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2566 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2567 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2568 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2569 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2570 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2571 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2572 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2574 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2575 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2576 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2577 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2578 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2581 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2582 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2583 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2584 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2588 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2589 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2590 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2591 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2592 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2593 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2594 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2595 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2596 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2597 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2598 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2599 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2600 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2602 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2603 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2604 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2605 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2606 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2607 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2610 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2611 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2612 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2613 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2615 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2616 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2617 favourite user agent.
2619 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2620 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2621 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2622 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2623 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2624 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2628 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2629 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2633 This starts a daemon which
2635 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2638 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2639 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2641 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2642 they will run in parallel.
2643 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2644 defined in the configuration.
2647 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2648 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2649 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2650 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2651 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2652 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2653 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2654 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2655 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2656 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2662 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2663 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2664 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2666 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2668 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2669 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2670 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2671 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2672 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2674 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2676 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2678 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2679 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2680 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2688 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2689 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2690 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2691 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2692 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2693 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2694 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2695 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2696 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2699 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2701 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2702 were present before any other options.
2703 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2705 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2706 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2707 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2710 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2711 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2712 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2716 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2717 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2718 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2721 .cindex "queue runner"
2722 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2723 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2724 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2726 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2727 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2728 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2729 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2730 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2731 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2732 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2733 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2736 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2737 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2738 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2739 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2740 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2741 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2744 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2745 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2746 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2747 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2748 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2749 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2751 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2752 .cindex "envelope from"
2753 .cindex "envelope sender"
2754 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2755 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2756 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2757 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2758 users to set envelope senders.
2762 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2763 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2764 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2766 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2767 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2768 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2769 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2770 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2771 that are available to trusted users.
2773 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2774 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2775 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2776 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2777 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2779 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2780 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2781 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2782 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2784 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2785 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2786 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2787 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2789 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2790 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2795 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2796 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2797 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2803 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2804 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2805 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2806 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2807 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2808 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2809 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2810 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2813 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2814 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2815 . creates a man page for the options.
2816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2819 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2825 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2826 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2827 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2828 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2831 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2832 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2836 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2843 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2847 .cmdopt -atrn <&'host'&> <&'domainlist'&>
2848 This option requests an ODMR customer connection.
2849 See &<<SECTODMRCUST>>& for details.
2852 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2854 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2855 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2856 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2857 clean; it ignores this option.
2861 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2862 .cindex "queue runner"
2863 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2864 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2865 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2867 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2868 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2869 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2870 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2872 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2873 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2874 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2875 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2877 When a listening daemon
2878 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2879 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2880 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2881 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2882 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2883 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2886 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2887 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2888 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2892 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2893 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2894 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2895 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2896 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2897 .cindex reload configuration
2898 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2899 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2900 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2901 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2902 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2903 because these are reread each time they are used.
2905 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2906 to cleanly shut down.
2907 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2908 or for scanning the queue,
2909 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2912 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2913 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2916 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2917 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2918 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2919 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2920 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2921 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2923 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2924 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2925 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2926 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2927 test data. A line history is supported.
2929 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2930 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2931 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2932 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2933 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2934 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2935 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2937 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2938 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2939 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2940 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2942 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2943 defined and macros will be expanded.
2944 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2945 available to admin users.
2947 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2948 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2949 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2950 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2951 the value is marked as tainted.
2952 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2954 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2955 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2956 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2957 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2958 of a file. For example:
2960 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2962 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2963 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2964 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2965 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2966 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2967 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2968 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2971 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2972 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2973 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2974 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2975 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2976 system filters are recognized.
2978 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2979 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2980 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2981 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2982 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2983 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2984 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2985 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2986 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2989 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2990 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2991 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2993 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2995 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2996 variables that are used by the user filter.
2998 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
3003 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
3004 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
3005 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
3008 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
3009 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
3010 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
3011 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
3013 When testing a filter file,
3014 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3015 .cindex "envelope from"
3016 .cindex "envelope sender"
3017 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
3018 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
3019 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
3020 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
3021 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
3024 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
3025 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
3026 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3027 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
3030 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
3031 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3032 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
3033 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
3034 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
3035 actually being delivered.
3037 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
3038 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3039 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3040 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3043 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
3044 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3045 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3046 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3049 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
3050 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
3051 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
3052 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
3053 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
3054 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
3055 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3056 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3057 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3058 after a full stop. For example:
3060 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3061 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3063 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3064 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3065 conversion to the canonical form is
3066 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3068 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3069 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3070 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3071 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3072 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3076 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident
3077 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 1413))
3078 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3079 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3082 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3083 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3084 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3086 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3087 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3088 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3089 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3090 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3091 session were authenticated.
3093 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3094 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3095 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3097 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3098 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3099 specialized SMTP test program such as
3100 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks,swaks).
3102 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3103 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3104 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3105 updating the callout cache database.
3108 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3109 .cindex "building alias file"
3110 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3111 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3112 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3113 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3114 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3117 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3118 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3119 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3120 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3121 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3122 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3125 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3127 .cindex "querying exim information"
3128 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3129 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3130 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3131 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3132 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3135 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3136 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3137 recognised DSCP names.
3140 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3141 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3142 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3143 useful for ManageSieve
3144 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc5804.html,RFC 5804))
3145 implementations, in providing that protocol's
3146 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3147 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3148 way to guarantee a correct response.
3151 .cindex "local message reception"
3152 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3153 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3154 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3155 argument can be a comma-separated list of
3156 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) addresses.
3158 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3159 if no other conflicting option is present.
3161 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3162 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3163 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3164 suppressing this for special cases.
3166 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3167 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3169 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3170 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3171 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3174 .cindex "message" "format"
3175 .cindex "format" "message"
3176 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3177 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3178 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3179 of the message must be as defined in
3180 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
3182 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3184 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3185 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3187 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3188 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3189 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3190 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3191 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3193 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3194 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3195 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3196 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3197 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3199 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3200 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3201 .cindex "malware scan test"
3202 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3203 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3204 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3205 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3206 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3207 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3208 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3210 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3211 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3212 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3213 This option requires admin privileges.
3215 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3216 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3217 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3220 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3221 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3222 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3223 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3224 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3225 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3226 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3228 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3229 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3230 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3231 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3232 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3234 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3235 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3236 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3237 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3241 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3242 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3243 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3244 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3245 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3246 arguments, for example:
3248 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3250 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3251 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3252 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3253 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3254 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3255 users, the output is as in this example:
3257 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3259 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3260 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3262 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3263 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3264 backward compatibility.)
3265 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3266 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3268 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3269 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3270 name will not be output.
3272 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3273 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3274 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3275 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3276 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3277 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3278 written directly into the spool directory.
3280 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3282 exim -bP +local_domains
3284 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3285 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3287 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3288 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3289 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3290 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3291 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3292 that driver are output. For example:
3294 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3296 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3297 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3298 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3299 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3300 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3303 .cindex "environment"
3304 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3305 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3308 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3309 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3310 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3311 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3312 The output format is one item per line.
3313 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3314 the exit status will be nonzero.
3317 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3318 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3319 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3320 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3321 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3322 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3323 to allow any user to see the queue.
3325 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3327 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3328 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3331 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3332 .cindex "size" "of message"
3333 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3334 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3335 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3336 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3337 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3338 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3339 before the sender address.
3341 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3342 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3343 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3345 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3346 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3347 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3348 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3349 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3354 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3355 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3356 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3361 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3362 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3363 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3364 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3368 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3369 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3374 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3375 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3376 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3377 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3380 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3383 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3386 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3390 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3391 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3392 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3393 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3397 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3398 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3399 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3400 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3401 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3403 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3404 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3406 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3407 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3408 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3409 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3410 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3411 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3412 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3413 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3414 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3416 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3417 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3421 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3422 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3423 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3424 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3425 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3426 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3427 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3430 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3431 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3432 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3433 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3434 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3435 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3436 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3437 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3438 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3440 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3441 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3442 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3444 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3445 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3446 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3447 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3449 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3450 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, ATRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3451 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3453 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3454 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3455 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3456 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3457 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3459 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3460 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3463 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3464 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3465 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3466 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3467 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3468 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3469 messages to the MTA.
3472 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3473 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3474 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3475 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3476 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3477 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3478 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3482 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3483 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3484 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3485 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3486 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3487 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3488 the listening daemon.
3491 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3492 .cindex "address" "testing"
3493 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3494 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3495 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3496 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3497 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3499 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3500 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3502 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3503 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3506 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3507 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3508 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3509 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3510 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3513 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3514 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3515 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3516 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3518 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3519 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3520 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3521 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3524 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3525 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3527 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3528 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3529 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3530 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3531 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3532 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3536 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3537 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3538 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3539 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3540 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3541 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3543 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3544 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3545 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3546 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3547 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3548 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3549 dynamic testing facilities.
3552 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3553 .cindex "address" "verification"
3554 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3555 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3556 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3557 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3558 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3559 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3561 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3562 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3563 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3565 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3566 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3568 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3569 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3572 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3573 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3574 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3575 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3576 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3578 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3579 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3580 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3581 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3582 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3583 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3586 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3587 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3588 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3591 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3592 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3593 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3594 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3596 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3597 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3598 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3599 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3602 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3603 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3609 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3610 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3611 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3612 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3614 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3615 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3616 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3617 each port only when the first connection is received.
3619 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3620 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3622 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3623 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3624 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3625 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3626 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3627 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3628 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3629 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3630 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3631 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3633 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3634 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3635 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3636 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3637 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3638 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3639 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3640 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3641 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3643 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3644 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3645 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3646 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3647 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3648 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3649 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3651 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3652 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3653 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3654 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3655 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3656 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3657 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3659 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3660 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3661 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3664 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3665 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3666 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3667 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3668 specified by this option.
3671 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3673 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3674 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3675 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3676 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3677 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3678 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3680 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3681 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3682 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3683 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3684 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3685 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3686 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3688 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3689 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3690 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3696 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3697 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3700 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3702 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3703 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3706 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3708 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3709 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3710 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3711 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3712 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3713 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3714 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3717 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3718 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3719 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3720 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3721 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3722 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3723 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3725 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3726 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3727 .irow auth "authenticators"
3728 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3729 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3730 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3731 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3732 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3733 .irow filter "filter handling"
3734 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3735 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3736 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3737 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3738 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3739 .irow load "system load checks"
3740 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3741 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3742 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3743 .irow memory "memory handling"
3744 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3745 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3746 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3747 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3748 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3749 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3750 .irow retry "retry handling"
3751 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3752 .irow route "address routing"
3753 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3754 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3755 .irow transport "transports"
3756 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3757 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3758 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3760 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3761 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3762 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3763 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3764 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3765 turn everything off.
3767 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3768 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3769 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3770 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3771 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3774 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3775 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3776 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3777 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3778 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3781 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3782 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3785 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3786 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3787 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3788 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3789 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3790 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3792 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3793 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3795 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3797 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3798 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3799 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3800 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3803 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3804 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3805 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3808 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3809 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3810 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3811 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3812 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3813 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3814 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3815 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3818 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3819 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3820 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3821 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3822 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3824 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3825 .cindex "sender" "name"
3826 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3827 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3828 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3829 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3830 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3831 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3833 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3834 .cindex "sender" "address"
3835 .cindex "address" "sender"
3836 .cindex "trusted users"
3837 .cindex "envelope from"
3838 .cindex "envelope sender"
3839 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3840 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3841 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3842 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3845 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3846 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3847 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3848 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3851 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3852 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3853 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3854 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3855 examples of shell commands:
3857 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3858 exim -f "" user@domain
3860 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3861 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3864 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3865 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3866 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3867 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3870 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3871 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3872 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3873 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3874 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3875 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3878 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3879 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3881 control = suppress_local_fixups
3883 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3884 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3887 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3890 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3891 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3892 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3893 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3897 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3898 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3899 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3900 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3901 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3902 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3903 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3904 by its &'mailx'& command.
3906 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3907 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3908 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3909 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3910 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3911 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3912 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3914 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3916 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3918 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3919 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3920 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3921 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3922 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3923 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3926 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3927 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3928 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3929 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3930 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3931 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3933 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3934 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3935 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3936 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3938 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3939 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3940 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3941 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3942 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3943 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3944 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3945 can be used only by an admin user.
3947 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3949 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3950 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3952 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3953 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3954 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3955 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3956 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3957 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3958 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3959 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3962 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3963 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3964 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3967 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3968 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3969 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3972 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3973 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3974 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3976 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3977 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3978 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3979 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3982 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3983 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3984 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3987 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3988 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3989 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3991 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3994 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3995 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3996 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3999 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4000 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
4001 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
4002 the following four arguments.
4004 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
4005 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4006 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
4007 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
4008 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
4009 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
4010 messages through the same SMTP connection.
4012 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
4013 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4014 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
4017 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4018 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4019 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
4023 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4024 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4025 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
4027 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
4031 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4032 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
4033 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
4034 The argument gives the SNI string.
4035 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
4037 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
4038 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4039 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4040 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
4041 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
4043 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4044 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4045 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4046 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4047 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4048 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4049 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4050 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4051 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4052 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4053 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4054 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4055 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4056 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4058 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4059 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4060 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4061 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4062 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4063 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4064 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4065 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4066 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4068 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4069 .cindex "freezing messages"
4070 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4071 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4072 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4073 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4074 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4075 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4078 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4079 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4080 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4081 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4082 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4083 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4084 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4085 is sent to the sender.
4086 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4089 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4091 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4092 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4093 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4094 queue to the given named queue.
4095 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4096 string to define the default queue.
4097 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4098 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4100 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4101 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4102 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4103 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4104 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4105 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4107 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4108 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4109 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4110 .cindex "removing recipients"
4111 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4112 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4113 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4114 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4115 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4116 can be used only by an admin user.
4118 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4119 .cindex "removing messages"
4120 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4121 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4122 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4123 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4124 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4125 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4126 placed in the queue.
4131 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4132 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4133 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4137 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4138 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4139 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4140 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4141 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4142 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4143 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4144 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4145 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4146 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4148 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4149 .cindex "thawing messages"
4150 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4151 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4152 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4153 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4154 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4155 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4158 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4159 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4160 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4161 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4162 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4164 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4165 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4166 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4167 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4168 be written to the standard output in
4169 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4170 format. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4172 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4173 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4174 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4175 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4176 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4177 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4179 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4180 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4181 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4182 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4183 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4186 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4187 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4188 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4191 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4192 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4193 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4194 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4195 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4196 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4197 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4200 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4201 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4202 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4203 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4204 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4205 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4206 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4210 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4211 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4212 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4213 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4215 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4216 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4219 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4220 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4221 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4222 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4226 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4227 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4228 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4229 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4230 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4231 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4234 .cindex "background delivery"
4235 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4236 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4237 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4238 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4239 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4240 processes to finish.
4242 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4243 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4244 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4245 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4247 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4248 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4249 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4250 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4253 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4254 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4255 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4256 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4257 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4258 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4260 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4261 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4264 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4265 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4267 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4268 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4269 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4270 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4274 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4278 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4279 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4280 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4281 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4282 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4283 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4284 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4285 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4286 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4287 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4291 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4292 .cindex "first pass routing"
4293 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4294 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4295 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4296 configuration file is in effect.
4298 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4299 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4300 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4301 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4302 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4303 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4304 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4305 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4306 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4310 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4311 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4312 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4315 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4317 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4318 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4319 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4320 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4323 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4324 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4325 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4326 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4327 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4330 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4331 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4332 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4333 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4334 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4337 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4338 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4342 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4343 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4347 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4348 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4349 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4350 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4351 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4352 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4355 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4357 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4358 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4359 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4360 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4361 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4362 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4363 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4365 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4366 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4368 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4370 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4371 followed by a colon and the port number:
4373 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4375 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4376 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4377 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4378 whichever one is last.
4380 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4381 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4382 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4383 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4384 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4385 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4386 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4388 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4389 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4390 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4391 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4392 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4393 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4394 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4396 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4397 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4398 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4399 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4400 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4401 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4402 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4403 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4404 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4406 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4407 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4408 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4409 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4410 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4411 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4413 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4414 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4415 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4416 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4417 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4418 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4419 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4420 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4422 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4423 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4424 is sending the bounce.
4426 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4427 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4428 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4429 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4430 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4431 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4432 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4433 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4434 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4435 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4436 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4438 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4439 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4440 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4441 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4442 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4443 uses the name it is given.
4445 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4446 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4447 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4448 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4449 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4450 used, when there is no default.
4453 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4454 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4455 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4456 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4459 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4460 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4461 whatever that means.
4463 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4464 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4465 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4466 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4467 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4468 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4469 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4470 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4473 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4474 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4475 This option is not intended for general use.
4476 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4477 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4478 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4480 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4481 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4482 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4483 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4484 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4485 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4487 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4488 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4489 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4490 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4491 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4492 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4493 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4496 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4498 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4499 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4500 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4501 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4502 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4503 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4504 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4505 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4506 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4509 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4510 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4512 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4514 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4515 option is also present.
4516 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4517 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4519 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4521 The socket is currently used for
4523 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4525 caching compiled regexes
4527 obtaining a current queue size
4531 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4532 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4533 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4534 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4538 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4539 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4540 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4541 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4544 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4546 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4548 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4550 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4551 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4552 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4553 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4554 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4555 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4558 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4559 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4560 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4561 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4562 and &%-S%& options).
4564 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4565 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4566 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4567 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4568 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4569 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4570 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4573 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4574 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4575 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4576 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4577 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4580 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4581 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4582 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4583 this to be repeated periodically.
4585 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4586 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4587 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4588 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4590 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4591 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4592 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4594 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4595 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4596 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4597 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4601 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4602 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4603 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4604 .cindex "first pass routing"
4605 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4606 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4607 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4608 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4611 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4613 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4614 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4615 then in the first phase of the run,
4616 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4617 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4619 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4620 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4621 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4623 After the first queue scan complete,
4624 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4626 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4627 delivered down a single SMTP
4628 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4629 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4630 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4631 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4633 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4634 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4635 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4638 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4640 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4641 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4642 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4643 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4644 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4646 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4648 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4649 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4650 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4651 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4652 their retry times are tried.
4654 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4656 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4657 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4660 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4662 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4663 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4664 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4667 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4670 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4671 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4672 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4673 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4674 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4675 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4676 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4678 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4679 will specify a queue to operate on.
4682 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4684 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4687 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4688 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4689 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4690 starting message id. For example:
4692 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4694 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4695 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4696 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4698 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4700 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4701 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4702 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4703 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4704 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4705 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4707 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4708 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4709 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4710 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4711 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4712 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4713 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4714 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4715 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4717 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4719 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4720 process every 30 minutes.
4722 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4723 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4726 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4729 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4730 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4732 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4734 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4737 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4739 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4741 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4743 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4744 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4745 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4746 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4747 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4748 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4749 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4751 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4752 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4753 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4754 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4755 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4756 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4758 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4759 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4761 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4763 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4764 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4765 applied to each queue run.
4767 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4768 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4769 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4770 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4771 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4772 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4773 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4774 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4775 address will be skipped.
4777 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4778 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4779 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4782 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4783 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4784 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4785 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4786 an arbitrary command instead.
4789 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4791 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4793 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4794 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4795 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4796 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4797 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4798 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4800 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4801 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4802 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4803 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4806 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4810 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4811 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4812 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4813 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4814 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4816 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4817 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4818 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4819 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4820 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4821 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4822 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4823 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4824 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4825 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4826 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4828 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4829 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4830 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4831 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4832 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4833 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4835 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4836 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4837 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4838 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4839 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4840 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4841 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4842 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4843 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4844 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4847 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4848 compatibility with Sendmail.
4850 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4851 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4852 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4853 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4854 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4856 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4860 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4861 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4862 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4863 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4864 set. Exim ignores this option.
4867 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4868 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4869 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4870 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4871 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4872 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4876 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4877 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4878 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4881 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4882 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4883 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4885 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4886 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4887 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4888 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4897 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4898 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4899 . creates a man page for the options.
4900 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4903 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4910 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4914 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4915 "The runtime configuration file"
4917 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4918 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4919 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4920 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4921 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4922 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4923 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4924 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4925 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4928 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4929 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4930 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4931 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4932 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4933 actually alter the string.
4935 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4936 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4937 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4938 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4939 existing file in the list.
4942 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4943 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4944 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4945 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4946 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4947 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4948 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4949 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4950 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4951 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4953 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4954 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4955 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4956 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4957 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4959 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4960 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4961 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4962 compromise the Exim user account.
4964 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4965 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4966 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4967 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4968 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4969 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4974 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4975 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4976 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4977 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4978 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4979 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4980 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4981 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4982 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4983 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4984 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4986 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4987 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4988 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4989 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4990 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4991 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4992 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4993 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4994 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4997 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4998 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4999 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
5000 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
5001 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
5003 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
5004 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
5005 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
5006 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
5007 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
5008 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
5010 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
5011 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
5012 necessarily be discarded.
5013 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
5014 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
5015 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
5016 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
5017 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
5018 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
5020 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
5021 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
5022 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
5023 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
5024 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
5025 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
5026 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
5028 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
5029 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
5030 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
5034 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
5035 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
5036 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
5037 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
5038 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
5039 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
5040 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5041 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5044 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5047 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5048 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5049 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5051 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5052 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5053 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5055 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5056 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5057 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5059 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5060 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5061 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5062 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5065 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5066 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5067 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5069 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5070 want to use this feature, you must set
5072 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5074 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5075 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5078 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5079 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5080 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5081 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5083 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5084 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5085 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5086 and does not introduce a comment.
5088 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5089 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5090 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5091 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5092 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5094 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5095 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5096 change settings as required.
5098 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5099 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5100 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5101 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5102 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5107 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5108 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5109 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5110 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5111 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5112 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5115 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5116 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5118 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5119 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5120 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5121 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5122 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5125 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5126 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5127 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5128 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5130 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5131 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5134 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5137 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5138 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5143 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5144 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5145 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5146 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5147 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5148 definition, and must be of the form
5150 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5152 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5153 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5154 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5155 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5156 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5158 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5159 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5160 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5162 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5163 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5164 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5165 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5166 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5167 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5168 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5171 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5172 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5174 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5175 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5176 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5177 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5178 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5179 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5182 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5183 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5184 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5189 MAC == updated value
5191 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5192 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5193 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5194 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5198 MAC == MAC and something added
5200 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5201 from a number of other files.
5203 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5204 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5205 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5206 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5207 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5212 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5213 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5214 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5215 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5217 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5218 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5220 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5222 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5224 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5225 address lists. In Exim version 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5226 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5229 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5230 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5231 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5232 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5233 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5236 The following classes of macros are defined:
5238 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5239 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5240 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5241 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5242 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5243 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5244 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5245 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5246 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5247 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5248 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5249 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5250 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5251 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5252 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5253 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5256 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5259 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5260 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5261 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5262 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5263 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5264 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5265 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5267 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5268 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5269 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5273 message_size_limit = 50M
5275 message_size_limit = 100M
5278 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5279 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5280 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5281 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5282 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5284 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5285 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5286 in this line"& will always be true.
5288 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5289 to clarify complicated nestings.
5293 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5294 .cindex "common option syntax"
5295 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5296 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5297 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5298 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5299 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5300 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5301 space) and then the value. For example:
5303 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5305 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5306 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5307 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5308 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5309 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5310 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5311 word &"hide"&. For example:
5313 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5315 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5317 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5319 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5320 all instances of the same driver.
5322 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5323 that are found in option settings.
5326 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5327 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5328 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5329 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5330 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5331 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5332 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5333 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5334 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5335 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5336 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5337 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5342 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5347 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5352 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5353 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5354 .cindex "format" "integer"
5355 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5356 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5357 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5358 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5361 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5362 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5363 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5365 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5366 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5367 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5371 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5372 .cindex "integer format"
5373 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5374 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5375 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5376 Such options are always output in octal.
5379 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5380 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5381 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5382 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5383 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5387 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5388 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5389 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5390 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5391 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5401 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5402 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5403 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5407 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5408 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5409 .cindex "format" "string"
5410 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5411 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5412 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5413 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5414 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5415 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5416 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5417 therefore equivalent:
5419 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5420 trusted_users = uucp:\
5421 # This comment line is ignored
5424 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5425 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5426 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5427 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5428 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5431 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5432 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5433 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5435 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5436 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5440 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5441 character, that character replaces the pair.
5443 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5444 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5445 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5446 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5447 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5448 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5451 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5452 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5453 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5454 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5455 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5456 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5457 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5458 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5459 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5460 within a quoted configuration string.
5463 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5464 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5465 .cindex "format" "user name"
5466 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5467 .cindex "format" "group name"
5468 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5469 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5470 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5471 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5474 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5475 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5476 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5477 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5478 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5479 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5480 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5481 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5482 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5483 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5484 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5486 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5487 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5488 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5489 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5490 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5491 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5494 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5496 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5498 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5499 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5500 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5501 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5503 .subsection "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5504 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5505 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5506 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5507 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5508 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5509 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5510 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5512 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5514 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5515 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5516 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5518 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5519 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5520 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5521 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5522 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5523 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5524 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5525 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5526 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5528 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5530 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5531 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5532 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5533 the value in quotes. For example:
5535 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5537 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5538 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5539 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5540 enclosing an empty list item.
5544 .subsection "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5545 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5546 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5547 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5549 senders = user@domain :
5551 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5552 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5553 items, the second of which is empty:
5555 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5557 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5558 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5559 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5560 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5564 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5565 is at the end of the list.
5570 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5571 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5572 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5573 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5574 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5575 a sequence of lines like this:
5577 <&'instance name'&>:
5582 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5583 followed by three options settings:
5588 transport = local_delivery
5590 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5591 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5592 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5593 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5594 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5595 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5597 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5598 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5600 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5601 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5602 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5603 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5604 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5607 .cindex "generic options"
5608 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5609 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5610 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5611 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5612 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5613 .cindex "private options"
5614 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5615 they all have default values.
5617 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5618 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5619 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5621 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5622 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5623 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5624 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5625 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5626 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5627 configuration lines:
5632 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5633 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5634 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5635 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5641 command_timeout = 10s
5643 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5644 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5647 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5648 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5649 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5660 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5661 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5662 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5663 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5664 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5665 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5666 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5667 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5668 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5669 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5670 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5674 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5675 All macros should be defined before any options.
5677 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5679 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5681 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5682 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5683 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5684 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5686 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5687 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5688 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5691 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5692 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5693 in the file, after the macros.
5694 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5696 # primary_hostname =
5698 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5699 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5700 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5701 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5703 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5705 domainlist local_domains = @
5706 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5707 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5709 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5710 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5711 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5712 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5714 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5715 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5718 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5719 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5720 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5721 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5722 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5723 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5725 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5726 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5727 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5728 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5729 domain is permitted.
5731 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5732 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5733 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5734 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5735 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5736 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5738 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5739 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5740 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5742 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5744 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5745 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5747 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5748 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5749 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5750 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5751 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5752 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5753 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5754 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5755 contents of a message to be checked.
5757 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5759 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5760 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5762 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5763 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5764 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5765 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5767 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5769 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5770 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5771 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5773 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5774 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5775 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5776 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5777 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5778 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5779 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5781 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5783 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5784 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5786 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5787 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5788 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5789 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5790 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5791 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5792 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5793 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5794 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5795 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5796 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5797 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5798 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5799 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5800 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5801 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5803 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6409,RFC 6409) (previously 4409)
5804 specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5805 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5806 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
5807 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5808 which should be used in preference to 587.
5809 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5811 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5813 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5816 # qualify_recipient =
5818 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5819 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5820 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5821 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5822 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5823 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5825 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5826 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5827 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5828 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5830 # allow_domain_literals
5832 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5833 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5834 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5835 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5836 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5837 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5839 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5843 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5844 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5845 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5846 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5847 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5848 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5849 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5850 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5852 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5853 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5858 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5859 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5860 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5861 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5862 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5863 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5866 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by
5867 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
5868 (hence their names):
5871 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5873 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5874 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5875 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5876 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5877 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5878 information, you can change this.
5880 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5881 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5886 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5887 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5888 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5889 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5891 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5892 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5894 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5895 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5897 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5900 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5901 +tls_certificate_verified
5904 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5906 # percent_hack_domains =
5908 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5909 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5910 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5912 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5913 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5914 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5915 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5916 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5917 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5918 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5919 always bounce messages.
5921 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5922 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5924 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5925 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5926 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5927 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5928 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5930 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5931 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5932 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5933 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5934 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5937 # split_spool_directory = true
5940 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5941 messages &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2048,RFC 2047)
5942 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5943 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5944 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5945 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5946 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5947 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5949 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5952 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5953 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5954 that are not 8-bit clean.
5956 # accept_8bitmime = false
5959 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5960 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5961 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5962 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5963 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5964 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5966 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5967 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5971 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5972 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5973 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5974 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5975 It starts with the line
5979 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5980 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5981 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5983 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5984 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5985 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5986 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5987 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5988 result of the ACL processing.
5992 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5997 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5998 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5999 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
6000 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
6001 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
6002 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
6004 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
6005 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
6006 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
6009 deny domains = +local_domains
6010 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
6011 message = Restricted characters in address
6013 deny domains = !+local_domains
6014 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
6015 message = Restricted characters in address
6017 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
6018 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
6019 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
6020 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
6021 in Internet mail addresses.
6023 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
6024 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
6025 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
6026 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
6027 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
6028 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
6029 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
6030 policy of being as safe as possible.
6032 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
6033 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
6034 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
6035 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6036 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6037 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6039 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
6040 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
6041 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
6042 have to modify this rule.
6044 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in
6045 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
6047 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6048 common convention of local parts constructed as
6049 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6050 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6051 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6052 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6053 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6054 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6056 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6057 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6058 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6059 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6060 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6061 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6062 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6064 accept local_parts = postmaster
6065 domains = +local_domains
6067 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6068 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6069 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6070 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6071 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6073 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6074 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6075 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6077 require verify = sender
6079 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6080 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6081 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6082 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6083 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6084 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6085 discusses the details of address verification.
6087 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6088 control = submission
6090 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6091 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6092 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6093 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6094 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6095 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6096 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6097 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6098 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6100 accept authenticated = *
6101 control = submission
6103 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6104 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6105 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6106 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6107 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6108 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6110 require message = relay not permitted
6111 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6113 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6114 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6116 require verify = recipient
6118 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6119 fails, the address is rejected.
6121 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6122 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6123 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6126 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6127 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6128 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6129 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6131 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6132 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6133 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6136 # require verify = csa
6138 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6139 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6144 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6145 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6149 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6150 of this ACL are commented out:
6153 # message = This message contains a virus \
6156 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6157 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6158 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6159 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6161 # warn spam = nobody
6162 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6163 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6164 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6165 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6167 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6168 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6169 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6170 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6171 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6172 whatever the spam score.
6176 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6179 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6180 .cindex "default" "routers"
6181 .cindex "routers" "default"
6182 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6187 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6188 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6189 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6190 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6191 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6194 # driver = ipliteral
6195 # domains = !+local_domains
6196 # transport = remote_smtp
6198 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6199 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6200 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6201 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6202 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6204 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6205 macro has been defined, per
6207 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6216 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6217 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6218 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6219 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6223 driver = manualroute
6224 domains = ! +local_domains
6225 transport = smarthost_smtp
6226 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6227 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6230 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6231 specified by the line
6233 domains = ! +local_domains
6235 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6236 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6237 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6238 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6239 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6240 passed on to the following routers.
6242 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6243 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6244 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6245 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6247 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6248 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6249 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6250 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6251 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6252 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6253 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6258 domains = ! +local_domains
6259 transport = remote_smtp
6260 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6263 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6265 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6266 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6267 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6268 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6269 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6271 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6272 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6273 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6274 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6275 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6276 the address fails and is bounced.
6278 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6279 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6280 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6281 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6282 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6283 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6284 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6291 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6293 file_transport = address_file
6294 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6296 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6297 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6298 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6299 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6300 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6303 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6304 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6305 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6306 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6311 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6312 # local_part_suffix_optional
6313 file = $home/.forward
6318 file_transport = address_file
6319 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6320 reply_transport = address_reply
6322 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6323 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6324 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6325 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6326 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6329 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6330 # local_part_suffix_optional
6332 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6333 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6334 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6335 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6336 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6337 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6338 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6340 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6341 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6342 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6343 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6345 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6346 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6347 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6348 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6349 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6350 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6351 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6353 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6354 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6355 There are two reasons for doing this:
6358 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6359 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6362 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6363 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6364 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6365 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6369 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6370 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6371 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6372 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6374 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6375 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6376 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6378 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6380 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6386 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6387 # local_part_suffix_optional
6388 transport = local_delivery
6390 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6391 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6392 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6393 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6394 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6397 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6398 .cindex "default" "transports"
6399 .cindex "transports" "default"
6400 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6401 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6402 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6406 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6410 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6415 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6416 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6417 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6418 with over-long lines.
6420 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6421 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6422 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6423 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6425 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6426 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6427 usual federated system.
6432 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6436 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6437 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6438 hosts_require_tls = *
6439 tls_verify_hosts = *
6440 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6441 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6442 # you succeed or not:
6443 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6445 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6446 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6447 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6448 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6449 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6450 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6452 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6453 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6456 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6463 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6464 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6465 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6466 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6467 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6468 then no other options are defined.
6469 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6470 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6471 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6472 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6473 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6474 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6475 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6476 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6477 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6478 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6479 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6481 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6483 All other options are defaulted.
6487 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6494 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6495 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6497 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6498 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6499 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6500 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6501 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6503 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6504 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6505 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6506 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6507 show how this can be done.
6509 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6510 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6511 similarly-named options above.
6517 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6518 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6519 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6520 be returned to the sender.
6528 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6529 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6530 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6535 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6540 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6541 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6542 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6543 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6544 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6545 introduced by the line
6549 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6552 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6554 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6555 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6556 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6557 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6558 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6560 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6561 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6562 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6565 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6566 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6570 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6571 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6575 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6576 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6577 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6579 begin authenticators
6581 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6582 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6583 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6584 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6585 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6586 to support most MUA software.
6588 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6591 # driver = plaintext
6592 # server_set_id = $auth2
6593 # server_prompts = :
6594 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6595 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6597 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6600 # driver = plaintext
6601 # server_set_id = $auth1
6602 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6603 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6604 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6607 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6608 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6609 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6610 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6611 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6612 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6613 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6614 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6616 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6617 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6618 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6619 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6621 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6622 usercode and password are in different positions.
6623 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6625 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6632 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6634 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6636 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6637 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6638 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6639 regular expressions is discussed in
6640 online Perl manpages, in
6641 many Perl reference books, and also in
6642 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6643 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6644 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6645 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6646 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6648 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6649 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6650 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6651 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6652 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6655 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6656 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6657 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6658 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6660 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6662 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6663 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6664 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6665 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6666 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6667 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6670 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6671 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6672 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6673 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6674 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6675 match anywhere in the subject string.
6677 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6678 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6680 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6682 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6685 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6687 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6688 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6695 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6696 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6697 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6699 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6700 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6703 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6704 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6705 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6706 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6707 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6708 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6710 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6711 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6712 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6713 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6714 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6715 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6716 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6717 or may be &*implicit*&,
6718 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6721 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6722 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6723 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6724 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6725 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6726 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6728 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6729 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6730 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6731 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6732 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6734 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6735 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6738 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6739 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6740 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6741 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6742 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6743 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6745 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6746 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6748 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6749 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6750 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6751 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6752 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6755 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6756 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6758 The file could contains lines like this:
6763 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6764 matches the list item.
6766 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6767 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6768 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6771 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6772 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6774 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6776 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6777 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6778 causes a second lookup to occur.
6780 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6781 and a comma-separated list of options.
6782 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6783 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6785 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6786 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6787 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6788 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6790 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6791 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6792 lookup is permitted.
6795 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6796 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6797 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6798 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6801 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6802 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6803 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6804 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6805 The file string may not be tainted.
6807 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6808 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6809 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6810 If this is given and the lookup
6811 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6812 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6813 version of the lookup key.
6816 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6817 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6818 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6819 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6821 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6822 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6823 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6824 list item after the first semicolon.
6826 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6827 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6828 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6829 appropriate for the lookup.
6832 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6833 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6834 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6839 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6840 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6841 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6846 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6847 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6848 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6849 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6852 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6853 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6854 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6855 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6856 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6857 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6858 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6859 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6860 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6862 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6863 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6864 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6865 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6867 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6868 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6869 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6870 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6873 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6874 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6875 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6876 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6877 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6878 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6879 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6881 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6882 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6883 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6884 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6885 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6886 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6887 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6890 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6891 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6893 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6894 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6895 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6896 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6897 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6898 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6899 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6902 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6903 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6904 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6906 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6907 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6908 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6909 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6910 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6911 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6912 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6913 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6914 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6915 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6918 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6919 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6920 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6921 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6922 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6923 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6924 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6925 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6926 The result is regarded as untainted.
6928 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6929 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6930 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6932 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6934 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6935 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6937 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6939 The default result is just the requested entry.
6941 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6942 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6943 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6945 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6947 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6950 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6951 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6953 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6955 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6956 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6958 An example of how this
6959 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6960 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6962 .subsection iplsearch
6963 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6964 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6965 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6966 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6967 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6968 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6969 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6971 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6972 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6973 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6974 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6976 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6977 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6978 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6979 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6980 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6982 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6983 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6984 lookup types support only literal keys.
6986 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6987 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6988 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6990 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6991 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6992 notation before executing the lookup.)
6994 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6995 rather than omitting the key portion.
6996 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
7000 .cindex json "lookup type"
7001 .cindex JSON expansions
7002 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
7003 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
7004 The key is a list of subelement selectors
7005 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
7006 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
7007 of the JSON structure.
7008 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
7009 nunbered array element is selected.
7010 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
7011 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
7012 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
7014 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
7020 .cindex database lmdb
7021 The given file is an LMDB database.
7022 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
7023 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
7024 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/,LMDB)
7025 for the feature set and operation modes.
7027 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
7028 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
7029 or your operating system package repository.
7030 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
7032 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
7033 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
7037 .cindex "linear search"
7038 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
7039 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
7040 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
7041 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
7042 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
7043 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
7044 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
7045 in the file is used.
7047 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7048 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7049 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7050 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7051 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7056 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7057 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7058 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7059 wildcarding of any kind.
7061 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7062 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7063 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7064 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7065 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7066 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7067 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7068 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7069 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7072 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7073 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7074 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7075 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7076 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7077 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7078 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7079 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7081 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7082 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7083 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7084 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7085 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7086 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7087 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7088 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7089 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7090 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7092 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7093 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7094 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7095 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7098 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7100 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7101 *fish data for anythingfish
7104 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7105 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7107 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7109 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7110 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7111 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7113 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7115 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7116 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7117 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7119 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7122 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7123 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7124 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7125 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7126 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7128 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7129 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7130 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7131 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7132 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7135 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7136 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7137 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7140 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7142 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7145 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7146 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7147 be followed by optional colons.
7149 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7150 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7151 lookup types support only literal keys.
7154 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7155 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7156 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7157 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7158 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7161 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7162 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7163 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7164 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7165 many of them are given in later sections.
7168 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7169 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7170 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7171 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7172 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7175 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7176 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7177 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7180 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7181 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7182 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7183 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7184 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7185 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7186 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7189 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7190 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7191 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7192 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7195 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7196 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7197 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7198 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7201 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7202 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7203 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7204 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7207 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7208 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7209 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7210 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7211 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7212 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7213 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7214 password value. For example:
7216 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7220 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7221 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7222 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7223 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7226 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7227 .cindex lookup Redis
7228 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7229 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7232 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7233 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7234 The format of the query is
7235 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7238 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7239 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7242 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7243 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7244 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7245 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7246 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7247 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7248 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7249 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7250 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7252 require condition = \
7253 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7255 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7256 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7257 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7258 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7262 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7263 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7264 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7265 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7266 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7267 options such as a list of local domains.
7269 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7270 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7271 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7272 or may give up altogether.
7276 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7277 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7278 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7279 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7280 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7281 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7282 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7283 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7285 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7286 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7287 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7289 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7290 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7291 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7293 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7294 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7295 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7296 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7297 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7298 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7299 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7300 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7301 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7302 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7304 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7306 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7307 looks up these keys, in this order:
7313 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7314 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7315 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7316 Exim move on to try the next key.
7320 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7321 .cindex "partial matching"
7322 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7323 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7324 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7325 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7326 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7327 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7328 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7329 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7330 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7331 a key in a DBM file is
7333 *.dates.fict.example
7335 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7336 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7337 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7340 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7341 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7342 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7344 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7345 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7346 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7347 partial matching keys
7348 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7349 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7350 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7352 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7353 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7354 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7355 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7356 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7357 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7360 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7361 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7362 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7363 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7364 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7365 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7367 2250.dates.fict.example
7368 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7369 *.dates.fict.example
7372 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7375 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7376 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7377 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7378 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7379 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7380 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7382 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7384 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7385 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7386 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7387 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7389 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7391 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7392 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7394 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7395 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7396 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7399 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7401 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7402 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7404 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7405 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7406 for &"*"& on its own.
7408 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7412 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7413 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7414 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7415 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7416 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7417 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7418 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7420 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7421 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7422 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7423 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7424 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7426 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7427 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7428 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7429 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7434 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7435 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7436 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7437 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7438 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7439 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7440 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7442 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7443 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7444 and a real lookup is done.
7446 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7447 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7448 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7449 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7450 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7451 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7453 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7454 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7460 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7461 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7462 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7463 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7464 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7465 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7469 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7470 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7472 [name="$local_part"]
7474 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7475 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7476 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7477 of the following form is provided:
7479 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7481 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7483 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7485 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7486 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7487 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7488 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7489 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7490 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7495 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7496 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7497 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7498 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7499 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7500 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7501 an expansion string could contain:
7503 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7505 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7506 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7507 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7508 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7510 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7511 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7512 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7514 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7515 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7516 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7517 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7518 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7520 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7522 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7523 white space is ignored.
7524 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7525 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7526 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7528 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7529 When the type is PTR,
7530 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7531 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7533 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7535 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7536 altered and nothing is added.
7538 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7539 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7540 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7541 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7542 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7543 The field separator can be modified as above.
7545 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7546 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7547 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7548 unless a field separator is specified.
7549 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7551 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7553 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7554 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7555 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7557 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7558 white space is ignored.
7560 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7561 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7562 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7563 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7566 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7569 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7570 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7571 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7572 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7573 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7574 each followed by a comma,
7575 that may appear before the record type.
7577 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7578 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7579 a defer-option modifier.
7580 The possible keywords are
7581 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7582 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7583 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7584 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7585 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7586 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7587 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7589 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7590 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7592 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7593 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7595 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7596 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7597 The possible keywords are
7598 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7599 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7601 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7602 is not labelled as authenticated data
7603 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7604 The default is &"lax"&.
7606 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7608 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7609 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7610 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7611 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7613 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7615 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7616 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7617 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7619 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7620 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7622 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7623 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7624 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7627 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7628 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7629 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7630 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7631 the pseudo-type MXH:
7633 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7635 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7638 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7639 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7640 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7641 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7642 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7643 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7644 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7645 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7647 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7648 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7650 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7651 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7652 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7654 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7655 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7656 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7657 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7658 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7661 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7662 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7663 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7664 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7665 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7666 result of a successful lookup such as:
7668 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7670 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7671 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7672 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7674 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7675 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7676 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7677 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7679 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7683 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7684 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7685 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7686 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7687 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7689 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7690 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7691 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7693 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7694 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7695 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7696 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7698 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7699 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7700 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7705 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7706 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7707 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7708 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7709 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7710 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7711 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7712 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7713 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7714 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7715 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7716 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7718 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7719 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7720 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7721 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7722 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7724 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7725 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7727 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7728 the way they handle the results of a query:
7731 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7734 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7735 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7737 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7738 from all of them are returned.
7742 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7743 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7744 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7745 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7748 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7749 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7750 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in
7751 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2255). For example, in
7752 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7754 data = ${lookup ldap \
7755 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7756 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7758 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7759 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7760 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7761 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7763 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7764 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7765 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7767 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7768 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7769 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7770 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7771 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7772 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7773 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7774 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7778 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7779 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7780 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7781 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7782 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7783 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7785 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7786 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7795 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2254,RFC 2254).
7796 The resulting string is then quoted according
7797 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7801 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7803 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7807 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7809 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7811 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7813 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7814 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7815 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7819 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7820 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in
7821 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2253).)
7822 The resulting string is then quoted according to the rules for URLs.
7825 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7829 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7831 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7833 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7835 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7836 authentication below.
7839 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7840 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7841 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7842 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7843 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7846 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7848 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7849 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7850 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7851 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7852 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7853 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7854 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7855 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7856 failures, and timeouts.
7858 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7859 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator
7860 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1738,RFC 1738)). Because
7861 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7862 doubled. For example
7864 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7866 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7867 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7868 the local host) is used.
7870 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7871 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7872 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7873 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7876 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7877 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7878 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7879 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7881 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7883 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7884 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7886 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7888 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7889 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7890 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7891 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7892 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7893 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7894 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7897 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7898 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7899 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7902 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7905 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7909 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7910 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7914 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7915 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7916 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7917 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7918 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7919 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7920 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7921 them. The following names are recognized:
7922 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7923 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7924 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7925 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7926 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7927 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7928 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7929 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7930 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7932 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7933 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7934 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7935 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7937 .cindex LDAP timeout
7938 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7939 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7940 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7941 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7942 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7943 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7944 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7945 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7946 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7947 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7949 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7950 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7952 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7953 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7954 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7955 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7956 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7957 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7958 alternate list (colon-separated).
7960 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7961 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7964 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7965 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7968 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7969 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7970 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7971 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7973 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7974 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7975 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7977 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7978 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7980 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7981 quoting has two advantages:
7984 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7985 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7987 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7990 For example, a setting such as
7992 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7994 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7996 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7997 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7998 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7999 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
8003 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
8004 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
8009 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
8010 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
8011 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
8012 as a sequence of values, for example
8014 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
8016 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
8017 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
8018 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
8019 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
8020 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
8023 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
8024 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
8025 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
8026 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
8028 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
8029 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
8030 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
8031 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
8032 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
8033 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
8034 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
8035 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
8036 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
8038 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
8039 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
8040 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
8041 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
8042 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
8045 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
8048 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8051 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
8052 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
8054 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8055 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8057 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
8058 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8061 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8062 results of LDAP lookups.
8063 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8064 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8065 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8066 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8067 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8068 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8073 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8074 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8075 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8076 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8077 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8078 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8079 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8080 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8082 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8084 might return the string
8086 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8087 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8089 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8091 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8097 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8098 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8099 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8103 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8104 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8105 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8106 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8107 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8108 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8109 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8110 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8111 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8112 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8113 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8114 .cindex lookup Redis
8115 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8117 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8120 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8123 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8124 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8126 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8131 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8133 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8134 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8135 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8139 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8140 with a newline between the data for each row.
8143 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8144 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8145 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8146 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8147 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8148 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8149 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8150 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8151 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8152 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8153 .cindex lookup Redis
8154 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8155 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8156 or &%redis_servers%&
8157 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8159 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8160 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8161 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8162 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8163 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8164 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8165 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8166 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8168 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8169 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8170 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8171 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8173 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8175 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8176 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8177 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8179 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8180 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8182 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8183 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8184 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8185 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8186 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8187 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8189 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8190 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8191 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8193 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8194 host, database number, and password.
8196 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8197 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8198 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8200 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8202 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8205 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8206 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8207 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8208 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8210 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8211 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8213 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8214 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8215 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8216 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8218 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8220 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8222 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8223 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8224 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8227 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8229 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8230 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8231 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8233 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8234 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8235 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8238 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8242 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8244 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8246 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8247 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8248 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8250 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8253 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8254 semicolon separated:
8256 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8258 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8259 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8260 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8261 including the server specification - which is not permissible.
8262 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8263 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8265 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8268 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8269 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8270 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8271 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8272 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8273 the default value is &"exim"&.
8274 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8276 <&'hostspec'&><&'portspec'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8277 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8279 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8280 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8283 A &'hostspec'& can be a hostname, an IPv4 address or an IPv6 address.
8284 For the latter, a &'portspec'& is a dot followed by a port number;
8285 for the other two a &'portspec'& is a colon followed by a port number.
8288 Note that the default list-separator for the list of servers is a colon so
8289 (unless that is changed) all colons in list items must be doubled.
8291 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8294 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8295 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8297 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8298 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8299 is zero because no rows are affected.
8301 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8302 parameters for the connection.
8305 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8307 The &'hostspec'& for PostgreSQL follows the same rules as for MySQL above.
8310 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8311 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8312 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8313 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8316 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8318 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8319 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8320 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8322 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8323 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8326 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8327 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8328 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8329 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8330 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8331 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8333 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8334 There are two ways of
8335 specifying the file.
8336 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8337 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8338 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8339 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8341 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8343 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8344 separated by white space.
8346 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8347 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8348 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8351 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8353 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8355 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8357 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8359 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8361 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8362 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8364 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8365 quote, which it doubles.
8367 .cindex timeout SQLite
8368 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8369 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8370 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8371 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8372 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8373 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8374 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8377 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8378 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8379 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8380 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8383 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8384 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8387 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8388 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8389 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8390 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8393 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8394 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8395 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8405 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8406 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8407 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8408 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8409 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8410 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8411 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8412 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8413 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8415 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8416 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8417 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8418 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8420 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8421 support all the complexity available in
8422 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8426 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8427 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8428 In some contexts additional information is stored
8429 about the list element that matched:
8432 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8433 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8435 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8436 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8438 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8439 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8441 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8442 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8444 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8445 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8448 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8449 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8454 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8455 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8457 Each list, after any leading change-of-separator specification
8458 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) is expanded as a single string,
8459 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8460 &*Note*&: As a result, if any component was tainted then the
8461 entire expansion result string becomes tainted.
8463 Splitting out a leading explicit change-of-separator permits
8464 one being safely used on a list that has tainted components
8465 while still detecting the use of a tainted setting.
8466 The latter is not permitted.
8469 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8470 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8473 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8474 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8475 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8476 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8477 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8480 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8481 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8482 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8484 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8485 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8486 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8487 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8488 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8490 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8491 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8493 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8494 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8495 senders based on the receiving domain.
8500 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8501 .cindex "list" "negation"
8502 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8503 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8504 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8505 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8506 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8507 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8509 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8510 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8511 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8512 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8513 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8515 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8517 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8518 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8519 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8521 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8523 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8524 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8525 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8527 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8528 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8533 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8534 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8535 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8536 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8537 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8538 filenames are not allowed,
8539 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8540 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8544 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8545 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8547 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8548 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8549 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8551 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8555 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8556 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8557 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8558 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8560 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8561 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8563 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8565 and the file contains the lines
8570 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8571 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8575 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8576 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8577 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8578 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8579 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8580 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8581 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8582 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8584 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8585 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8586 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8587 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8592 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8593 .cindex "named lists"
8594 .cindex "list" "named"
8595 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8596 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8597 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8598 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8599 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8600 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8601 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8603 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8605 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8606 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8607 configured with the line
8609 domains = +local_domains
8611 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8612 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8616 domains = ! +local_domains
8617 transport = remote_smtp
8620 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8621 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8622 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8623 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8625 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8626 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8628 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8630 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8631 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8632 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8634 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8635 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8636 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8638 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8639 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8641 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8642 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8643 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8645 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8647 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8648 referenced lists if you can.
8651 The list item which references a named list (&"+<listname>"&)
8655 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8656 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8657 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8658 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8659 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8660 word &"hide"&. For example:
8662 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8666 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8667 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8668 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8670 domains = +local_domains
8672 on several of your routers
8673 or in several ACL statements,
8674 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8675 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8676 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8677 the same each time they are referenced.
8679 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8680 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8681 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8682 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8686 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8687 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8688 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8689 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8690 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8693 ALIST = host1 : host2
8694 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8696 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8698 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8700 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8703 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8704 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8706 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8708 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8712 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8713 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8714 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8715 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8716 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8717 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8718 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8719 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8720 message. For example:
8722 domainlist special_domains = \
8723 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8725 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8726 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8727 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8728 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8729 same list each time.
8731 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8732 cache the result anyway. For example:
8734 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8736 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8737 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8741 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8742 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8743 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8744 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8745 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8748 .cindex "primary host name"
8749 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8750 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8751 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8752 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8753 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8754 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8755 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8756 differ only in their names.
8758 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8760 The pattern may not be tainted.
8765 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8766 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8767 .cindex "domain literal"
8768 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8769 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8770 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8771 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8772 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8773 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8774 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8776 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8778 The pattern may not be tainted.
8784 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8785 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8786 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8787 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8788 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8789 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8790 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8791 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8792 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8793 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8794 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8797 The pattern may not be tainted.
8800 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8801 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8802 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8803 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8804 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8806 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8807 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8808 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8809 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8810 on a router). For example:
8812 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8814 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8815 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8817 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8818 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8819 contain negative items.
8821 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8822 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8823 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8825 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8826 an.other.domain : ...
8828 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8829 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8831 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8832 an.other.domain ? ...
8834 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8838 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8839 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8840 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8841 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8842 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8843 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8844 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8845 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8846 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8849 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8850 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8851 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8854 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8855 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8856 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8857 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8858 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8859 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8860 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8861 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8862 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8864 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8865 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8866 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8867 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8868 expression by expansion, of course).
8870 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8871 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8872 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8877 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8878 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8879 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8880 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8881 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8882 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8884 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8886 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8887 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8888 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8889 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8890 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8891 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8892 other statements in the same ACL.
8893 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8894 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8895 The value will be untainted.
8897 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8898 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8899 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8900 may be what is wanted.
8904 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8905 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8907 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8909 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8910 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8913 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8914 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8915 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8916 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8917 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8918 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8922 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8923 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8924 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8925 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8927 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8928 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8930 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8931 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8932 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8933 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8934 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8935 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8936 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8937 The value will be untainted.
8940 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8941 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8942 followed by a comma and options,
8943 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8944 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8947 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8948 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8949 between the pattern and the domain.
8951 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8952 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8953 Note that this is commonly untainted
8954 (depending on the way the list was created).
8955 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8956 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8957 the domain, for later operations.
8959 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8960 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8961 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8965 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8967 domainlist funny_domains = \
8970 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8971 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8972 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8973 nis;domains.byname : \
8974 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8976 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8977 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8978 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8979 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8980 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8985 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8986 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8987 .cindex "list" "host list"
8988 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8989 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8990 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8991 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8992 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8993 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8994 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8997 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8998 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8999 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
9000 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
9001 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
9002 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
9005 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9006 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
9007 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
9011 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
9012 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
9013 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
9014 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
9015 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
9016 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
9017 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
9020 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
9021 inspecting its IP address:
9024 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
9025 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
9026 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
9027 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
9028 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
9029 with the IP address of the subject host.
9031 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
9032 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
9033 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
9034 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
9035 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9038 .cindex "@ in a host list"
9039 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
9040 domain name, as just described.
9043 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
9044 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
9045 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
9046 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
9047 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
9048 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
9049 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
9050 that can never match a client host.
9053 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
9054 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
9055 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
9056 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
9058 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
9062 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9063 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
9068 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
9069 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
9070 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
9071 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
9072 significant end of the address.
9074 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
9075 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
9076 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
9077 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
9081 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
9082 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
9085 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
9087 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
9088 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
9090 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
9091 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
9094 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
9096 could make use of a file containing
9101 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
9102 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
9103 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
9105 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
9108 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9114 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9116 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9117 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9118 address, the pattern takes this form:
9120 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9124 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9126 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9127 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9128 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9129 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9130 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9131 returned by the lookup is not used.
9133 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9134 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9135 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9136 patterns of this form:
9138 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9142 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9144 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9145 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9146 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9147 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9148 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9150 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9151 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9152 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9153 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9154 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9155 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9156 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9157 converted using colons and not dots.
9158 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9159 addresses are always used.
9160 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9162 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9163 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9164 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9167 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9168 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9169 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9170 case the IP address is used on its own.
9174 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9175 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9176 .cindex "unknown host name"
9177 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9178 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9179 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9180 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9181 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9184 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9185 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9186 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9187 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9188 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9189 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9190 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9192 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9193 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9195 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9196 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9197 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9198 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9199 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9200 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9201 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9202 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9203 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9205 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9206 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9208 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9209 .cindex "alias for host"
9210 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9211 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9214 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9215 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9216 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9217 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9218 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9221 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9222 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9223 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9224 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9225 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9226 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9227 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9232 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9233 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9234 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9235 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9236 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9238 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9240 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9241 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9242 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9249 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9250 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9251 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9252 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9253 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9254 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9256 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9257 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9259 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9260 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9261 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9262 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9263 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9264 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9265 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9266 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9267 not recognized in an indirected file).
9268 The effects of these special items do not propagate into referenced
9272 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9273 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9275 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9277 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9278 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9281 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9282 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9285 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9288 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9289 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9290 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9293 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9294 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9297 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9299 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9301 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9302 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9303 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9306 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9307 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9308 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9310 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9312 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9313 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9314 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9315 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9316 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9317 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9318 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9321 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9322 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9324 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9325 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9327 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9328 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9329 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9334 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9336 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9337 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9338 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9339 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9340 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9341 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9342 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9343 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9344 host lists such as whitelists.
9348 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9350 .cindex "unknown host name"
9351 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9352 If a pattern is of the form
9354 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9358 dbm;/host/accept/list
9360 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9361 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9364 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9365 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9366 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9367 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9368 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9369 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9370 lookup, both using the same file.
9374 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9375 If a pattern is of the form
9377 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9379 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9380 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9381 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9383 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9384 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9386 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9387 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9388 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9391 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9392 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9393 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9395 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9396 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9397 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9398 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9399 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9400 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9406 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9407 .cindex "list" "address list"
9408 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9409 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9410 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9411 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9412 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9413 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9414 using this option setting:
9418 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9419 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9420 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9421 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9423 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9426 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9428 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9429 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9430 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9431 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9432 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9433 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9434 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9436 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9437 *@+hostile_domains:\
9438 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9439 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9441 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9442 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9443 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9444 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9445 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9447 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9448 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9449 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9450 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9451 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9453 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9456 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9457 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9461 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9462 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9463 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9464 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9465 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9466 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9467 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9469 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9470 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9472 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9473 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9476 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9477 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9478 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9481 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9482 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9483 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9485 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9486 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9487 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9488 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9490 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9491 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9493 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9494 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9495 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9496 default. For example, with this lookup:
9498 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9500 the file could contains lines like this:
9502 user1@domain1.example
9505 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9508 nimrod@jaeger.example
9512 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9513 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9515 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9517 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9518 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9520 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9521 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9522 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9526 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9527 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9532 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9533 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9534 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9535 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9536 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9537 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9538 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9539 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9540 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9542 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9543 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9544 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9545 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9546 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9549 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9551 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9553 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9555 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9557 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9558 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9559 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9560 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9561 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9562 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9564 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9567 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9570 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9571 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9572 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9573 might have entries like
9575 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9576 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9579 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9580 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9581 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9582 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9584 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9585 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9586 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9589 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9590 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9591 can only return a single list of local parts.
9594 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9595 in these two examples:
9598 senders = *@+my_list
9600 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9601 example it is a named domain list.
9606 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9607 .cindex "case of local parts"
9608 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9609 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9610 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9611 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9612 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However,
9613 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505) (&'Anti-Spam
9614 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9615 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9616 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9619 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9620 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9621 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9622 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9623 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9624 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9625 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9628 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9629 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9630 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9631 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9632 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9633 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9634 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9635 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9636 The effects of &"+caseful"& propagate into any referenced named lists.
9639 This string may not be tainted.
9640 To do caseful matching on list elements whic are tainted,
9641 place them in a named list.
9646 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9647 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9648 .cindex "local part" "list"
9649 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9652 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9653 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9654 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9655 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9656 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9657 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9658 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9659 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9662 This string may not be tainted.
9663 To do caseful matching on list elements whic are tainted,
9664 place them in a named list.
9667 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9668 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9669 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9670 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9671 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9672 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9673 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9675 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9683 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9684 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9685 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9686 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9688 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9689 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9690 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9691 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9692 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9693 escape character, as described in the following section.
9695 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9696 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9698 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9699 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9700 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9701 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9702 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9704 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9705 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9706 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9707 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9708 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9710 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9712 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9713 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9714 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9715 or the password file,
9716 or accessed via a DBMS.
9717 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9721 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9722 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9723 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9724 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9725 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9726 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9727 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9728 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9730 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9731 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9732 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9733 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9735 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9737 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9738 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9743 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9744 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9745 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9746 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9747 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9748 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9749 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9752 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9753 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9754 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9757 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9758 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9759 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9761 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9762 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9763 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9764 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9765 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9766 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9767 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9770 When reading lines from the standard input,
9771 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9775 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9777 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9779 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9780 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9781 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9784 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9785 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9786 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9787 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9789 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9791 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9792 Exim message identifier. For example:
9794 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9796 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9797 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9800 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9801 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9802 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9803 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9804 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9805 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9806 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9807 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9808 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9809 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9810 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9811 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9817 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9818 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9819 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9820 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9821 white space is significant.
9824 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9825 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9826 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9831 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9832 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9833 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9834 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9835 given, the expansion fails.
9837 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9838 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9839 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9840 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9844 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9845 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9846 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9847 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9848 string easier to understand.
9850 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9851 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9852 expansion item below.
9855 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9856 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9857 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9858 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9859 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9860 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9861 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9862 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9863 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9864 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9865 the result of the expansion.
9866 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9867 the expansion result is an empty string.
9868 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9871 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9872 .cindex authentication "results header"
9873 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9874 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9875 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9876 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9878 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9879 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9880 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9889 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9891 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9893 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9894 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9897 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9898 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9899 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9900 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9901 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9902 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9903 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9904 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9908 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9909 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9914 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9918 If the field is found,
9919 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9920 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9921 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9922 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9924 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9925 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9928 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9930 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9931 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9933 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9934 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9935 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9936 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9937 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9938 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9939 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9940 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9942 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9943 take an optional modifier of "int"
9944 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9945 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9946 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9948 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9949 newline-separated by default,
9950 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9951 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9952 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9954 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9955 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9956 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9957 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9958 if so the element tags are omitted.
9960 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9962 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9963 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9965 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9966 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9970 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9971 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9972 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9974 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9977 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9978 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9979 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9980 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9981 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9982 must have the following type:
9984 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9986 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9987 function should return one of the following values:
9989 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9990 into the expanded string that is being built.
9992 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9993 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9995 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9996 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9998 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
10000 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
10001 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
10002 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
10005 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10006 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
10007 .cindex "environment" "values from"
10008 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
10010 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
10011 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
10012 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
10014 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
10015 appear, for example:
10017 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
10019 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10020 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10022 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
10024 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
10027 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
10028 &%add_environment%& main section options.
10031 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10032 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10033 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
10034 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
10035 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10036 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10037 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10038 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10040 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
10042 .vindex "&$value$&"
10043 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
10044 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
10045 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
10046 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
10047 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
10048 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
10049 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
10050 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
10051 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
10053 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
10054 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10055 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
10058 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
10059 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
10061 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
10062 appear, for example:
10064 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
10066 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10067 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10069 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10070 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10071 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10072 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10073 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
10074 .cindex JSON expansions
10075 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10076 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10077 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10078 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10080 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
10082 .vindex "&$value$&"
10083 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
10084 the spaces are optional.
10085 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
10086 For the &"json"& variant,
10087 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10089 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10090 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10091 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
10093 The results of matching are handled as above.
10096 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
10097 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10098 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
10099 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
10100 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10101 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10102 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
10103 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
10104 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
10105 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
10106 <&'string3'&> as before.
10108 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
10109 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
10110 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
10111 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
10112 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
10113 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
10114 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
10115 provided. For example:
10117 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10121 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10123 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
10124 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
10127 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10128 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10129 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10130 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10131 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10132 .cindex JSON expansions
10133 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10134 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10136 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10137 there is no choice of field separator.
10138 For the &"json"& variant,
10139 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10141 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10142 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10145 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10146 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10147 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10150 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10151 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10152 then the whole is taken as a list.
10154 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10156 For each item in this list,
10157 its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is evaluated.
10158 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10159 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10160 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10161 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10162 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10164 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10166 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10167 to what it was before.
10168 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10171 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10172 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10173 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10174 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10175 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10176 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10178 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10179 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10180 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10181 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10183 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10185 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10186 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10187 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10188 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10189 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10191 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10193 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10194 letters appear. For example:
10196 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10197 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10198 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10201 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10202 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10203 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10204 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10205 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10206 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10207 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10208 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10209 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10210 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10211 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10212 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10213 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10214 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10215 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10216 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10217 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10221 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10222 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10223 lines) may be present.
10225 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10226 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10229 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10230 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10231 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10234 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10235 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10236 are multiple headers with a given name.
10237 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10238 list-processing facilities can be used.
10239 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10240 the content is &"raw"&.
10243 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10244 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10245 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10246 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10247 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10248 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10249 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10250 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10253 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10254 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10255 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10256 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10257 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10258 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10261 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10262 command of the following form:
10264 headers charset "UTF-8"
10266 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10267 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10268 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10269 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10270 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10273 Header names follow the syntax of
10274 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
10275 which states that they may contain
10276 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10277 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10278 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10280 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10281 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10282 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10283 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10284 router or transport are not accessible.
10286 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10287 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10288 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10289 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10290 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10291 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10292 point they are added.
10293 When any of the above ACLs are
10294 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10296 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10297 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10298 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10299 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10300 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10301 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10302 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10305 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10306 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10307 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10308 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10309 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10310 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10311 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10312 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10314 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10315 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10316 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10319 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10320 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10322 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10323 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10324 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2104.RFC 2104).
10325 This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10326 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10327 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10328 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10329 present. For example:
10331 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10333 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10336 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10338 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10339 an Exim configuration:
10341 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10343 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10346 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10347 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10348 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10350 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10351 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10352 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10353 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10354 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10355 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10358 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10359 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10360 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10361 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10362 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10363 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10365 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10367 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10368 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10369 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10370 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10371 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10373 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10374 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10375 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10377 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10381 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10386 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10387 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10388 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10389 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10390 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10391 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10395 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10396 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10397 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10398 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10399 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10400 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10401 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10402 some of the braces:
10404 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10406 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10407 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10408 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10409 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10412 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10413 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10414 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10415 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10416 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10417 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10418 apart from an optional leading minus,
10419 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10422 The <&'string1'&> argument, after any leading change-of-separator
10423 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
10424 is expanded and the whole forms the list.
10426 By default, the list separator is a colon.
10428 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10429 If the number is negative, the fields are
10430 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10431 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10432 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10434 If the modulus of the
10435 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10436 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10440 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10444 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10446 yields &"result: 42"&.
10448 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10449 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10451 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10454 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10455 .cindex quoting "for list"
10456 .cindex list quoting
10457 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10458 in the given string.
10459 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10460 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10461 in a list using the given separator.
10464 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10465 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10466 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10467 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10468 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10469 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10470 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10471 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10472 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10473 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10474 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10476 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10477 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10478 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10479 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10480 out by the system administrator.
10482 .vindex "&$value$&"
10483 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10484 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10485 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10486 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10487 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10488 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10489 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10490 original lookup fails.
10492 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10493 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10494 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10495 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10496 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10497 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10498 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10499 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10501 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10502 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10503 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10504 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10506 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10507 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10508 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10509 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10511 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10513 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10515 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10516 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10518 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10523 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10524 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10527 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10528 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10529 then the whole is taken as a list.
10531 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10533 For each item in this list,
10534 its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10535 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10536 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10537 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10539 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10541 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10542 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10543 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10545 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10546 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10547 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10548 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10549 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10550 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10551 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10553 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10555 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10556 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10557 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10558 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10561 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10563 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10567 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10568 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10569 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10570 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10571 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10572 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10573 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10574 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10576 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10577 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10578 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10579 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10580 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10581 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10584 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10585 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10586 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10588 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10589 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10592 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10593 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10594 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10595 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10596 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10597 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10598 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10599 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10601 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10602 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10603 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10604 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10605 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10606 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10607 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10608 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10609 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10610 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10612 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10613 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10614 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10615 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10617 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10618 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10619 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10620 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10621 is the expansion of the third argument.
10623 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10624 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10625 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10627 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10628 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10629 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10630 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10631 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10632 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10633 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10634 newlines are left in the string.
10635 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10636 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10637 the string expansion fails.
10639 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10640 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10644 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10645 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10646 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10647 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10648 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10649 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10650 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10653 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10654 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10656 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10657 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10658 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10659 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10660 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10663 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10665 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10666 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10667 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10668 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10669 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10670 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10671 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10673 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10676 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10677 and must be present if any options are given.
10678 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10681 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10684 The following option names are recognised:
10687 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10688 request in the same process.
10689 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10690 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10691 will be invalidated.
10695 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10696 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10697 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10701 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10702 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10706 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10707 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10708 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10712 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10713 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10714 turns them into spaces:
10716 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10718 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10719 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10720 addition, the following errors can occur:
10723 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10725 Failure to connect the socket;
10727 Failure to write the request string;
10729 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10732 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10733 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10734 errors occurs. For example:
10736 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10739 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10740 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10741 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10742 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10743 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10745 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10746 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10749 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10750 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10751 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10752 .vindex "&$value$&"
10754 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string.
10757 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10758 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10759 then the whole is taken as a list.
10761 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10763 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10764 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10765 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10766 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10767 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10768 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10769 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10771 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10773 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10776 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10778 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10779 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10782 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10783 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10784 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10787 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10788 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10789 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10790 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10793 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10794 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10795 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10797 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10798 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10799 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10800 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10801 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10802 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10803 and without whitespace.
10805 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10806 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10807 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10808 Then the command is run
10809 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10810 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10811 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10812 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10814 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10815 potential attacker;
10816 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10818 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10819 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10820 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10821 and then the command is run as above.
10822 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10823 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10824 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10825 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10826 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10827 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10828 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10829 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10830 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10832 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10834 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10835 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10836 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10837 .vindex "&$value$&"
10838 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10839 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10840 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10841 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10842 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10845 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10846 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10847 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10848 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10850 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10851 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10852 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10855 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10856 log_message = Output of id: $value
10858 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10859 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10861 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10863 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10865 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10866 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10867 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10869 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10870 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10874 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10875 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10878 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10879 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10880 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10881 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10883 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10884 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10887 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10888 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10889 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10890 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10891 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10892 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10893 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10894 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10896 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10898 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10899 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10900 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10902 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10904 yields &"defabc"&, and
10906 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10908 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10909 the regular expression from string expansion.
10911 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10912 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10915 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10916 .cindex sorting "a list"
10917 .cindex list sorting
10918 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10920 <&'string'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10921 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10922 then the whole is taken as a list.
10924 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10926 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10927 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10928 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10929 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10930 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10931 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10932 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10933 to give values for comparison.
10935 The item result is a sorted list,
10936 with the original list separator,
10937 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10941 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10943 sorts a list of numbers, and
10945 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10947 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10951 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10952 SRS encoding. See section &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10956 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10957 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10958 .cindex "substring extraction"
10959 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10960 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10961 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10962 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10963 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10965 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10967 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10968 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10971 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10972 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10973 length required. For example
10975 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10977 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10978 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10979 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10980 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10982 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10983 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10984 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10986 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10988 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10989 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10990 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10992 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10994 yields an empty string, but
10996 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
11000 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
11001 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
11002 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
11003 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
11006 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
11008 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
11010 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11014 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
11015 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
11016 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
11017 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
11018 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
11019 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
11020 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
11021 replacement list. For example
11023 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
11025 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
11026 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
11027 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
11030 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11036 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
11037 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
11038 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
11039 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
11040 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
11041 following operations can be performed:
11044 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11045 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
11046 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
11047 The string is interpreted as an
11048 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11049 address, as it might appear in a
11050 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
11051 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11053 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11056 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11057 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
11058 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
11059 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in
11060 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11061 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
11062 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
11063 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
11064 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
11065 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
11067 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
11068 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
11069 character. For example:
11071 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
11073 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
11074 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
11075 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
11076 separator explicitly:
11078 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
11081 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
11082 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
11083 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
11086 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
11087 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
11088 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
11089 email address separator. For the example header line:
11091 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
11093 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
11094 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
11095 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
11096 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
11097 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
11098 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
11099 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
11101 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
11102 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
11104 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
11105 Last:user@example.com
11106 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
11108 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
11112 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11113 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
11114 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11115 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11116 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
11117 Only lowercase letters are used.
11119 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
11120 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
11121 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11122 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
11123 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
11125 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11126 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
11127 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11128 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11129 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
11130 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
11131 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
11132 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
11133 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
11135 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
11136 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
11137 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11138 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
11139 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
11140 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
11143 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11144 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
11145 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
11146 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
11147 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
11148 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
11150 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11151 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
11154 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11155 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
11156 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
11157 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
11158 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11161 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11162 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11163 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11164 The string is interpreted as an
11165 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11166 address and the domain is extracted from it.
11167 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11170 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11171 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11172 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11173 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11174 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11175 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11176 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11178 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11179 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11180 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11181 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11182 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11183 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11186 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11187 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11188 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11189 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11190 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11191 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11192 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11193 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11194 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11195 C programming language):
11197 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11198 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11199 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11200 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11201 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11203 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11205 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11206 space is permitted before or after operators.
11208 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11209 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11210 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11211 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11212 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11214 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11216 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11217 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11220 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11221 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11222 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11223 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11224 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11225 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11226 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11227 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11228 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11229 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11230 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11233 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11237 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11240 {$recipients_count} \
11241 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11244 message = Too many bad recipients
11246 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11247 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11250 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11251 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11252 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11255 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11257 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11258 and then re-expands what it has found.
11261 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11263 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11264 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11265 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11266 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11267 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11268 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11269 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11270 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11271 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11273 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11274 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11275 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11276 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11277 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11278 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11279 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11282 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11283 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11284 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11285 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11286 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11287 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11289 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11291 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11292 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11296 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11297 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11298 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11299 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11300 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11301 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11302 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11303 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11304 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11305 column number is reached.
11306 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11307 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11308 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11312 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11313 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11314 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11315 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11316 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11317 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11321 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11322 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11323 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11324 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11325 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11326 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11327 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11330 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11331 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11332 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11333 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11334 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11335 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11336 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11338 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11339 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11340 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11341 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11342 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11343 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11344 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11345 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11346 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11349 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11350 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11351 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11352 .cindex "lower casing"
11353 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11354 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11355 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11359 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11361 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11362 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11363 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11364 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11365 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11366 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11368 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11370 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11371 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11372 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11373 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11376 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11377 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11378 .cindex "list" "item count"
11379 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11380 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11381 The part of the string after any leading change-of-separator is expanded,
11382 then the whole is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11385 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11386 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11387 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11388 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11389 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11390 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11391 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11392 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11393 matching list is returned.
11394 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11395 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11398 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11399 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11400 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11401 The string is interpreted as an
11402 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11403 address and the local part is extracted from it.
11404 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11405 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11408 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11409 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11410 .cindex "masked IP address"
11411 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11412 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11413 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11414 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11415 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11416 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11417 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11418 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11419 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11421 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11423 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11425 Since this operation is expected to
11426 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11429 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11430 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11432 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11436 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11438 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11439 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11440 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11443 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11445 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11446 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11447 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11448 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11449 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11451 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11452 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11455 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11456 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11457 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11458 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11459 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11460 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11462 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11464 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11467 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11468 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11469 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11470 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11471 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11472 is an empty string or
11473 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11474 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11475 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11476 respectively For example,
11484 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11485 variable or a message header.
11487 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11488 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11489 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11490 required to do so by the rules of
11491 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11492 for quoting local parts. For example,
11493 a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11494 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11495 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11497 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11498 will likely use the quoting form.
11499 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11502 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11503 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11504 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11505 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11506 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11508 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11514 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11515 yields an unchanged string.
11518 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11519 .cindex "random number"
11520 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11521 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11522 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11523 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11524 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11525 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11526 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11527 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11531 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11532 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11533 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11534 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11535 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11536 for DNS. For example,
11538 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11539 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11544 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11548 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11549 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11550 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11551 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11552 This operator encodes text according to the rules of
11553 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). This is an
11554 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11555 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11556 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11557 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11560 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11562 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11563 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11567 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11568 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11569 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11570 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11571 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per
11572 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
11574 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11575 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11576 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11578 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11579 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11580 to use this operator as well.
11584 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11585 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11586 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11587 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11588 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11589 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11590 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11593 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11594 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11595 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11596 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11597 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11598 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11599 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11601 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11602 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11605 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11606 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11607 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11608 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11609 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11610 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11611 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11612 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11613 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11614 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11616 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11618 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11619 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11621 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11622 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11623 Finally, if an underbar
11624 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11625 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11626 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11629 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11630 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11631 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11632 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11633 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11634 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11636 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11638 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11639 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11640 with 256 being the default.
11642 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11643 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11644 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11645 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11648 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11649 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11650 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11651 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11652 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11653 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11654 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11655 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11656 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11657 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11658 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11659 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11660 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11662 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11663 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11664 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11666 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11667 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11668 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11672 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11673 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11674 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11675 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11676 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11677 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11678 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11681 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11682 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11683 .cindex "substring extraction"
11684 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11685 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11686 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11687 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11689 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11691 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11692 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11693 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11695 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11696 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11697 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11698 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11701 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11702 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11703 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11704 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11705 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11706 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11709 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11710 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11711 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11712 .cindex "upper casing"
11713 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11714 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11715 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11716 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11718 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11719 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11720 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11721 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11722 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11723 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11724 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11725 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11726 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11727 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11728 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11729 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11730 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11731 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11733 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11735 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11736 literal question mark).
11738 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11739 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11740 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11741 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11742 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11743 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11745 .cindex internationalisation
11746 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11747 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11748 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11749 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11750 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11751 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11754 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11755 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11756 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11758 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11759 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per
11760 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
11771 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11772 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11773 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11774 while expanding strings:
11777 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11778 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11779 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11780 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11783 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11784 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11785 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11786 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11788 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11790 .irow "== " "equal"
11791 .irow "> " "greater"
11792 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11794 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11798 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11800 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11801 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11802 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11803 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11804 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11807 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11808 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11809 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11812 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11813 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11814 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11815 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11816 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11817 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11818 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11819 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11820 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11821 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11822 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11823 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11824 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11825 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11827 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11828 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11829 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11830 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11831 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11832 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11834 An empty string is treated as false.
11835 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11836 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11837 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11839 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11840 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11843 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11847 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11848 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11849 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11850 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11851 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11852 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11853 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11854 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11856 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11858 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11859 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11860 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11861 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11862 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11863 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11864 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11865 included in the binary.
11867 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11868 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11869 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11870 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11871 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11872 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11873 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11874 string in LDAP form is:
11876 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11878 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11879 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11881 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11883 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11888 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11889 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11890 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11891 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11892 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11893 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11897 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11898 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11899 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11900 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11901 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11902 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11905 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11906 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11907 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11908 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11909 whatever its length.
11912 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11913 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11914 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11915 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11917 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11918 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11919 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11920 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11921 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11922 support &[crypt16()]&.
11924 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11925 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11926 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11927 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11928 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11930 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11931 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11932 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11934 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11935 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11936 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11937 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11938 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11940 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11941 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11942 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11943 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11944 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11945 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11947 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11949 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11950 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11952 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11953 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11954 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11955 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11956 exists in the message. For example,
11958 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11960 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11961 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11963 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11964 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11965 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11966 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11967 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11968 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11969 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11970 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11971 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11972 case is defined per the system C locale.
11974 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11975 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11976 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11977 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11978 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11979 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11980 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11981 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11983 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11985 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11987 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11988 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11989 .cindex "first delivery"
11990 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11991 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11992 .cindex retry condition
11993 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11994 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11997 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11998 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11999 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
12000 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
12001 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
12003 These conditions iterate over a list.
12005 The first argument, after any leading change-of-separator
12006 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
12007 is expanded and the whole forms the list.
12009 By default, the list separator is a colon.
12011 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
12012 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
12013 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
12015 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
12016 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
12017 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
12019 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
12020 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
12021 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
12023 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
12024 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
12025 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
12029 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
12031 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
12032 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
12034 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
12036 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12037 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12038 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12039 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
12040 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
12041 .cindex JSON expansions
12042 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
12043 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
12044 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
12045 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
12046 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
12048 The array separator is not changeable.
12049 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
12050 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
12054 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12055 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12056 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12057 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12058 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
12059 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
12060 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12061 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
12062 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
12064 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12066 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12067 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12068 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12069 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12070 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
12071 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
12072 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12073 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
12074 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
12076 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12079 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
12080 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
12083 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
12084 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
12085 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12086 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
12087 The <&'subject'&> string is expanded.
12089 The <&'list'&> first has any change-of-list-separator
12090 +(see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) retained verbatim,
12091 +then the remainder is expanded.
12093 The whole is treated as a list of simple strings;
12094 if the subject string is a member of that list, then the condition is true.
12095 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
12097 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
12098 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
12100 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
12101 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
12102 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
12103 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
12106 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12107 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12108 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12109 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
12110 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12112 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
12114 can be used for de-tainting.
12115 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12118 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12119 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12120 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
12121 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
12122 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
12123 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
12124 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
12125 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
12126 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
12127 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
12128 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
12130 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
12131 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
12132 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
12133 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
12134 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
12136 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
12137 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
12139 This is no longer the case.
12141 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
12142 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
12144 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
12146 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
12148 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
12149 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
12150 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
12151 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
12152 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
12153 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
12154 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
12155 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
12156 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
12157 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
12158 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
12159 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
12160 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
12164 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12165 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12166 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12167 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12168 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
12169 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
12170 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12171 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
12172 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
12174 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12176 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12177 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12178 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12179 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12180 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12181 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12182 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12183 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12184 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12186 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12189 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12190 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12191 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12192 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12193 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12194 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12195 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12196 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12197 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12198 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12199 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12202 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12204 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12205 backslashes is also required.
12207 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12208 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12209 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12210 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12211 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12212 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12213 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12214 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12216 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12217 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12218 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12219 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12220 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12221 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12222 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12223 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12225 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12226 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12227 See &*match_local_part*&.
12229 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12230 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12231 See &*match_local_part*&.
12233 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12234 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12235 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12236 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12237 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12238 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12240 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12242 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12245 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12247 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12249 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12250 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12251 in a single test such as
12252 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12253 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12254 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12255 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12257 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12259 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12261 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12263 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12264 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12265 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12266 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12267 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12268 masks. For example:
12270 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12272 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12273 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12274 address mask, for example:
12276 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12278 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12279 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12281 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12285 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12286 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12288 For the latter case, only the part after any leading
12289 change-of-separator specification is expanded.
12292 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12294 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12295 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12296 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12298 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12299 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12300 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12301 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12302 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12303 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12304 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12305 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12308 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12310 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12311 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12312 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12313 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12315 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12317 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12318 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12319 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items
12320 (including those of referenced named lists)
12321 to have their local parts matched casefully.
12322 Domains are always matched caselessly.
12324 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12325 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12326 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12327 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12328 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12330 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12332 can be used for de-tainting.
12333 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12335 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12336 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12338 For the latter case, only the part after any leading
12339 change-of-separator specification is expanded.
12342 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12343 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12344 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12345 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12347 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12348 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12349 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12350 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12351 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12352 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12353 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12354 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12355 available in Solaris
12356 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12357 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12358 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12362 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12363 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12365 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12366 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12367 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12368 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12369 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12370 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12371 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12373 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12374 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12376 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12377 For example, the configuration
12378 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12380 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12382 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12383 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12384 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12385 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12388 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12389 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12391 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12392 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12393 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12394 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12395 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12396 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12398 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12399 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12400 building Exim. For example:
12402 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12404 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12405 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12406 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12407 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12409 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12410 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12411 configuration, you might have this:
12413 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12415 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12417 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12419 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12420 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12421 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12422 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12423 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12424 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12427 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12429 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12430 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12431 Radius authentication
12432 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2865,RFC 2865))
12433 is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12434 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12435 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12438 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12439 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12440 this library, you need to set
12442 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12444 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12445 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12447 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12449 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12450 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12451 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12453 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12454 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12455 the authentication is successful. For example:
12457 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12461 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12462 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12463 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12465 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12466 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12467 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12468 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12469 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12470 by a process that is not running as root.
12472 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12473 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12474 building Exim. For example:
12476 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12478 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12479 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12480 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12482 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12483 two are mandatory. For example:
12485 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12487 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12488 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12489 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12494 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12495 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12496 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12497 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12498 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12499 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12500 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12504 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12505 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12506 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12507 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12508 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12511 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12513 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12514 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12515 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12517 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12518 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12519 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12520 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12521 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12522 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12523 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12524 parsed but not evaluated.
12526 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12531 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12532 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12533 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12534 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12535 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12536 .cindex "tainted data"
12537 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12538 a potential attacker.
12539 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12540 values are created.
12541 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12543 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12546 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12547 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12548 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12549 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12550 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12551 In the expansion condition case
12552 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12553 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12554 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12555 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12556 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12557 matching condition.
12558 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12560 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12561 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12562 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12563 any unused variables being made empty.
12565 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12566 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12567 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12568 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12569 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12570 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12571 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12572 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12573 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12574 during subsequent delivery.
12576 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12577 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12578 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12579 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12580 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12581 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12582 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12583 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12586 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12587 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12588 this variable has the number of arguments.
12590 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12591 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12592 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12593 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12594 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12596 warn !verify = sender
12597 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12599 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12600 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12602 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12604 .vitem &$address_data$&
12605 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12606 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12607 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12608 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12609 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12610 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12613 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12614 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12615 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12616 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12617 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12618 from the child's routing.
12620 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12621 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12622 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12625 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12626 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12627 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12629 .vitem &$address_file$&
12630 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12631 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12632 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12633 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12634 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12636 /home/r2d2/savemail
12638 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12639 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12640 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12641 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12642 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12643 to the relevant file.
12645 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12646 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12647 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12648 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12651 .vitem &$atrn_host$&
12652 .vindex ATRN "data for routing"
12653 When an ATRN command is accepted, this variable is filled in with the client
12654 IP and port, for use in a manualroute router.
12656 .vitem &$atrn_mode$&
12659 When in provider mode this variable will contain &"P"&.
12660 When in customer mode it will contain &"C"&.
12661 Otherwise, it will be empty.
12664 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12665 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12666 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12667 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12669 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12670 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12671 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12672 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12673 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12674 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12675 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12676 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12677 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12679 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12680 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12681 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12682 command line option.
12683 This second case also sets up information used by the
12684 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12686 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12687 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12688 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12689 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12690 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12691 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12692 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12693 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12694 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12698 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12699 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12700 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12701 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12702 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12703 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12704 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12705 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12706 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12707 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12709 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12710 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12711 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12712 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12713 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12716 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12717 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12718 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12719 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12720 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12721 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12722 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12723 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12724 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12725 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12726 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12727 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12729 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12730 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12731 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12732 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12733 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12734 the ACL malware condition.
12736 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12737 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12738 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12739 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12740 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12741 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12743 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12744 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12745 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12746 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12747 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12748 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12749 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12751 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12752 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12753 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12754 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12755 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12757 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12758 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12759 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12760 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12761 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12763 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12764 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12765 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12766 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12767 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12768 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12769 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12771 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12772 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12773 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12774 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12775 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12776 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12777 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12779 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12780 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12781 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12782 address that was connected to.
12784 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12785 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12786 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12787 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12788 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12790 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12791 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12792 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12793 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12794 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12795 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12797 .vitem &$config_file$&
12798 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12799 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12801 .vitem &$connection_id$&
12802 .vindex "&$connection_id$&"
12803 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
12804 An identifier for the accepted connection, for use in custom logging.
12806 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12807 Results of DKIM verification.
12808 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12810 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12811 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12812 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12813 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12814 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12816 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12817 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12818 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12819 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12820 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12821 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12822 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12823 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12824 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12825 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12826 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12827 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12828 &$dkim_key_length$&
12829 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12830 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12832 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12833 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12834 When a message has been received this variable contains
12835 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12836 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12838 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_spf$& &&&
12839 &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$& &&&
12840 &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12841 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12842 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12843 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12844 Results of DMARC verification.
12845 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12847 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12848 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12849 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12851 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12852 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12853 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12854 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12855 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12856 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12857 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12858 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12859 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12862 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12863 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12864 case for &$domain$&.
12866 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12867 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12868 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12869 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12871 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12872 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12873 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12874 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12875 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12876 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12878 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12879 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12880 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12882 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12885 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12886 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12887 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12888 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12889 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12890 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12891 the &(smtp)& transport.
12894 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12895 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12896 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12897 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12900 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12901 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12902 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12903 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12904 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12905 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12908 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12909 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12910 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12911 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12914 .cindex "tainted data"
12915 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12916 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12917 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12918 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12919 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12920 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12923 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12924 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12925 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12928 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12929 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12930 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12931 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12933 If the router routes the
12934 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12935 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12938 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12939 the rest of the ACL statement.
12941 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12942 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12943 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12945 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12946 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12947 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12949 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12950 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12951 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12953 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12954 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12955 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12956 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12957 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12958 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12959 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12961 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12963 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12964 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12965 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12966 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12967 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12969 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12970 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12971 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12972 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12973 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12977 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12978 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12979 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12980 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12981 by a setting on the transport itself.
12983 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12984 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12985 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12989 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12990 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12991 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12992 to local and remote transports.
12994 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12995 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12996 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12997 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12998 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12999 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
13000 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
13003 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
13004 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
13005 client is connected.
13008 .vitem &$host_address$&
13009 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
13010 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
13011 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
13012 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
13014 .vitem &$host_data$&
13015 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
13016 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
13017 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
13018 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
13020 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
13021 message = $host_data
13024 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13025 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
13026 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13027 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
13028 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
13029 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
13030 variables is set to &"1"&.
13033 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
13034 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13037 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
13038 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
13039 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
13042 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
13043 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
13044 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
13045 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
13046 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
13047 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
13048 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
13049 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
13050 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
13051 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
13053 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
13054 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
13055 &%authresults%& expansion item.
13058 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
13059 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13060 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
13062 .vitem &$host_port$&
13063 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
13064 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
13065 for an outbound connection.
13067 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
13068 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
13069 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
13070 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
13071 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
13072 to &$spool_directory$& later.
13075 .vindex "&$inode$&"
13076 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
13077 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
13078 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
13079 a unique name for the file.
13081 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
13083 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
13084 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
13085 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13089 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
13090 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
13091 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
13095 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
13096 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
13097 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
13100 .vitem &$load_average$&
13101 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
13102 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
13103 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
13104 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
13106 .tvar &$local_part$&
13107 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
13108 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
13109 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
13110 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
13112 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
13113 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
13114 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
13115 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
13118 .cindex "tainted data"
13119 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
13120 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
13121 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
13123 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
13125 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
13127 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
13128 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
13129 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
13130 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
13131 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
13132 rather than this variable.
13133 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
13134 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
13135 the retrieved data.
13137 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
13138 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
13139 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
13142 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
13143 local part of the recipient address.
13145 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
13146 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
13147 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
13149 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
13152 "abc:xyz"@test.example
13153 abc\:xyz@test.example
13155 the value of &$local_part$& is
13159 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
13160 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
13163 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
13165 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
13166 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
13167 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
13169 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
13170 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
13171 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
13172 matches a local part list
13173 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
13174 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
13175 applied to the data read by a lookup.
13176 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
13178 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
13180 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
13181 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
13182 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
13183 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
13184 .cindex affix variables
13185 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
13186 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
13187 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
13188 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
13189 .cindex "tainted data"
13190 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
13191 the affix variable value is not tainted.
13193 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
13194 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
13195 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
13196 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
13198 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
13199 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
13200 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
13201 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
13203 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
13204 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
13205 See &$local_user_uid$&.
13207 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
13208 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
13209 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
13210 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13211 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13212 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13213 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13214 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13216 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13217 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13218 This contains the expanded value of the
13219 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13222 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13223 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13224 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13225 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13226 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13227 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13229 .vitem &$log_space$&
13230 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13231 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13232 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13233 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13234 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13235 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13238 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13239 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13240 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13241 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13242 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13243 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13244 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13245 and &"yes"& if it was.
13246 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13247 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13248 as authenticated data.
13250 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13251 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13252 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13253 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13254 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13255 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13256 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13259 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13260 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13261 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13262 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13263 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13265 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13266 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13267 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13268 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13269 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13270 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13272 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13274 .vitem &$message_age$&
13275 .cindex "message" "age of"
13276 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13277 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13278 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13281 .tvar &$message_body$&
13282 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13283 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13284 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13285 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13286 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13287 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13288 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13289 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13291 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13292 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13293 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13294 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13295 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13297 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13298 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13299 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13300 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13301 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13304 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13305 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13306 .cindex "message body" "size"
13307 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13308 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13309 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13310 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13311 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13313 If the spool file is wireformat
13314 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13315 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13317 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13318 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13319 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13320 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13321 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13322 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13323 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13324 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13326 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13327 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13328 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13329 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13330 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13332 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13333 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13334 contents of header lines is done.
13336 .vitem &$message_id$&
13337 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13339 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13340 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13341 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13342 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13343 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13344 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13345 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13346 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13347 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13348 from the body is not counted.
13350 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13351 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13352 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13353 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13354 header and the body).
13356 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13359 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13360 message = Too many lines in message header
13362 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13363 message has not yet been received.
13365 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13367 .vitem &$message_size$&
13368 .cindex "size" "of message"
13369 .cindex "message" "size"
13370 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13371 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13372 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13373 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13374 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13375 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13376 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13377 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13378 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13380 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13381 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13382 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13383 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13385 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13386 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13387 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13388 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13389 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13390 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13391 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13392 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13393 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13394 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13395 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13396 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13397 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13398 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13399 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13400 &$mime_part_count$&
13401 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13402 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13403 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13405 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13406 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13407 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13409 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13410 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13411 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13412 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13413 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13414 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13415 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13416 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13417 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13419 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13420 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13421 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13423 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13424 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13425 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13426 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13427 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13428 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13429 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13430 the original address.
13432 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13433 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13434 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13435 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13436 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13438 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13439 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13440 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13442 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13443 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13444 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13445 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13446 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13447 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13448 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13449 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13450 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13452 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13453 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13454 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13455 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13456 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13457 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13458 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13459 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13462 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13463 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13464 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13466 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13467 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13468 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13471 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13473 This variable contains the current process id.
13475 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13476 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13477 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13478 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13479 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13480 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13481 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13482 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13483 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13484 variable"& error if encountered.
13485 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13486 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13487 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13489 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13490 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13491 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13492 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13493 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13494 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13495 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13498 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13499 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13500 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13501 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13503 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13505 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13507 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13508 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13509 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13510 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13512 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13513 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13514 &$prvscheck_result$&
13515 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13516 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13517 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13519 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13520 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13521 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13523 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13524 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13525 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13526 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13528 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13529 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13530 .cindex "named queues" variable
13531 .cindex queues named
13532 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13534 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13535 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13536 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13537 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13538 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13539 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13540 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13545 .cindex router variables
13546 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13547 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13548 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13549 and the eventual transport.
13551 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13552 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13553 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13554 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13555 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13557 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13558 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13559 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13560 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13561 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13562 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13564 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13565 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13566 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13567 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13568 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13570 .vitem &$received_count$&
13571 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13572 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13573 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13574 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13577 .tvar &$received_for$&
13578 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13579 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13580 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13581 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13583 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13585 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13586 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13587 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13588 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13589 (The remote IP address and port are in
13590 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13591 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13594 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13595 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13596 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13597 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13598 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13600 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13602 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13603 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13604 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13605 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13606 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13607 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13608 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13609 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13610 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13612 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13613 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13614 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13615 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13616 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13617 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13619 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13620 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13621 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13623 .vitem &$received_time$&
13624 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13625 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13626 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13628 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13629 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13630 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13631 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13632 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13634 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13635 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13637 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13638 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13639 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13640 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13642 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13643 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13644 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13645 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13648 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13649 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13652 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13655 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13656 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13660 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13663 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13666 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13667 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13669 .tvar &$recipients$&
13670 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13671 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13673 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13674 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13675 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13677 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13679 However, the variables
13680 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13681 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13685 In a system filter file.
13687 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13688 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13689 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13690 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13692 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13696 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13697 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13698 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13699 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13700 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13701 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13704 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13705 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13706 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13707 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13709 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13710 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13711 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13712 these variables contain the
13713 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13714 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13717 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13718 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13719 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13720 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13721 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13722 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13724 .vitem &$return_path$&
13725 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13726 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13727 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13728 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13729 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13730 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13731 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13732 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13733 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13734 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13737 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13738 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13739 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13741 .vitem &$router_name$&
13742 .cindex "router" "name"
13743 .cindex "name" "of router"
13744 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13745 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13746 this variable contains the router name.
13749 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13750 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13751 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13752 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13753 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13754 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13755 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13758 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13759 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13760 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13761 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13762 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13763 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13764 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13765 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13767 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13768 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13769 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13770 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13771 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13773 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13774 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13775 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13776 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13777 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13778 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13779 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13780 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13782 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13783 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13785 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13786 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13788 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13789 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13790 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13791 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13792 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13795 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13796 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13798 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13799 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13800 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13801 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13803 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13804 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13805 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13806 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13807 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13808 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13809 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13810 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13811 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13812 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13813 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13814 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13815 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13817 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13818 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13819 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13820 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13821 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13823 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13824 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13825 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13826 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13827 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13829 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13830 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13831 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13832 this variable contains that
13833 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13835 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13836 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13837 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13838 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13839 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13840 &$authenticated_id$&.
13842 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13843 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13844 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13845 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13846 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13847 resolver library states that both
13848 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13849 other times, this variable is false.
13851 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13852 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13853 library, by setting:
13858 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13859 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13860 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13861 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13862 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13863 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13868 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13869 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13871 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13872 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13874 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13875 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13876 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13877 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13880 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13881 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13882 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13883 other means, this variable is empty.
13885 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13886 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13887 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13888 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13889 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13890 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13891 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13893 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13894 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13895 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13896 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13898 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13899 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13900 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13903 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13904 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13905 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13906 following are true:
13909 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13911 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13912 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13913 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13915 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13916 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13917 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13919 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13920 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13921 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13923 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13924 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13925 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13926 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13928 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13930 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13931 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13935 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13936 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13937 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13938 number that was used on the remote host.
13940 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13941 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13942 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13943 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13944 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13947 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13948 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13949 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13950 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13952 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13953 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13954 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13955 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13956 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13957 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13958 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13959 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13960 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13961 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13962 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13965 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13966 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13967 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13968 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13969 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13971 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13972 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13973 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13974 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13975 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13977 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13978 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13979 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13980 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13981 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13982 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13983 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13985 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13986 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13987 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13988 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13989 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13991 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13992 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13993 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13994 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13995 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13996 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13998 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13999 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
14000 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
14001 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
14006 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
14007 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
14008 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
14009 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
14011 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
14012 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
14013 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
14014 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
14015 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
14016 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
14018 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
14019 .cindex SMTP "command history"
14020 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
14021 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
14022 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
14025 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
14026 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
14027 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
14028 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
14029 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
14030 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
14031 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
14032 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
14033 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
14034 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
14035 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
14037 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
14038 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
14039 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
14040 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
14042 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
14043 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
14044 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
14045 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
14046 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
14047 message is junk mail.
14049 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
14050 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
14052 &$spam_report$& &&&
14054 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
14055 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
14056 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
14058 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
14059 &$spf_received$& &&&
14061 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
14062 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
14063 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
14064 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
14066 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
14067 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
14068 The name of Exim's spool directory.
14070 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
14071 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14072 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
14073 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
14074 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
14075 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
14077 .vitem &$spool_space$&
14078 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14079 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
14080 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
14081 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
14082 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
14083 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
14084 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
14086 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
14088 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
14091 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
14092 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
14093 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
14094 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
14095 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
14096 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
14098 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
14099 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
14100 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
14101 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
14102 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
14103 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
14104 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
14105 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
14107 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
14108 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14111 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
14112 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
14113 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
14114 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
14115 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
14116 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
14118 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
14119 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
14120 .cindex certificate variables
14121 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14122 inbound connection when the message was received.
14123 It is only useful as the argument of a
14124 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14125 or a &%def%& condition.
14127 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
14128 when a list of more than one
14129 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
14130 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
14132 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
14133 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
14134 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14135 inbound connection when the message was received.
14136 It is only useful as the argument of a
14137 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14138 or a &%def%& condition.
14139 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14140 which is not the leaf.
14142 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
14143 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
14144 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14145 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14146 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14147 or a &%def%& condition.
14149 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
14150 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
14151 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14152 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14153 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14154 or a &%def%& condition.
14155 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14156 which is not the leaf.
14158 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
14159 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
14160 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
14161 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
14163 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
14164 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14167 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
14168 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
14169 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
14170 outbound SMTP connection was made,
14171 and &"0"& otherwise.
14173 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
14174 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14175 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
14176 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14177 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
14178 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
14179 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
14180 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
14181 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
14183 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
14184 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
14185 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
14187 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
14188 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
14189 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14191 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
14192 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
14194 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
14195 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
14196 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
14197 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
14199 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
14200 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
14201 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14203 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
14204 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
14205 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14207 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
14208 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
14209 When a message is received from a remote client connection
14210 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14212 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14213 1 No response to request
14214 2 Response not verified
14215 3 Verification failed
14216 4 Verification succeeded
14219 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14220 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14221 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14222 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14223 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14225 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14226 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14227 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14228 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14229 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14230 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14231 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14232 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14233 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14234 which is not the leaf.
14236 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14237 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14240 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14241 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14242 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14243 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14244 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14245 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14246 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14247 which is not the leaf.
14250 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14251 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14252 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14253 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14254 .cindex TLS resumption
14255 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14258 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14259 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14260 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14262 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14263 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14264 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14265 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14266 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14267 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14268 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14269 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14271 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14272 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14275 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14276 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14277 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14279 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14281 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14284 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14285 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14286 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14288 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14289 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14290 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14291 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14293 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14294 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14295 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14296 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14299 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14300 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14301 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14302 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14304 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14305 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14306 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14308 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14309 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14310 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14312 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14313 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14314 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14315 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14316 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14317 values for those that are behind (west).
14320 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14321 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14322 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14324 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14325 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14326 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14327 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14330 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14331 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14332 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14335 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14336 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14337 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14338 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14340 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14341 .cindex "transport" "name"
14342 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14343 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14344 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14347 .vindex "&$value$&"
14348 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14349 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14350 &*reduce*& expansion.
14352 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14353 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14354 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14355 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14358 .vitem &$version_number$&
14359 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14360 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14361 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14363 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14364 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14365 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14366 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14368 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14369 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14370 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14371 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14377 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14378 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14380 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14381 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14382 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14383 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14384 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14385 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14390 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14393 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14394 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14395 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14396 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14397 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14398 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14399 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14400 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14401 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14403 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14404 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14405 should usually be something like
14407 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14409 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14410 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14411 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14412 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14413 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14414 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14415 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14416 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14420 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14421 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14422 a startup when Exim is entered.
14424 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14425 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14428 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14429 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14432 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14433 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14434 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14435 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14436 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14437 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14440 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14443 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14444 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14445 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14446 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14450 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14451 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14453 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14454 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14455 with an error message of the form
14457 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14459 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14460 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14461 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14462 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14463 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14464 that was passed to &%die%&.
14467 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14468 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14469 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14472 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14474 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14475 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14476 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14478 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14479 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14480 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14481 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14483 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14484 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14485 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14486 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14487 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14488 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14489 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14492 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14493 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14494 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14495 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14496 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14497 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14498 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14499 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14500 avoided, but the output is lost.
14502 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14503 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14504 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14505 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14506 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14507 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14508 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14510 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14512 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14513 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14514 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14515 as the first subroutine argument.
14519 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14520 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14522 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14523 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14524 "Starting the daemon"
14525 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14526 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14527 .cindex "network interface"
14528 .cindex "interface" "network"
14529 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14530 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14531 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14532 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14533 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14534 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14535 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14536 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14537 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14538 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14539 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14542 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14543 and ports to listen on.
14545 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14546 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14547 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14548 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14549 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14550 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14551 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14552 as an error situation.
14554 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14555 for the outgoing connection.
14559 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14560 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14561 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14562 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14563 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14565 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14566 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14567 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14568 chapter describes how they operate.
14570 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14571 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14575 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14576 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14577 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14581 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14583 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14585 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14586 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14589 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14590 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14591 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14592 colons. For example:
14594 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14597 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14599 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14600 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14603 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14604 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14606 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14607 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14610 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14611 with a colon separator, for example:
14613 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14614 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14618 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14619 default setting contains just one port:
14621 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14623 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14624 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14625 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14626 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14627 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14631 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14632 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14633 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14634 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14635 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14636 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14638 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14640 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14642 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14644 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14648 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14649 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14650 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14651 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14652 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14653 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14656 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14657 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14658 If there are any items that do not
14659 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14660 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14661 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14662 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14666 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14669 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14671 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14672 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14673 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14677 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14678 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14679 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14680 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14681 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14682 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14683 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14684 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14685 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14686 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14687 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14688 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14689 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14692 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14693 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14694 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14696 The common use of this option is expected to be
14698 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14700 per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314).
14701 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14702 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14704 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14705 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14706 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14707 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14708 connections via the daemon.)
14713 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14714 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14715 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14716 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14717 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14718 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14719 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14720 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14722 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14724 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14725 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14726 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14727 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14728 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14729 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14731 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14733 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14734 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14735 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14736 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14737 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14739 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14740 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14741 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14742 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14743 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14744 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14745 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14746 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14747 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14748 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14749 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14750 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14752 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14753 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14754 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14755 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14756 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14760 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14761 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14763 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14764 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14766 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14767 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14768 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14769 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14771 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14773 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14775 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14777 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14778 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14780 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14781 IPv4 loopback address only:
14783 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14785 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14787 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14789 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14793 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14794 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14795 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14796 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14799 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14800 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14801 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14802 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14804 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14805 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14806 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14807 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14808 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14809 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14810 used for listening. Consider this example:
14812 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14814 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14816 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14818 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14819 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14822 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14823 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14824 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14825 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14826 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14827 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14828 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14829 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14833 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14834 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14835 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14836 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14837 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14838 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14847 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14848 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14849 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14850 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14853 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14854 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14856 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14857 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14858 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14860 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14861 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14862 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14863 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14867 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14868 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14869 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14870 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14871 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14872 listed in more than one group.
14874 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14876 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14877 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14878 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14879 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14880 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14881 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14882 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14883 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14884 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14885 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14886 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14887 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14888 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14892 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14894 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14895 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14896 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14897 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14898 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14899 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14904 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14906 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14907 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14908 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14909 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14910 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14911 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14912 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14913 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14914 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14915 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14916 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14917 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14922 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14924 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14925 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14926 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14927 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14928 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14929 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14930 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14931 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14932 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14933 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14934 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14935 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14936 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14937 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14938 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14939 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14944 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14946 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14947 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14948 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14949 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14954 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14956 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14957 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14958 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14959 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14960 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14961 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14962 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14963 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14964 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14965 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14966 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14967 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14968 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14969 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14970 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14975 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14977 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14978 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14983 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14985 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14986 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14987 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14992 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14994 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14995 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14996 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14997 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14998 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14999 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
15000 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
15001 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
15002 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
15007 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
15009 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
15010 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
15011 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
15012 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
15013 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
15014 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
15015 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15016 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
15017 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15018 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15019 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15020 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15021 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15022 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15023 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15024 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15026 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15027 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15028 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15029 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
15030 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15035 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
15037 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
15038 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
15039 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
15040 .row &%acl_smtp_atrn%& "ACL for ATRN"
15041 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
15042 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
15043 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
15044 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
15045 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
15046 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
15047 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
15048 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
15049 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
15050 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
15051 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
15052 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
15053 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
15054 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
15055 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
15056 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
15057 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
15058 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
15059 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
15060 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15062 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
15063 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
15064 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
15065 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15066 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15067 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
15068 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
15069 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
15070 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
15071 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
15072 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15073 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15074 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
15075 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
15076 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
15077 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
15078 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
15079 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15080 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
15081 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
15082 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
15083 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
15088 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
15090 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
15092 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
15094 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
15095 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
15096 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
15101 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
15103 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
15104 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
15105 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
15106 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
15107 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
15108 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15109 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
15110 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
15111 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
15112 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
15113 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
15114 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
15115 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
15116 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
15117 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
15118 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
15119 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
15120 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
15121 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
15122 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
15127 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
15129 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
15130 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
15131 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
15132 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
15133 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
15134 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
15135 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
15136 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
15141 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
15143 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15144 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15145 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
15146 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15147 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
15148 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
15149 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
15150 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
15156 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
15158 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
15165 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
15166 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
15169 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
15170 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
15171 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
15172 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
15173 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
15174 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
15175 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
15176 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15177 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15178 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
15179 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
15180 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
15181 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
15182 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
15183 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15184 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15185 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15186 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15187 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15188 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15189 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15191 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15192 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
15193 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
15194 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15195 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15196 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
15197 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
15198 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
15199 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
15200 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
15201 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
15202 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
15203 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
15204 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
15205 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15206 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15211 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15213 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15214 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15215 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15216 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15217 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15218 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15219 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15220 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15221 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15222 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15223 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15224 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15225 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15230 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15232 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15233 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15234 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15235 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15237 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15238 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15239 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15240 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15241 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15242 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15243 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15244 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15245 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15246 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15251 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15253 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15254 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15256 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15257 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15258 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15259 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15260 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15265 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15267 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15268 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15269 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15270 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15271 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15272 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15273 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15274 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15275 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15276 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15277 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15278 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15279 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15280 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15281 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15282 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15283 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15284 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15285 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15286 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15287 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15288 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15289 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15290 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15291 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15296 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15298 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15299 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15300 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15301 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15302 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15303 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15304 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15305 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15306 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15307 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15308 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15309 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15310 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15311 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15312 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15317 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15318 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15321 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15323 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15324 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15325 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15326 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15327 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15328 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15329 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15330 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15332 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15333 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15334 It now defaults to true.
15335 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15337 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15340 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15342 log_selector = +8bitmime
15345 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15346 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15347 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15348 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15349 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15352 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15353 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15354 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15357 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15358 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15359 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15360 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15361 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15364 .option acl_smtp_atrn main string&!! unset
15365 .cindex ATRN "ACL for"
15366 .cindex ATRN advertisement
15367 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ATRN
15368 .cindex ODMR provider
15369 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ATRN command is
15371 If no value is set, or the result after expansion is an empty string,
15372 then the ATRN facility is not advertised.
15373 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs,
15374 and section &<<SECTODMRPRDVR>>& for description of ATRN.
15377 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15378 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15379 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15380 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15382 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15383 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15385 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15386 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15387 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15388 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15390 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15391 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15392 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15393 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15394 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15396 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15397 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15398 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15399 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15400 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15401 This option defines the ACL that,
15402 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15403 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15404 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15405 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15407 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15408 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15409 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15410 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15411 of a received message.
15412 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15414 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15415 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15416 .cindex "ETRN" advertisement
15417 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15419 If no value is set then the ETRN facility is not advertised.
15420 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs,
15421 and section &<<SECTETRN>>& for description of ETRN.
15423 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15424 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15425 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15426 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15428 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15429 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15430 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15431 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15432 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15435 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15436 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15437 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15438 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15440 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15441 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15442 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15444 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15445 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15447 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15448 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15449 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15450 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15451 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15453 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15454 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15455 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15456 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15457 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15459 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15460 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15461 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15464 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15465 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15466 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15467 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15469 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15470 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15471 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15472 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15474 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15475 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15476 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15477 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15479 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15480 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15481 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15482 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15484 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15485 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15486 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15487 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15489 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15490 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15491 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15492 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15493 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15495 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15497 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15498 .cindex "admin user"
15499 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15500 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15501 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15502 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15503 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15504 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15505 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15507 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15508 .cindex "domain literal"
15509 If this option is set, the
15510 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
15511 domain literal format is permitted in
15512 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15513 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15514 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15516 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15517 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15518 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15519 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15520 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15521 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15522 the local host's IP addresses.
15524 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15525 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15526 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15527 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15528 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15529 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15530 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15531 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15532 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15534 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15535 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15536 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15537 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15538 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15539 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15540 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15542 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15543 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15544 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15546 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15547 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15548 this option can be left as default.
15550 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15551 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15552 suitable setting is:
15554 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15555 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15557 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15559 dns_check_names_pattern =
15561 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15564 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15565 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15566 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15567 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15568 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15569 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15570 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15571 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15572 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15573 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15574 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15575 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15577 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15578 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15579 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15580 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15581 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15582 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15584 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15585 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15586 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15587 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15589 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15591 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15592 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15593 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15594 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15597 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15598 .cindex "thawing messages"
15599 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15600 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15601 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15602 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15603 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15604 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15606 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15607 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15608 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15611 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15612 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15613 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15615 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15617 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15618 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15621 .option bi_command main string unset
15623 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15624 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15625 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15626 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15629 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15630 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15631 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15632 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15633 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15634 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15635 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15636 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15637 absolute and untainted.
15638 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15641 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15642 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15643 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15644 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15646 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15647 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15648 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15649 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15650 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15651 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15652 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15653 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15654 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15655 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15657 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15658 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15659 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15660 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15661 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15662 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15663 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15664 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15665 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15666 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15668 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15669 during reception of a message.
15670 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15672 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15675 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15676 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15677 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15678 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15681 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15682 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15683 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15684 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15685 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15686 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15687 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15688 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15689 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15691 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15692 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15693 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15694 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15695 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15698 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15699 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15700 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15701 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15702 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15703 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15704 connection. A typical setting might be:
15706 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15708 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15710 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15712 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15715 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15716 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15717 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15718 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15719 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15720 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15723 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15724 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15725 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15726 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15729 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15730 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15731 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15732 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15735 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15736 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15737 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15738 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15741 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15742 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15743 callout verification. The default value is
15745 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15747 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15750 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15751 check_log_space main integer 10M
15752 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15754 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15755 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15756 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15757 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047)
15758 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15759 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15760 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15761 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15762 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15763 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15764 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15767 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15768 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15769 .cindex "checking disk space"
15770 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15771 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15772 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15773 message is accepted.
15775 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15776 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15777 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15778 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15779 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15780 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15781 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15782 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15785 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15786 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15788 check_spool_space = 100M
15789 check_spool_inodes = 100
15791 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15792 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15795 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15796 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15797 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15799 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15800 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15801 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15802 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15803 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15804 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15806 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15807 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15808 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15810 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15811 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15812 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15814 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15815 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15816 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15817 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15819 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15820 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15821 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15822 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15823 The CHUNKING extension
15824 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3030.html,RFC 3030))
15825 will be advertised in the EHLO message to these hosts.
15826 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15828 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15829 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15830 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15831 administrative user.
15832 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15834 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15835 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15836 .cindex memory debugging
15837 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15838 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15839 it should normally be left as default.
15841 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15842 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15843 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15844 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15845 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15846 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15848 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15849 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15850 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15851 These options control the retrying done by
15852 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15853 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15854 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15855 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15857 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15858 .cindex "warning of delay"
15859 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15860 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15861 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15862 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15863 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15864 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15865 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15866 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15869 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15871 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15872 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15873 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15874 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15878 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15879 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15881 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15883 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15884 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15885 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15887 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15888 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15889 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15890 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15891 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15892 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15893 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15894 not sent. The default is:
15896 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15897 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15898 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15899 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15902 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15903 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15904 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15905 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15907 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15908 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15909 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15910 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15911 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15912 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15913 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15914 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15916 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15917 .cindex "load average"
15918 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15919 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15920 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15921 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15922 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15925 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15926 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15927 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15928 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15929 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15930 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15931 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15932 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15934 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15935 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15936 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15937 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15938 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15939 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15940 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15941 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15943 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15944 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15945 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15946 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15949 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15950 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15951 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15952 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15953 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15954 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15955 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15958 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15959 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15960 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15961 and an order of processing.
15962 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15964 Acceptable values include:
15971 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates
15972 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301).
15974 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15975 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15976 and an order of processing.
15977 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15980 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15981 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15982 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15983 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15985 The default enforces the
15986 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
15987 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15989 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15990 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15993 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15994 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15995 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15996 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15997 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15998 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
16001 .options dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
16002 dmarc_history_file main string&!! unset &&&
16003 dmarc_tld_file main string&!! unset
16004 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
16005 These options control DMARC processing.
16006 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
16009 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
16010 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
16011 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
16012 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
16013 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
16014 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
16015 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
16016 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
16017 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
16018 by a setting such as this:
16020 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
16022 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
16023 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
16024 is security-relevant).
16025 It also applies when the
16026 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
16027 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
16028 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
16029 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
16030 options are applied after this global option.
16032 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
16033 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
16034 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
16035 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
16036 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
16037 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
16038 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
16039 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
16040 value of this option. The default pattern is
16042 dns_check_names_pattern = \
16043 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
16045 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
16046 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
16047 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
16048 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
16049 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
16052 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
16053 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
16054 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
16056 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
16057 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
16058 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
16059 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
16061 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
16062 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
16063 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
16064 not do it internally.
16065 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
16066 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
16068 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
16069 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
16070 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
16073 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
16074 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16075 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16076 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16077 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
16078 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
16080 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
16082 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
16083 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
16084 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
16085 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
16086 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
16087 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
16093 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
16094 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
16095 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
16096 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
16097 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
16098 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
16099 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
16100 domain matches this list.
16102 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
16103 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
16104 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
16105 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
16106 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
16107 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
16110 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
16111 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16112 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
16113 .cindex "DNS" timeout
16114 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
16115 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
16116 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
16117 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
16118 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
16119 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
16120 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
16121 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
16123 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
16126 .option dns_retry main integer 0
16127 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
16130 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
16131 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16132 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16133 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
16134 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
16135 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
16136 match with this expanded domain list.
16138 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
16139 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
16140 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
16141 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
16142 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
16143 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
16145 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
16146 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
16147 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
16149 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
16150 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
16151 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
16152 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
16153 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
16155 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16156 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
16157 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16158 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
16159 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
16160 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16161 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
16162 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
16165 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
16167 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
16168 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
16169 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
16172 .option drop_cr main boolean false
16173 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
16174 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
16175 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
16177 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16178 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
16179 .cindex "DSN" "success"
16180 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
16181 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
16182 DSN extensions (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461))
16183 will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
16184 and accepted from, these hosts.
16185 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
16186 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
16187 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
16188 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
16190 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
16191 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
16193 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
16194 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
16195 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
16196 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
16197 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
16198 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
16200 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
16202 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
16203 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
16205 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
16206 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
16207 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
16208 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
16209 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
16210 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
16211 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
16212 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
16213 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
16216 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
16217 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
16218 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
16219 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
16220 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
16221 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
16222 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
16223 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
16224 must be enclosed in double quotes.
16226 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
16227 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
16228 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
16229 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
16230 are examined. For example:
16232 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
16233 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
16234 postmaster@mydomain.example
16236 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16237 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16238 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16239 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16240 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16241 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16242 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16245 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16246 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16247 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16249 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16251 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16252 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16253 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16254 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16255 overrides the default.
16257 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16258 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16259 and warning messages. For example:
16261 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16263 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid
16264 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
16265 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16266 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16267 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16271 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16273 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16274 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16277 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16278 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16279 .cindex "Exim group"
16280 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16281 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16282 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16283 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16284 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16288 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16289 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16290 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16291 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16292 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16293 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16295 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16296 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16297 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16298 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16301 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16302 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16303 .cindex "Exim user"
16304 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16305 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16306 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16307 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16309 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16310 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16311 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16312 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16315 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16316 .cindex "Exim version"
16317 .cindex customizing "version number"
16318 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16319 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16320 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16323 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16324 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16325 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16326 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16329 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16330 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16332 . .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments"
16333 . but apparently this results in searchability problems; bug 1197
16335 .option extract_addresses_remove_arguments main boolean true
16337 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16338 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16339 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16340 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16341 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16342 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16343 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16344 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16345 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16346 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16350 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16351 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16352 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16353 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16354 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16355 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16356 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16357 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16360 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16361 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16362 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16363 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16367 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16368 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16369 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16370 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16371 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16372 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16373 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16374 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16375 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16376 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16377 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16378 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16379 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16380 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16381 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16382 logging that you require.
16385 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16386 gecos_pattern main string unset
16388 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16389 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16390 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16391 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16392 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16393 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16394 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16395 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16397 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16398 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16399 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16402 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16403 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16404 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16405 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16407 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16412 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16413 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16414 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16415 implementations of TLS.
16418 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16419 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16420 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16423 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16428 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16429 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16430 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16431 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16432 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16433 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16437 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16438 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16439 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16440 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16441 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16442 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16443 sections are rejected.
16446 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16447 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16448 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16449 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16450 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16451 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16452 zero means &"no limit"&.
16457 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16458 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16459 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16460 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16461 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16462 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16463 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16464 if you want to do semantic checking.
16465 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16469 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16470 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16471 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16472 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16473 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16474 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16475 hyphens, and dots. For example if you really must allow underscores,
16478 helo_allow_chars = _
16480 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16481 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16484 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16485 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16486 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16487 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16488 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16489 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16490 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16494 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16495 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16496 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16497 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16498 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16499 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16500 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16501 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16502 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16503 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16504 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16505 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16507 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16508 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16509 EHLO command either:
16512 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16514 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16515 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16516 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16517 calling host address, or
16519 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16522 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16523 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16524 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16526 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16527 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16528 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16530 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16531 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16532 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16533 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16534 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16535 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16536 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16537 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16538 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16541 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16542 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16543 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16544 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16545 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16546 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16547 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16548 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16549 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16551 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16552 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16553 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16554 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16555 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16557 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16558 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16559 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16560 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16563 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16564 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16565 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16566 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16567 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16568 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16569 default configuration file contains
16573 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16574 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16576 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16577 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16578 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16580 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16581 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16582 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16583 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16584 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16585 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16588 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16589 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16590 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16591 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16592 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16595 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16596 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16597 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16598 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16602 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16603 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16604 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16605 as soon as the connection is made.
16606 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16607 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16608 connections immediately.
16610 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16611 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16613 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16614 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16615 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16616 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16617 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16620 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16621 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16622 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16623 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16624 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16625 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16626 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16627 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16628 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16630 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16632 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16633 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16636 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16637 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16639 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16640 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16641 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16642 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16643 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16645 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16646 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16649 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16650 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16651 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16652 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16655 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16656 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16657 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16658 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16661 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16662 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16663 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16664 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16665 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16667 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16668 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16670 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16671 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16672 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16673 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16674 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16675 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16676 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16679 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16680 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16681 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16682 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16683 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16687 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16688 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16689 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16690 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16691 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16692 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16694 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16695 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16696 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16697 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16698 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16699 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16700 for frozen messages. For example,
16702 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16704 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16705 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16706 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16707 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16708 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16709 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16712 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16713 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16714 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16715 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16716 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16717 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16718 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16719 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16720 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16721 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16722 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16726 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16727 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16728 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16729 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16730 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16731 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16732 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16733 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16734 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16736 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16737 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16739 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16740 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16741 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16742 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16744 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16745 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16746 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16749 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16750 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16751 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16755 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16756 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16757 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16758 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16762 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16763 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16764 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16765 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16766 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16767 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16768 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16769 and constrained to be a directory.
16772 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16773 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16774 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16775 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16776 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16777 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16778 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16779 and constrained to be a file.
16782 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16783 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16784 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16785 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16786 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16787 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16790 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16791 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16792 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16793 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16794 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16795 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16796 identity to be proven.
16799 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16800 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16801 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16802 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16803 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16806 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16807 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16808 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16809 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16810 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16814 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16815 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16816 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16817 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16818 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16819 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16823 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16824 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16825 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16826 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16827 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16829 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16830 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16831 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16834 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16835 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16836 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16837 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16838 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16839 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16840 has been built with LDAP support.
16844 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16845 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16846 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16847 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16848 LIMITS extension (&url(https://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc9422.html,RFC 9422))
16850 If permitted, Exim as a server will advertise in the EHLO response
16851 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16852 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16855 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16856 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16857 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16858 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16859 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16860 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16861 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16863 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16864 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16865 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16867 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16868 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16869 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16870 and the default qualify domain.
16872 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16873 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16874 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16875 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16877 .cindex "envelope from"
16878 .cindex "envelope sender"
16879 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16880 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16881 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16883 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16884 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16885 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16890 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16891 local_from_suffix main string unset
16892 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16893 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16894 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16895 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16896 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16897 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16900 local_from_prefix = *-
16902 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16904 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16906 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16907 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16911 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16912 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16913 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16914 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16915 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16916 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16917 &%local_interfaces%& is
16919 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16921 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16923 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16926 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16927 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16928 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16929 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16930 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16931 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16932 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16933 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16937 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16938 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16939 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16940 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16941 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16942 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16943 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16944 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16949 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16950 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16951 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16952 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16953 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16954 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16955 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16956 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16957 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16958 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16959 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16960 each host must set a different
16961 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16962 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16963 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16964 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16965 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16966 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16967 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16968 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16969 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16973 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16974 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16975 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16976 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16977 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16978 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16979 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16980 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16981 A path must start with a slash.
16982 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16983 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16984 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16985 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16986 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16987 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16988 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16989 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16992 .option log_selector main string unset
16993 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16994 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16995 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16996 minus characters. For example:
16998 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
17000 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
17001 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
17004 .option log_timezone main boolean false
17005 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
17006 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
17007 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
17008 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
17009 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
17010 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
17011 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
17012 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
17013 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
17014 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
17015 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
17016 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
17019 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
17020 .cindex "too many open files"
17021 .cindex "open files, too many"
17022 .cindex "file" "too many open"
17023 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
17024 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
17025 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
17026 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
17027 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
17028 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
17029 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
17030 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
17031 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
17032 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
17033 &%lookup_open_max%&.
17036 .option max_username_length main integer 0
17037 .cindex "length of login name"
17038 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
17039 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
17040 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
17041 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
17042 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
17043 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
17046 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
17047 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
17048 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
17049 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
17050 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
17051 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
17052 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
17053 option is set true, this no longer happens.
17056 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
17057 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
17058 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
17059 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
17060 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
17061 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
17062 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
17065 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
17066 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
17067 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
17068 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
17069 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
17070 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
17071 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
17072 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
17073 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
17074 empty string, the option is ignored.
17077 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
17078 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
17079 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
17080 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by
17081 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17082 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
17083 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
17084 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
17085 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
17086 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
17087 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
17088 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
17089 colons will become hyphens.
17092 .option message_logs main boolean true
17093 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
17094 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
17095 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
17096 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
17097 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
17098 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
17099 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
17100 which is not affected by this option.
17103 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
17104 .cindex "message" "size limit"
17105 .cindex "limit" "message size"
17106 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
17107 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
17108 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
17109 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
17110 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
17111 optionally followed by K or M.
17113 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17114 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
17115 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
17116 service extension keyword.
17118 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
17119 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
17120 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
17121 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
17122 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17124 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
17125 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
17126 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
17127 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
17128 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
17129 message that an individual transport can process.
17131 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
17132 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
17133 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
17134 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
17135 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
17136 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
17137 some problems may result.
17139 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
17140 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
17141 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
17144 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
17145 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
17146 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
17148 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
17150 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
17151 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
17152 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
17153 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
17154 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
17157 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
17158 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
17159 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
17160 contains a full description of this facility.
17164 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
17165 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
17166 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
17167 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
17168 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
17171 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
17172 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
17173 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
17174 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
17175 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
17178 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
17179 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
17180 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
17181 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
17182 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
17184 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
17185 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
17188 never_users = root:daemon:bin
17190 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
17191 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
17195 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
17196 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
17197 listens for work and information-requests.
17198 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
17199 should need to modify the default.
17201 The option is expanded before use.
17202 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
17203 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
17205 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
17208 If this option is set as empty,
17209 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
17210 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
17211 then a notifier socket is not created.
17214 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
17215 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
17216 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
17217 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
17218 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
17220 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
17221 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
17222 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
17223 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
17224 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
17225 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
17226 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
17228 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
17229 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
17230 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
17231 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
17232 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
17234 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
17236 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
17237 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
17238 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
17239 some now infamous attacks.
17243 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17244 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17245 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17247 # Disable older protocol versions:
17248 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17251 Possible options may include:
17255 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17257 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17259 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17263 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17265 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17267 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17269 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17271 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17273 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17277 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17291 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17295 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17297 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17299 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17301 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17305 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17308 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17309 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17310 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17311 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17312 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17313 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17316 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17317 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17318 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17319 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17320 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17323 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17324 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17325 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17326 to terminate the process
17327 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17328 then a coredump is requested.
17330 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17331 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17332 common installed configuration.
17334 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17335 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17336 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17337 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17338 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17339 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17340 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17342 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17343 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17344 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17345 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17348 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17349 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17350 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17351 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17352 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17353 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17354 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17357 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17358 perl_startup main string unset
17360 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17361 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17363 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17365 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17368 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17369 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17370 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17371 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17372 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17373 PostgreSQL support.
17376 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17377 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17378 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17379 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17380 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17383 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17385 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17387 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17388 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17389 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17392 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17393 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17394 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17395 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17396 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17397 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17398 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17399 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17400 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17401 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17403 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17404 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17405 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17406 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17407 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17408 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17409 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17410 commands are acceptable.
17411 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17413 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17415 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17416 it permits the client to pipeline
17417 TCP connection and hello command (cleatext phase),
17418 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17419 on later connections to the same host.
17422 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17423 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17424 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17425 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17426 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17427 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17428 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17429 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17430 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17432 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17433 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17434 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17435 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17436 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17437 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17438 volume of mail. Use with care!
17441 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17442 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17443 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17444 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17445 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17446 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17447 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17448 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17449 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17450 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17452 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17453 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17454 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17455 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17456 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17457 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17460 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17461 .cindex "printing characters"
17462 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17463 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17464 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17465 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17466 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17467 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17470 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17471 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses
17472 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) encoding of
17473 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17474 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17475 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17479 .option process_log_path main string unset
17480 .cindex "process log path"
17481 .cindex "log" "process log"
17482 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17483 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17484 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17485 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17486 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17487 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17488 different spool directories.
17491 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17492 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17496 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17497 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17498 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17501 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17502 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17503 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17504 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17507 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17508 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17509 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17510 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17511 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17512 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17513 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17514 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17515 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17517 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17518 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17519 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17520 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17521 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17522 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17523 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17526 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17527 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17528 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17532 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17533 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17534 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17535 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17536 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17537 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17538 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17539 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17542 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17543 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17544 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17545 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17546 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17547 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17548 routed for a single host.
17551 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17552 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17554 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17555 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17556 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17557 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17560 .option queue_only main boolean false
17561 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17562 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17563 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17564 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17565 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17566 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17568 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17569 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17570 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17571 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17574 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17575 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17576 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17577 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17578 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17579 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17580 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17581 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17582 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17584 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17586 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17587 &_/some/file_& exists.
17590 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17591 .cindex "load average"
17592 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17593 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17594 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17595 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17596 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17597 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17598 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17601 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17602 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17603 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17604 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17607 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17608 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17609 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17610 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17611 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17612 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17613 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17614 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17615 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17616 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17617 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17618 re-evaluated for each message.
17621 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17622 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17623 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17624 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17625 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17626 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17629 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17630 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17631 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17632 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17633 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17634 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17635 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17636 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17637 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17638 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17639 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17640 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17641 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17645 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17646 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17647 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17648 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17649 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17650 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17651 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17652 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17653 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17655 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17656 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17657 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17658 the daemon's command line.
17660 .cindex queues named
17661 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17662 To set limits for different named queues use
17663 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17665 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17666 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17667 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17668 .cindex "first pass routing"
17669 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17670 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17671 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17672 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17673 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17674 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17675 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17676 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17677 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17678 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17682 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17683 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17684 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17685 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17686 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17687 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17688 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17690 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17691 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17692 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17693 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17694 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17695 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17696 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17697 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17698 &"Received:"& and conform to the
17699 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17700 specification for &'Received:'& header lines.
17701 The default setting is:
17704 received_header_text = Received: \
17705 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17706 {${if def:sender_ident \
17707 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17708 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17709 by $primary_hostname \
17710 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17711 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17712 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17713 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17714 ${if def:sender_address \
17715 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17716 id $message_exim_id\
17717 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17720 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17721 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17722 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17723 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17724 header lines such as the following:
17726 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17727 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17728 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17729 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17730 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17731 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17732 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17734 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17735 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17736 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17737 message was accepted.
17740 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17741 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17742 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17743 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17744 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17745 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17746 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17747 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17750 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17751 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17752 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17753 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17754 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17755 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17756 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17757 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17758 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17759 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17760 option was not set.
17763 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17764 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17765 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17766 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17767 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17768 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17769 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17770 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17771 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17774 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17775 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17776 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17777 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17778 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17781 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17782 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17783 RCPT commands in a single message.
17786 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17787 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17788 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17789 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17790 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17791 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17792 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17795 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17796 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17797 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17798 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17799 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17800 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17801 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17802 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17803 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17804 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17805 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17806 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17807 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17808 tagged with its process id.
17810 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17811 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17812 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17813 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17816 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17817 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17819 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17820 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17821 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17822 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17823 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17824 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17825 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17826 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17827 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17828 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17829 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17831 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17832 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17833 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17834 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17837 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17838 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17839 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17840 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17841 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17843 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17845 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17846 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17849 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17850 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17851 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17852 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17853 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17857 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17858 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17859 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17860 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17861 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17862 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17863 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17867 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17868 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17869 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821), section 4.4,
17870 states that an SMTP server must insert a
17871 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17872 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17873 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17874 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17875 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17876 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17877 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17880 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17881 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17884 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17886 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17887 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17888 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17889 an item in the list.
17890 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17893 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17894 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17895 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17896 This sets the timeout on
17897 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17898 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17899 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17902 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17903 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17904 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17905 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17906 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17907 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17908 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17909 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17910 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17911 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17914 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17915 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17916 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17917 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17918 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17919 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17920 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17924 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17925 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17926 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17927 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17928 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17929 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17930 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17931 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17932 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17933 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17934 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17938 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17939 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17940 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17942 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17943 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17944 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17945 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17946 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17947 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17949 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17950 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17951 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17952 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17955 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17956 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17957 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17958 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17959 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17960 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17961 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17962 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17964 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17965 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17966 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17967 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17968 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17969 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17970 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17971 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17974 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17975 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17976 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17977 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17981 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17982 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17983 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17984 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17985 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17986 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17987 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17988 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17989 . the option name to split.
17991 .option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer&!! 1000
17992 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17993 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17994 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17995 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17996 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17997 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17998 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
18000 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
18001 and may depend on values available at that time.
18002 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
18005 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
18006 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
18007 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
18008 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
18009 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
18010 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
18011 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
18012 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
18013 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
18014 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
18015 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
18017 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
18018 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
18019 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
18020 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
18021 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
18022 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
18026 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
18027 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
18028 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
18029 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
18030 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
18031 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
18032 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
18033 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
18034 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
18035 to all messages received in the same connection.
18037 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
18038 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
18039 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
18040 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
18043 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
18045 .option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
18046 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
18047 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
18048 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
18049 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
18050 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
18051 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
18052 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
18053 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
18054 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
18055 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
18056 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
18059 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
18060 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
18061 .cindex "host" "reserved"
18062 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
18063 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
18064 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
18065 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
18066 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
18067 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
18068 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
18069 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
18072 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
18073 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
18074 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
18075 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
18078 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
18079 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
18080 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
18081 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
18082 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
18083 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
18084 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
18085 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
18086 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
18088 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
18089 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
18090 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
18091 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
18093 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
18094 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
18095 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
18096 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
18097 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
18100 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
18101 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
18104 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
18105 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
18106 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
18107 &%helo_data%& value.
18109 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
18110 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
18111 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
18112 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
18113 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
18114 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
18115 This facility is only available on Linux.
18117 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
18118 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
18119 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
18120 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
18121 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
18122 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
18123 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
18124 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
18126 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
18127 $version_number $tod_full
18129 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
18130 a forced fail just closes the connection.
18131 If you want to create a
18132 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
18133 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
18134 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
18135 multiline response).
18138 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
18139 .cindex "checking disk space"
18140 .cindex "disk space, checking"
18141 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
18142 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
18143 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
18144 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
18145 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
18146 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
18149 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
18150 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
18151 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
18152 .cindex "backlog of connections"
18153 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
18154 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
18155 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
18156 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
18157 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
18158 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
18159 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
18160 attacks by SYN flooding.
18163 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
18164 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
18165 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
18166 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
18167 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
18168 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
18169 fewer, but they still exist.
18171 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
18172 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
18173 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
18174 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
18175 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
18176 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
18177 does detect many instances.
18179 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
18180 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
18181 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
18182 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
18186 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
18187 .cindex ETRN "command to be run"
18188 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
18189 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18190 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
18191 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
18192 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
18193 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
18194 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
18197 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
18198 $sender_host_address
18200 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
18201 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
18202 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
18203 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
18205 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
18206 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
18207 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
18208 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
18209 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
18213 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
18214 .cindex ETRN serializing
18215 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
18216 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
18217 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
18220 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
18221 .cindex "load average"
18222 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
18223 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
18224 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
18225 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
18226 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
18227 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
18231 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
18232 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
18233 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
18234 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
18235 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
18237 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
18239 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
18240 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
18241 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
18242 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
18243 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
18245 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
18246 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
18247 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
18248 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18249 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18250 not count towards the limit.
18254 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18255 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18256 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18257 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18258 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18261 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18262 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18266 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18267 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18268 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18269 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18270 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18271 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18272 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18273 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18276 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18277 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18278 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18279 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18281 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18282 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18283 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18284 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18288 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18290 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18291 fractional parts are allowed here.
18293 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18295 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18296 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18299 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18300 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18302 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18303 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18305 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18306 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18307 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18308 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18312 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18313 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18314 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18315 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18316 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18317 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18318 the message is abandoned.
18319 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18321 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18322 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18324 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18325 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18327 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18328 expanded before use and may depend on
18329 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18333 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18334 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18335 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18336 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18337 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18340 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18341 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18342 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18345 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18346 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18347 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18348 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18349 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18350 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18351 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18352 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18353 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18354 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18356 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18357 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18361 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18362 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18363 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18364 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18365 the availability thereof is advertised in
18366 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18367 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18370 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18371 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18372 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18373 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18377 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18378 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18379 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18381 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18382 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18383 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18384 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18385 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18386 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18387 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18388 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18392 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18394 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18396 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18398 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18400 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18402 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18404 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18406 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18408 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18410 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18412 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18414 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18415 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18418 A note on using Exim variables: As
18419 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18420 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18423 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18424 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18425 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18426 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18427 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18428 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18429 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18430 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18431 arrival of the message.
18433 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18434 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18435 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18436 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18437 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18439 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18440 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18441 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18442 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18443 automatically deleted.
18445 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18446 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18447 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18448 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18449 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18450 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18451 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18452 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18453 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18456 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18457 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18458 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18459 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18460 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18461 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18462 &$primary_hostname$&.
18464 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18465 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18466 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18467 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18468 as failures in the configuration file.
18470 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18471 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18473 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18474 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18475 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18476 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18477 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18478 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18481 The following variables will not have useful values:
18483 $max_received_linelength
18488 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18489 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18490 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18491 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18493 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18494 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18495 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18497 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18498 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18499 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18500 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18502 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18503 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18504 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18505 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18506 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18507 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18509 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18510 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18511 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18512 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18513 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18514 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18515 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18518 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18519 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18520 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18521 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18522 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18523 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18524 domain causes a syntax error.
18525 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18529 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18530 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18531 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18532 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18533 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18534 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18535 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18536 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18537 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18538 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18539 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18540 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18543 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18544 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18545 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18546 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18547 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18548 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18549 details of Exim's logging.
18552 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18553 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18554 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18555 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18556 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18557 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18558 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18562 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18563 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18564 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18565 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18566 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18570 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18571 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18572 .cindex timestamps syslog
18573 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18574 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18575 details of Exim's logging.
18578 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18579 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18580 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18581 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18582 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18583 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18584 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18585 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18586 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18587 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18588 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18589 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18592 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18593 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18594 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18595 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18596 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18597 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18600 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18601 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18602 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18603 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18604 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18606 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18607 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18608 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18609 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18610 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18612 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18613 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18614 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18615 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18616 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18617 contains the pipe command.
18620 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18621 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18622 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18623 is used in a system filter.
18626 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18627 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18628 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18629 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18630 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18631 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18632 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18633 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18634 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18635 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18637 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18638 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18639 transport option overrides.
18642 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18643 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18644 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18645 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18646 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18647 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18648 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18649 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18650 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18651 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18652 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18653 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18657 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18658 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18659 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18660 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18661 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18662 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18663 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18664 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18665 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18666 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18668 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18669 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18670 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18673 .option timezone main string unset
18674 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18675 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18676 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18677 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18678 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18679 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18683 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18684 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18685 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18686 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18687 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18688 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18691 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18692 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18693 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18694 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18695 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18696 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18697 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18698 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18699 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18700 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18701 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18702 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18705 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18706 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18708 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18709 If this option is set,
18710 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18711 and the client offers either more than one
18712 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18713 the TLS connection is declined.
18716 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18717 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18718 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18719 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18720 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18721 Commonly only one file is needed.
18722 The server's private key is also
18723 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18724 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18726 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18727 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18728 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18729 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18731 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18732 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18734 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18735 when a list of more than one
18736 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18737 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18739 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18740 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18741 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18742 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18743 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18745 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18747 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18748 generated fresh for every connection.
18750 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18751 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18752 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18753 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18754 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18756 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18758 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18759 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18760 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18762 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18765 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18766 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18767 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18768 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18769 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18770 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18772 The value must be at least 1024.
18774 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18775 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18776 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18778 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18781 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18782 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18783 larger prime than requested.
18786 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18787 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18788 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18789 to be used by Exim.
18791 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18792 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18793 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18794 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18796 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18797 then it names a file from which DH
18798 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18799 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18800 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18801 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18802 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18803 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18805 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18808 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18809 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18810 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18811 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18813 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18814 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18816 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18817 2.2 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18818 "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18819 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18821 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18822 of DH primes specified in
18823 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2409,RFC 2409),
18824 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3526,RFC 3526),
18825 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18826 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919), or from other
18827 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18828 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18829 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18831 The available standard primes are:
18832 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18833 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18834 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18835 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18837 The available additional primes are:
18838 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18840 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18841 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18842 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18843 of the later IKE values, which led into
18844 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919)
18845 providing new fixed constants (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18847 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18848 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18849 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18850 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by
18851 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8247,RFC 8247)
18852 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18854 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18855 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18856 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18857 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18859 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18860 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18861 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18862 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18863 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18866 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18867 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18868 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18869 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18870 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18871 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18872 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18875 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18876 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18877 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18878 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18879 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18880 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18882 After expansion it must contain
18883 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18884 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18885 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18887 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18888 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18889 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18891 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18894 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18895 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18896 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18898 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18899 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18900 Certificate Authority.
18902 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18903 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18905 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18906 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18907 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18908 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18909 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18911 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18912 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18914 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18915 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18916 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18917 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18918 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18919 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18920 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18922 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18923 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18924 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18925 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18927 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18930 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18931 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18932 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18933 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18937 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18938 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18939 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18940 files which contains the server's private keys.
18941 If this option is unset, or if
18942 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18943 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18944 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18946 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18949 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18950 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18951 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18952 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18953 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18954 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18958 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18959 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18960 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18961 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18962 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18963 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18964 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18965 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18966 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18967 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18968 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18971 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18972 .cindex TLS resumption
18973 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18974 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18977 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18978 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18979 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18980 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18983 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18984 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18985 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18986 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18988 or the absolute path to
18989 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18990 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18992 The "system" value for the option will use a
18993 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18994 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18995 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18998 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18999 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
19001 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
19003 either by file or directory
19004 are added to those given by the system default location.
19006 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
19007 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
19008 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
19009 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
19010 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
19011 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
19012 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
19013 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
19015 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
19017 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
19021 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
19022 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
19023 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
19024 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
19025 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
19026 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
19027 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
19028 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
19030 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
19031 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
19032 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
19034 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
19035 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
19036 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
19037 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
19039 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
19040 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
19041 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
19042 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
19043 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
19044 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
19045 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
19048 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
19052 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
19053 .cindex "trusted groups"
19054 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
19055 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
19056 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
19057 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
19058 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
19059 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
19060 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
19063 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
19064 .cindex "trusted users"
19065 .cindex "user" "trusted"
19066 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
19067 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
19068 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
19069 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
19070 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
19071 Exim user are trusted.
19073 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
19074 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
19075 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
19076 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
19077 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
19078 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
19079 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
19080 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
19081 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
19084 .option unknown_username main string unset
19085 See &%unknown_login%&.
19087 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
19088 .cindex "trusted users"
19089 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
19090 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
19091 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
19092 .cindex "envelope from"
19093 .cindex "envelope sender"
19094 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
19095 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
19096 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
19097 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
19098 is used) is ignored.
19100 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
19101 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
19103 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
19105 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
19106 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
19107 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
19108 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
19109 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
19110 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
19111 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
19112 followed by a hyphen
19113 by a setting like this:
19115 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
19117 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
19118 restriction, you can use
19120 untrusted_set_sender = *
19122 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
19123 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
19124 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
19125 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
19126 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
19127 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
19128 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
19129 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
19131 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
19132 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
19133 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
19134 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
19138 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
19139 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19140 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
19141 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
19142 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
19143 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
19144 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
19145 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
19146 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
19147 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
19149 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
19150 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
19152 The pattern can be seen by running
19154 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
19156 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
19157 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
19158 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
19159 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
19160 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
19161 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
19164 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
19165 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
19168 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
19169 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
19170 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
19171 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
19172 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
19173 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
19174 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
19175 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
19176 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
19177 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
19178 absolute and untainted.
19179 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
19182 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
19183 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
19184 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
19185 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
19186 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
19188 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
19189 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
19190 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
19191 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
19192 .ecindex IIDconfima
19193 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
19198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19201 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
19202 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
19203 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
19204 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
19205 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
19207 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
19208 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
19209 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
19210 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
19211 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
19213 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
19214 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
19218 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
19219 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
19220 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
19221 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
19222 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
19223 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
19224 delivery of the address to be deferred.
19226 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19227 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
19228 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
19229 routers, and the eventual transport.
19231 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
19232 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
19233 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
19234 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
19235 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
19237 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
19238 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
19239 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
19240 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
19241 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
19243 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
19244 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
19245 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
19247 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
19249 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
19251 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
19253 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
19254 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19256 See also the &%set%& option below.
19258 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19259 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19260 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19261 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19262 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19263 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19264 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19268 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19270 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19271 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19272 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19273 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19274 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19279 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19280 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19281 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19282 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19283 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19284 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19285 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19286 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19287 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19288 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19291 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19293 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19296 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19298 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19299 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19300 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19301 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19304 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19305 .cindex "case of local parts"
19306 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19307 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19308 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19309 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19310 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19311 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19312 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19315 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19316 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19317 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19318 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19319 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19320 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19321 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19322 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19323 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19325 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19326 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19327 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19328 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19332 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19333 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19334 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19335 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19337 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19338 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19339 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19340 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19341 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19343 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19344 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19345 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19346 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19347 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19348 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19349 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19350 the router is skipped.
19352 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19353 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19354 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19355 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19356 setting to achieve this. For example:
19358 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19360 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19361 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19362 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19366 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19367 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19368 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19369 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19370 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19371 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19372 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19373 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19375 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19376 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19378 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19379 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19381 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19382 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19383 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19385 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19387 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19389 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19392 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19394 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19395 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19399 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19400 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19401 be specified using &%condition%&.
19403 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19404 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19405 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19406 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19407 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19408 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19409 Router rules processing behavior.
19411 This is best illustrated in an example:
19413 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19414 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19416 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19419 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19422 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19423 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19424 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19425 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19426 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19427 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19428 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19429 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19431 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19432 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19433 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19434 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19437 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19438 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19439 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19440 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19441 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19444 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19445 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19446 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19447 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19448 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19449 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19450 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19451 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19452 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19453 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19454 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19455 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19456 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19457 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19461 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19462 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19463 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19464 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19465 transport option of the same name.
19467 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19468 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19469 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19470 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19471 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19472 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19473 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19474 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19476 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19477 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19478 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19479 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19480 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19481 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19482 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19483 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19484 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19487 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19488 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19489 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19490 If this option is set,
19491 the argument is first expanded to give a list.
19492 The router is skipped unless the current domain matches the list.
19493 The data returned by the list check
19494 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19495 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19496 If the result of expansion is empty or a forced-fail,
19497 the router is skipped.
19499 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19500 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19502 A complex example, using a file like:
19508 and checking both domain and local_part
19510 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19511 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19516 .option driver routers string unset
19517 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19521 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19522 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19523 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19524 If this option is set true, and extended DSN
19525 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461)) processing is in effect,
19526 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19527 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19528 Not effective on redirect routers.
19532 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19533 .cindex "envelope from"
19534 .cindex "envelope sender"
19535 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19536 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19537 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19538 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19539 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19540 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19541 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19543 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19544 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19545 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19548 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19549 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19550 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19551 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19553 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19554 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19555 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19556 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19562 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19563 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19564 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19565 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19566 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19568 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19569 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19570 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19571 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19572 setting &%return_path%&.
19574 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19575 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19576 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19580 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19581 .cindex "address" "testing"
19582 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19583 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19584 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19585 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19586 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19587 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19588 on for the system alias file.
19589 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19592 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19593 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19594 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19598 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19599 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19600 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19601 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19605 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19606 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19607 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19611 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19612 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19613 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19617 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19618 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19619 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19620 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19621 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19622 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19623 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19624 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19625 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19627 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19628 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19629 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19630 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19631 transport for further details.
19634 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19635 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19636 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19637 .cindex "transport" "local"
19638 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19639 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19640 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19642 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19643 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19644 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19645 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19646 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19650 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19651 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19652 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19653 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19654 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19655 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19656 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19657 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19658 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19659 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19660 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19661 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19662 &"see"& the added header lines.
19664 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19665 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19666 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19667 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19669 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19670 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19672 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19673 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19675 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19676 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19677 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19678 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19679 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19680 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19681 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19682 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19683 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19684 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19688 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19689 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19690 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19691 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19692 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19693 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19694 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19695 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19696 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19698 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19699 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19700 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19701 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19702 &"see"& the original header lines.
19704 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19705 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19706 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19709 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19710 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19712 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19713 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19715 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19716 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19717 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19718 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19720 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19721 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19722 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19726 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19727 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19728 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19729 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19730 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19731 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19732 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19735 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19739 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19741 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19742 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19743 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19744 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19745 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19746 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19748 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19749 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19751 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19752 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19754 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19755 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19757 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19758 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19759 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19760 domain that is being routed.
19762 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19763 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19766 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19767 .cindex "additional groups"
19768 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19769 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19770 .cindex "transport" "local"
19771 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19772 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19773 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19774 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19775 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19779 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19780 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19781 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19782 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19783 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19784 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19785 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19788 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19789 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19790 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19791 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19792 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19793 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19794 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19795 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19796 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19798 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19799 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19800 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19801 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19802 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19803 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19804 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19805 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19806 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19807 the relevant transport.
19809 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19810 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19811 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19813 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19814 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19815 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19818 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19819 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19820 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19821 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19822 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19826 local_part_prefix = real-
19828 transport = local_delivery
19830 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19831 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19833 condition = ${if match_ip {$sender_host_address} \
19834 {<; ; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1}}
19837 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19838 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19839 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19840 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19843 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19844 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19848 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19849 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19850 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19851 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19852 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19853 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19854 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19855 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19856 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19860 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19861 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19865 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19866 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19867 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19868 If this option is set, the argument is first expanded to give a list.
19869 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19870 If the result of expansion is empty or a forced-fail,
19871 the router is skipped.
19873 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19875 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19876 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19879 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19881 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19882 The data returned by the list check
19883 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19884 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19885 You might use this option, for
19886 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19887 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19888 each virtual domain:
19892 local_parts = postmaster
19893 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19897 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19898 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19899 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19900 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19901 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19902 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19903 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19904 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19905 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19906 redirect addresses.
19910 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19911 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19912 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19913 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19914 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19915 delivery to be deferred.
19917 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19918 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19920 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19921 means of the setting
19925 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19926 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19927 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19929 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19930 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19931 controls what happens next.
19934 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19935 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19936 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19937 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19938 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19939 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19940 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19941 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19943 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19944 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19945 applies to all of them.
19949 .option pass_router routers string unset
19950 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19951 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19952 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19953 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19954 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19955 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19956 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19957 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19958 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19959 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19963 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19964 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19965 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19966 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19967 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19968 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19970 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19971 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19972 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19973 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19977 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19978 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19979 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19980 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19981 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19982 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19983 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19985 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19986 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19987 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19988 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19989 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19991 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19992 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19993 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19994 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19995 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19998 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19999 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
20002 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
20003 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
20004 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
20005 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
20006 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
20007 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
20008 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
20009 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
20011 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
20012 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
20013 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
20014 operates as follows:
20016 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
20017 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
20018 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
20019 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
20022 require_files = mail:/some/file
20023 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
20025 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
20026 &%require_files%& condition fails.
20028 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
20029 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
20030 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
20031 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
20033 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
20034 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
20035 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
20036 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
20037 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
20039 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
20040 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
20041 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
20042 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
20043 check again in that process.
20045 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
20046 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
20047 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
20048 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
20049 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
20050 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
20051 as if the file did not exist. For example:
20053 require_files = +/some/file
20055 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
20056 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
20057 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
20061 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
20062 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20063 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
20064 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
20065 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
20066 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
20067 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
20068 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
20071 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
20072 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
20073 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
20074 &%check_local_user%&,
20077 &%local_part_prefix%&,
20078 &%local_part_suffix%&,
20081 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
20082 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
20085 Failing to set this option when it is needed
20086 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
20087 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
20089 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
20090 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
20091 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
20095 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
20096 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
20097 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
20099 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
20100 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
20101 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
20102 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
20103 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
20104 cause the router to defer.
20106 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
20107 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
20109 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20111 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
20112 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
20114 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
20115 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
20116 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
20117 of these values that is set:
20120 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20122 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20124 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20126 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20129 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
20130 router, but not for the transport.
20134 .option self routers string freeze
20135 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20136 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20137 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
20138 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
20139 and &(manualroute)& routers.
20140 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
20142 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
20143 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
20144 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
20145 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
20146 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20148 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
20149 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
20150 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
20151 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
20152 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
20157 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
20159 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
20160 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
20161 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
20162 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
20164 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
20165 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
20166 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
20171 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
20172 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
20173 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
20174 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
20175 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
20176 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
20182 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
20183 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
20184 be passed to the next router.
20187 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
20190 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
20191 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
20192 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
20193 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
20194 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
20195 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
20200 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
20201 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
20202 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
20203 address matches something on the list.
20204 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20207 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
20208 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
20209 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
20210 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
20211 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
20212 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
20213 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
20217 .option set routers "string list" unset
20218 .cindex router variables
20219 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
20220 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
20221 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
20224 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
20225 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
20226 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
20227 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
20228 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
20230 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
20231 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
20232 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
20233 The variables can be used by the router options
20234 (not including any preconditions)
20235 and by the transport.
20236 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
20237 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
20239 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
20240 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
20243 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
20244 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
20245 .cindex "packet radio"
20246 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
20247 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
20248 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
20249 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
20250 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
20251 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
20252 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
20253 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20255 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20256 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
20257 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
20258 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
20259 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
20260 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
20261 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
20262 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
20263 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
20264 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20266 translate_ip_address = \
20267 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20270 The file would contain lines like
20272 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20273 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20275 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20280 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20281 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20282 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20283 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20284 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20285 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20286 delivery is deferred.
20288 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20289 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20290 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20294 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20295 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20296 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20297 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20298 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20299 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20300 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20301 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20302 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20303 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20304 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20310 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20311 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20312 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20313 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20314 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20315 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20316 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20317 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20318 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20319 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20321 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20322 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20323 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20324 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20325 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20327 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20333 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20334 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20335 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20336 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20337 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20338 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20339 delivery to be deferred.
20341 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20342 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20343 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20344 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20345 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20346 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20348 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20349 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20350 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20351 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20352 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20353 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20354 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20355 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20357 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20358 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20359 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20360 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20361 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20362 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20363 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20364 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20365 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20366 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20368 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20369 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20370 subsequent routers.
20373 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20374 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20375 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20376 .cindex "transport" "local"
20377 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20378 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20379 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20380 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20381 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20382 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20383 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20384 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20385 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20386 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20387 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20388 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20392 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20393 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20394 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20397 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20398 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20400 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20401 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20402 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20403 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20404 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20405 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20406 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20408 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20409 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20410 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20414 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20415 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20417 delivering in cutthrough mode
20418 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20419 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20421 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20424 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20425 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20426 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20427 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20429 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20430 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20431 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20441 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20442 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20443 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20444 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20445 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20446 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20447 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20448 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20449 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20453 domains = mydomain.example
20455 transport = local_delivery
20457 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20458 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20459 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20460 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20470 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20471 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20472 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20473 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20474 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20475 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20477 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20478 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20479 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20480 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20483 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20484 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20485 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20486 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20487 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20488 generic option, the router declines.
20490 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20491 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20492 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20494 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20495 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20496 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20497 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20498 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20499 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20502 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20503 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20504 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20505 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20506 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20507 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20509 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20510 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20511 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20512 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20513 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20514 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20515 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20516 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20517 case routing fails.
20520 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20521 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20522 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20523 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20524 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20526 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20527 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20529 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20531 The domain does not exist in DNS
20533 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20534 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20535 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20537 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20539 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20541 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20542 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20544 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20545 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20547 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20548 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20550 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20551 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20557 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20558 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20559 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20561 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20562 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20563 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20564 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20565 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20566 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20567 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20570 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20571 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20572 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records
20573 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2782,RFC 2782))
20574 in addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20575 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20576 required. For example,
20580 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20581 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20582 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20583 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20584 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20587 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20588 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20589 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20590 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20591 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20592 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20594 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20595 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20596 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20597 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20598 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20599 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20600 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20601 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20603 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20604 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20609 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20610 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20611 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20612 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20613 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20614 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20615 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20616 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20620 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20621 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20622 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20623 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20624 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20625 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20626 only A records are used.
20628 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20629 .cindex IPv4 preference
20630 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20631 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20632 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20633 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20634 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20636 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20637 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20638 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20639 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20640 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20641 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20642 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20645 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20647 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20648 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20649 the address record.
20652 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20653 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20654 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20655 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20660 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20661 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20662 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20663 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20664 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20665 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20666 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20667 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20668 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20673 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20674 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20675 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20676 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20677 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20678 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20679 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20680 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20681 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20682 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20683 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20685 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20686 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20689 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20690 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20691 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20692 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20693 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20697 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20698 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20699 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20700 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20701 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20702 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20703 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20704 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20706 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20707 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20708 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20709 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20710 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20711 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20712 without processing them independently,
20713 provided the following conditions are met:
20716 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20717 &%headers_remove%&.
20719 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20726 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20727 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20728 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20729 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20730 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20731 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20732 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20733 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20734 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20735 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20737 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20738 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20743 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20744 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20745 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20746 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20751 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20752 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20753 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20754 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20757 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20759 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20760 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20761 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20762 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20763 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20764 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20767 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20768 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20769 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20770 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20771 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20773 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20774 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20775 such as that implied by
20779 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20780 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20781 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20782 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20795 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20796 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20797 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20798 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20799 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20800 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20801 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20802 takes the form of an
20803 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
20804 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20805 router handles the address
20809 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20810 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20811 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20813 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20815 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20816 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20818 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20819 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20820 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20821 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20823 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20824 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20825 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20826 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20830 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20831 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20833 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20834 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20835 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20836 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20837 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20838 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20841 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20843 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20845 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20846 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20847 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20848 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20849 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20850 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20851 must not be specified for it.
20853 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20854 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20855 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20856 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20857 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20858 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20859 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20862 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20863 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20864 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20865 delivery to the address is deferred.
20868 .option port iplookup integer 0
20869 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20870 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20874 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20875 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20876 protocols is to be used.
20879 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20880 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20883 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20885 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20886 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20889 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20890 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20891 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20892 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20893 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20894 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20895 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20896 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20899 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20900 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20901 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20902 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20903 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20904 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20905 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20906 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20907 following could be used:
20909 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20910 reroute = $local_part@$1
20913 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20914 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20915 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20916 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20922 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20924 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20925 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20926 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20927 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20928 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20929 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20930 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20931 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20932 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20933 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20935 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20936 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20937 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20938 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20939 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20940 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20941 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20944 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20945 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20946 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20947 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20948 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20949 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20950 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20953 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20954 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20955 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20956 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20957 below, following the list of private options.
20960 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20962 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20963 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20965 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20966 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20968 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20969 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20970 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20971 of the following values:
20980 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20981 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20982 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20985 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20986 router only if &%more%& is true.
20988 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20989 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20990 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20991 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20993 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20994 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20995 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20998 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20999 .cindex "randomized host list"
21000 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21001 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
21002 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
21003 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
21004 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
21005 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
21006 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
21007 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
21009 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
21010 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
21011 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
21012 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21014 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21016 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21017 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21018 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
21019 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
21020 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
21023 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
21024 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
21025 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
21028 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
21030 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
21031 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
21035 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
21036 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
21037 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
21038 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
21041 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
21042 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
21043 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
21044 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
21045 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
21046 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
21047 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
21048 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
21050 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
21051 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
21052 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
21053 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
21054 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
21055 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
21056 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
21057 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
21062 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
21063 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
21064 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
21065 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
21066 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
21067 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
21069 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
21071 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
21075 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
21076 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
21078 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
21079 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
21080 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
21081 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
21082 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
21083 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
21084 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
21085 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
21086 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
21087 in a &%route_list%&).
21089 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
21090 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
21091 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
21092 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
21096 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
21097 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
21098 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
21099 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
21100 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
21101 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
21102 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
21105 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
21106 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
21108 This data can be accessed by setting
21110 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
21112 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
21113 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
21114 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
21115 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
21116 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
21121 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
21122 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
21123 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
21124 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
21125 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
21126 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
21127 The format of each item
21128 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
21129 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
21131 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
21132 variables are set during its expansion:
21135 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21136 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
21137 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
21139 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
21142 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
21144 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
21147 .vindex "&$value$&"
21148 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
21149 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
21151 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
21155 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
21156 semicolon is the default route list separator.
21160 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
21161 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
21162 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
21163 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
21164 When no port is given, an IP address
21165 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
21166 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
21167 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
21170 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
21171 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
21172 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
21174 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
21175 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
21178 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
21179 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
21180 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
21181 number follows. For example:
21183 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
21187 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
21188 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
21189 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
21190 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
21191 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
21194 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
21195 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
21196 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
21197 records in the DNS. For example:
21199 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
21201 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
21204 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
21206 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
21207 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
21208 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
21209 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
21210 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
21211 happens is controlled by the
21212 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21213 &%self%& option of the router.
21215 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
21216 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
21217 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
21218 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
21219 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
21220 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
21221 defined by MX preferences.
21223 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
21224 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
21225 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
21227 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
21228 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
21229 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
21230 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
21232 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
21233 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
21236 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
21237 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
21238 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
21240 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
21241 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
21245 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
21246 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
21247 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
21248 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
21249 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
21250 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
21251 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
21254 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
21255 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21257 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
21258 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21260 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
21261 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
21262 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
21264 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
21265 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
21266 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21268 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21270 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21275 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21276 domain2 host4:host5
21278 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21279 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21280 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21281 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21284 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21285 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21286 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21287 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21290 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21291 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21296 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21297 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21300 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21301 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21305 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21306 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21307 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21310 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21311 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21312 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21313 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21315 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21317 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21318 your first router something like this:
21321 driver = manualroute
21322 domains = !+local_domains
21323 transport = remote_smtp
21324 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21326 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21327 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21328 they are tried in order
21329 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21330 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21333 driver = manualroute
21334 transport = remote_smtp
21335 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21337 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21338 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21339 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21340 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21341 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21342 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21343 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21344 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21347 .cindex "mail hub example"
21348 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21349 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21350 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21351 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21352 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21353 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21354 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21355 lookup is easier to manage.
21357 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21358 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21362 driver = manualroute
21363 transport = remote_smtp
21364 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21366 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21367 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21368 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21369 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21370 domain can be used to find the host:
21373 driver = manualroute
21374 transport = remote_smtp
21375 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21377 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21378 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21379 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21383 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21384 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21385 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21386 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21387 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21388 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21391 driver = manualroute
21392 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21393 route_list = saved.domain.example
21395 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21396 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21397 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21400 driver = manualroute
21402 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21403 *.saved.domain2.example \
21404 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21407 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21409 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21410 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21411 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21412 the address if the lookup fails.
21415 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21416 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21417 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21418 one way it can be done:
21424 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21425 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21426 return_fail_output = true
21431 driver = manualroute
21433 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21435 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21437 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21439 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21440 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21441 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21443 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21444 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21456 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21457 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21458 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21459 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21460 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21461 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21462 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21463 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21464 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21465 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21467 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21469 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21470 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21471 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21472 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21473 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21476 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21477 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21478 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21479 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21480 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21481 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21484 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21485 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21486 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21487 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21488 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21489 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21490 not set, a value for the gid also.
21492 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21493 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21494 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21495 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21496 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21497 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21501 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21502 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21503 before running the command.
21506 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21507 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21508 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21512 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21513 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21514 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21515 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21516 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21519 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21522 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21523 &%no_more%& is set.
21525 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21526 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21527 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21528 included in the SMTP response.
21530 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21531 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21532 included in any SMTP response.
21534 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21536 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21537 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21539 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21540 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21541 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21544 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21545 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21548 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21549 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21551 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21552 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21553 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21554 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21556 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21557 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21558 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21559 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21560 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21562 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21563 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21564 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21565 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21566 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21568 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21569 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21570 variable. For example, this return line
21572 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21574 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21575 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21576 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21577 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21585 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21586 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21587 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21588 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21589 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21590 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21591 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21592 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21593 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21594 redirected in several different ways:
21597 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21600 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21602 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21604 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21606 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21608 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21610 It can be discarded.
21613 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21614 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21615 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21616 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21618 If success DSNs have been requested
21619 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21620 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21621 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21625 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21626 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21627 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21628 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21629 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21630 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21634 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21636 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21637 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21638 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21639 cause delivery to be deferred.
21641 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21642 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21647 file = $home/.forward
21650 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21651 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21652 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21653 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only
21654 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21657 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21658 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21659 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21661 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21662 directly for redirection,
21663 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21664 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21665 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21666 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21670 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21671 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21672 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21673 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21676 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21677 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21678 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21679 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21681 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21682 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21683 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21684 saves some resources.
21692 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21693 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21694 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21695 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21696 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21699 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21700 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21701 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21702 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21703 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21704 document is intended for use by end users.
21706 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21707 described in the next section.
21710 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21711 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21712 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21713 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21714 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21718 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21719 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21720 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21721 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21722 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21723 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21724 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21725 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21726 commas or newlines.
21727 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21730 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21731 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21732 next newline character is ignored.
21734 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21735 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21736 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21737 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21740 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21741 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21742 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21743 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21744 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21745 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21748 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21752 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21753 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21754 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21755 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21756 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21757 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21758 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21759 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21760 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21761 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21762 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21764 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21765 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21766 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21767 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21768 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21770 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21772 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21773 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21774 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21775 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21776 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21779 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid
21780 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21781 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21782 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21783 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21784 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21786 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21787 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21792 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21793 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21796 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21798 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21799 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21800 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21801 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21802 should really contain
21804 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21806 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21807 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21808 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21812 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21813 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21814 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21817 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21818 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21819 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21821 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21823 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21824 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21825 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21827 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21828 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21829 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21830 in double quotes, for example:
21832 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21834 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21835 quote just the command. An item such as
21837 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21839 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21841 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21842 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21843 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21844 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21845 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21846 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21847 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21848 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21849 an &%accept%& router.
21852 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21853 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21854 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21856 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21857 address that includes a domain. For example,
21859 /home/world/minbari
21861 is treated as a filename, but
21863 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21865 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21866 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21867 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21868 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21870 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21871 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21873 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21874 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21875 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21876 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21879 .cindex "included address list"
21880 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21881 If an item is of the form
21883 :include:<path name>
21885 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21886 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21887 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21888 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21889 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21890 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21892 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21894 It must be given as
21896 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21898 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21899 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21900 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21902 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21903 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21904 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21905 .cindex "black hole"
21906 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21907 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21908 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21909 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21913 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21914 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21915 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21917 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21918 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21919 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21920 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21924 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21925 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21926 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21927 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21928 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21929 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21930 redirection items of the form
21935 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21936 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21937 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21938 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21940 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21942 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21944 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21945 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21947 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21948 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21949 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21951 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21952 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21953 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21954 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21955 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21956 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21957 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21958 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21959 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21962 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21963 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21964 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21965 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21967 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21968 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21969 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21970 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21971 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21973 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21974 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21975 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21976 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21977 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21981 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21982 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21983 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21984 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21985 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21986 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21987 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21991 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21992 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21993 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21994 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21995 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21996 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21997 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21998 aliasing scheme of the type
22000 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
22004 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
22005 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
22006 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
22009 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
22010 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
22012 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
22013 the pipes are distinct.
22017 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
22018 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
22019 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
22020 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
22021 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
22022 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
22023 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
22024 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
22025 can be used to avoid this.
22028 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
22029 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
22030 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
22031 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
22032 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
22033 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
22034 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
22038 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
22040 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
22041 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
22044 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
22045 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
22046 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
22049 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
22050 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
22051 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
22052 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
22055 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
22056 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
22057 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
22058 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
22059 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
22060 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
22061 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
22063 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
22064 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
22067 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
22068 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
22069 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
22070 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
22071 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
22075 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
22076 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
22077 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
22078 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
22079 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
22080 let ordinary users do.
22084 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
22085 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
22086 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
22087 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
22088 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
22089 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
22091 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
22092 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
22093 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
22094 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
22095 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
22096 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
22098 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
22100 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
22101 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
22102 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
22103 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
22104 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
22105 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
22106 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
22107 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
22110 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
22111 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
22112 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
22113 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
22114 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
22115 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
22116 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
22117 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
22121 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
22122 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
22123 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
22124 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
22125 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
22126 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
22129 .option data redirect string&!! unset
22130 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
22131 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
22132 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
22133 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
22134 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
22136 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
22137 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
22138 terminated with newline characters. For example:
22140 data = #Exim filter\n\
22141 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
22143 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
22144 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
22145 choice into a newline.
22148 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
22149 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
22150 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22151 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22152 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
22155 .option file redirect string&!! unset
22156 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
22157 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
22158 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
22159 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
22160 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
22161 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
22162 entirely of comments), the router declines.
22164 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
22165 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
22166 runs a check on the containing directory,
22167 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
22168 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
22169 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
22170 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
22171 not, the router declines.
22174 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
22175 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22176 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
22177 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22178 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22179 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
22180 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
22183 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
22184 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
22185 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
22186 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
22187 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
22190 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
22191 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22192 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22193 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
22197 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
22198 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22199 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22200 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
22201 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22206 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
22207 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22208 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
22209 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22210 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
22211 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
22212 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
22213 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
22214 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
22215 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
22216 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
22219 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
22220 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22221 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22222 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22223 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
22226 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
22227 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22228 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22229 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
22230 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22231 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
22233 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
22234 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22235 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22236 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
22237 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
22238 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
22239 &_.forward_& files).
22242 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
22243 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22244 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22245 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22246 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
22249 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
22250 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22251 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22252 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
22253 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
22254 of the embedded Perl support.
22257 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
22258 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22259 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22260 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22261 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
22264 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
22265 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22266 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22267 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22268 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
22271 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
22272 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22273 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22274 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22275 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22276 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22277 &%one_time%& is set.
22280 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22281 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22282 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22283 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22284 to make use of &%run%& items.
22287 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22288 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22289 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22290 If this option is true, items of the form
22292 :include:<path name>
22294 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22297 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22298 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22299 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22300 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22301 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22302 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22303 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22306 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22307 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22308 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22309 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22310 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22313 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22314 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22315 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22316 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22317 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22322 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22323 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22324 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22325 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22326 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22327 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22328 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22331 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22333 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22334 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22335 file did not exist.
22338 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22340 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22341 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22342 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22344 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22345 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22346 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22347 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22348 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22349 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22350 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22351 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22355 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22356 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22357 redirection list must start with this directory.
22360 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22361 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22362 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22365 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22366 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22367 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22368 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22369 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22370 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22371 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22372 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22373 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22374 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22375 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22376 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22377 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22378 before they subscribed.
22380 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22381 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22382 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22383 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22386 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22387 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22388 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22389 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22391 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22392 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22393 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22395 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22398 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22399 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22400 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22401 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22402 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22406 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22407 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22408 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22409 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22410 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22411 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22412 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22413 See &%check_owner%& above.
22416 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22417 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22418 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22419 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22422 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22423 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22424 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22425 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22426 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22427 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22428 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22431 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22432 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22433 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22434 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22435 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22436 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22437 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22438 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22440 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22441 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22442 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22445 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22446 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22447 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22448 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22449 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22450 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22451 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22452 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22453 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22454 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22457 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22458 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22459 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22460 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22461 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22462 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22465 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22466 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22467 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22468 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22469 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22470 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22473 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22474 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22475 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22476 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22477 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22480 .option sieve_inbox redirect string&!! inbox
22482 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22483 name of the mailbox used for "keep" operations (explicit or implicit).
22486 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22487 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22488 :subaddress part of an address.
22490 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22491 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22492 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22493 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22496 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22497 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22498 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22499 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22500 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22501 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22502 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22506 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22507 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22508 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22509 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22510 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22511 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22512 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22513 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22514 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22515 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22516 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22517 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22518 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22519 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22520 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22521 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22523 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22524 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22525 the following routers.
22527 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22528 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22529 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22530 so it is passed to the following routers.
22532 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22533 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22534 action is specified by
22535 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
22536 The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22537 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22539 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22540 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22541 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22542 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22548 file = $home/.forward
22549 file_transport = address_file
22550 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22551 reply_transport = address_reply
22554 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22555 syntax_errors_text = \
22556 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22557 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22558 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22559 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22560 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22561 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22562 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22563 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22564 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22565 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22567 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22568 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22569 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22574 local_part_prefix = real-
22575 transport = local_delivery
22577 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22578 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22580 condition = ${if match_ip {$sender_host_address} \
22581 {<; ; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1}}
22585 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22586 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22589 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22590 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22591 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22592 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22602 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22603 "Environment for local transports"
22604 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22605 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22606 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22607 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22608 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22609 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22610 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22612 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22613 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22614 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22615 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22617 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22618 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22619 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22620 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22621 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22625 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22626 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22627 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22628 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22629 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22630 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22631 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22634 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22635 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22639 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22641 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22642 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22643 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22644 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22649 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22650 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22651 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22652 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22653 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22654 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22655 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22656 group (set by the transport). For example:
22659 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22663 transport = group_delivery
22666 # This transport overrides the group
22668 driver = appendfile
22669 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22672 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22673 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22674 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22677 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22678 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22679 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22680 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22681 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22682 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22684 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22685 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22686 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22687 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22688 original gid is also used.
22690 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22691 following that is set is used:
22694 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22696 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22698 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22699 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22701 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22703 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22704 the uid is the creator's uid;
22706 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22709 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22710 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22711 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22712 The first of the following that is set is used:
22715 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22717 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22719 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22721 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22726 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22727 &%never_users%& list.
22733 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22734 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22735 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22736 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22737 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22738 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22739 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22740 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22741 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22742 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22745 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22747 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22749 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22751 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22754 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22757 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22759 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22763 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22764 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22765 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22769 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22770 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22771 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22772 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22773 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22774 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22775 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22776 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22777 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22778 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22779 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22780 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22781 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22782 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22793 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22794 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22795 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22796 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22797 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22798 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22801 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22804 .option body_only transports boolean false
22805 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22806 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22807 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22808 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22809 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22810 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22811 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22812 automatically suppress them.
22815 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22816 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22817 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22818 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22819 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22820 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22823 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22824 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22825 deliveries by the transport or for any
22826 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22827 what you are doing.
22830 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22831 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22832 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22833 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22835 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22836 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22837 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22838 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22839 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22840 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22842 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22843 transport and the router that called it.
22845 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22846 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22847 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22848 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22849 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22850 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22851 safely be resent to other recipients.
22854 .option driver transports string unset
22855 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22856 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22859 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22860 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22861 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22862 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22863 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22864 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22865 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22866 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22867 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22868 resent to other recipients.
22870 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22871 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22872 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22873 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22874 Doing so is generally not advised.
22877 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22879 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22880 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22883 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22884 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22885 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22886 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22887 &%user%& (see below).
22890 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22891 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22892 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22893 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22894 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22895 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22896 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22897 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22898 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22899 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22900 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22902 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22903 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22906 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22907 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22908 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22909 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22910 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22911 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22912 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22913 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22916 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22917 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22918 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22919 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22920 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22921 to be removed from the message.
22922 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22923 Each list item is separately expanded.
22924 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22925 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22926 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22927 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22929 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22930 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22933 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22934 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22936 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22937 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22938 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22942 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22943 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22944 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22945 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22946 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22947 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22948 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22949 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22952 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22955 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22956 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22957 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22958 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22959 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22960 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22961 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22962 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22963 change envelope recipients at this time.
22966 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22967 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22969 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22970 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22971 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22972 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22973 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22974 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22975 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22979 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22980 .cindex "additional groups"
22981 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22982 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22983 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22984 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22985 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22988 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22989 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22990 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22991 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22992 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22993 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22994 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22995 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22997 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22998 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22999 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
23000 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
23001 Obviously there is scope for
23002 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23003 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23005 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
23006 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23007 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23008 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23009 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
23012 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
23013 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
23014 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
23015 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
23016 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
23017 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
23018 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
23019 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
23020 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
23021 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
23022 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
23023 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
23024 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
23029 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
23030 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
23031 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
23032 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
23033 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
23034 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
23035 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
23036 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
23039 local_part_prefix = *-
23041 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
23044 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
23046 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
23047 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
23048 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
23049 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
23050 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
23053 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
23054 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
23055 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
23056 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
23057 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
23058 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
23059 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
23060 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
23061 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
23063 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
23064 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
23065 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
23066 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
23068 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
23069 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
23070 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
23073 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
23074 .cindex "envelope sender"
23075 .cindex "envelope from"
23076 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
23077 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
23078 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
23079 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
23080 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
23081 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
23082 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
23083 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
23084 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
23086 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
23087 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
23089 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
23090 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
23091 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
23092 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
23093 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
23094 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
23095 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
23097 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
23098 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
23099 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
23100 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
23101 &%errors_to%& in a router.
23105 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
23106 .chindex Return-path:
23107 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
23108 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
23109 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
23110 have easy access to it.
23112 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
23113 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
23114 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
23115 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
23116 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
23117 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
23121 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
23122 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
23125 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
23126 .cindex "shadow transport"
23127 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
23128 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
23129 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
23131 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
23132 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
23133 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
23134 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
23135 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
23136 cause a log line to be written.
23138 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
23139 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
23140 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
23141 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
23142 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
23145 ST=<shadow transport name>
23147 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
23148 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
23149 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
23150 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
23151 headers that some sites insist on.
23154 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
23155 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23156 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23157 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
23158 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
23159 individual users or via a system filter.
23160 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
23162 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
23163 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
23164 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
23165 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
23166 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
23168 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
23169 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
23171 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
23172 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
23173 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
23174 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
23175 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
23176 &(pipe)& transports.
23178 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
23179 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
23180 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
23181 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
23182 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
23184 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
23186 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
23187 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
23188 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
23189 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
23191 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
23192 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
23193 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
23194 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
23195 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
23196 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
23198 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
23199 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
23200 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
23201 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
23202 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
23203 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
23204 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
23205 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
23207 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23208 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
23209 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
23210 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
23211 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
23212 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
23213 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
23214 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
23215 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
23216 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
23219 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23220 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
23221 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
23222 which the message is being sent. For example:
23223 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
23225 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
23226 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
23229 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
23230 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
23231 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
23233 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
23234 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
23235 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
23238 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
23240 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
23241 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
23243 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
23244 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
23245 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
23246 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
23247 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
23248 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
23249 and the latter does not.
23251 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
23252 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
23253 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
23254 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
23255 Exim tried to expand the first one.
23257 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
23258 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
23259 arguments. Consider this example:
23261 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23262 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23264 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
23265 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
23267 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23268 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23272 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
23273 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
23274 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
23275 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
23276 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
23277 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
23278 bounced from a transport filter.
23280 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
23281 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
23282 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23285 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23286 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23287 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23288 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23289 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23290 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23291 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23292 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23293 becomes a temporary error.
23296 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23297 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23298 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23299 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23300 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23301 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23302 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23305 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23306 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23307 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23309 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23310 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23311 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23312 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23314 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23315 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23316 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23323 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23326 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23328 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23329 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23330 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23331 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23332 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23333 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23334 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23336 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23337 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23338 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23339 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23340 local transport, for example:
23343 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23344 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23345 recipients saves space.
23347 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23348 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23350 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23351 to a scanner program or
23352 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23356 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23357 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23358 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23360 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23361 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23362 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23363 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23364 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23365 to certain conditions:
23368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23369 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23370 batching is possible.
23372 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23373 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23374 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23376 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23377 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23378 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23379 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23380 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23383 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23384 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23385 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23389 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23390 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23391 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23392 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23393 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23394 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23395 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23398 escape_string = ".."
23400 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23401 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23402 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23404 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23405 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23406 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23407 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23408 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23409 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23411 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23412 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23413 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23414 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23415 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23416 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23417 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23418 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23419 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23424 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23425 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23427 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23428 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23429 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23430 .cindex "directory creation"
23431 .cindex "creating directories"
23432 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23433 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23434 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23435 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23436 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23437 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23438 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23439 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23440 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23441 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23443 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23444 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23445 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23448 .cindex "quota" "system"
23449 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23450 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23451 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23453 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23454 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23455 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23456 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23458 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23459 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23462 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23463 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23464 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23465 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23470 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23471 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23472 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23473 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23474 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23476 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23477 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23478 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23479 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23480 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23481 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23482 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23483 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23484 operation. There are two cases:
23487 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23488 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23489 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23490 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23491 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23492 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23493 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23495 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23496 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23497 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23499 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23500 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23501 a file or directory name
23502 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23504 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23505 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23506 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23507 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23508 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23509 which returns a path (or component).
23512 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23513 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23514 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23515 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23520 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23522 require "fileinto";
23523 fileinto "folder23";
23525 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23526 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23527 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the
23532 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23533 way of handling this requirement:
23535 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23536 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23537 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23539 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23543 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23544 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23545 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23548 An alternative for the &"keep"& aspect is to use the &%sieve_inbox%& option
23549 on the redirect router that calls the Sieve filter,
23550 to explicitly set the filename used.
23553 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23554 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23555 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23556 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23557 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23558 path to the transport.
23560 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23561 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23564 &*Note 3*&: Permitting a user to enable writes to an absolute path
23565 may be a security issue.
23570 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23571 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23575 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23576 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23577 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23578 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23579 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23580 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23581 delivery is deferred.
23584 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23585 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23586 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23587 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23588 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23589 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23590 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23591 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23594 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23595 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23596 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23597 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23601 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23602 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23605 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23606 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23607 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23608 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23609 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23612 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23613 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23614 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23615 process is running.
23618 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23619 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23620 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23621 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23622 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23623 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23624 contains is significant.
23626 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23627 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23628 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23629 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23630 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23632 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23633 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23634 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23635 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23636 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23637 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23639 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23640 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23641 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23642 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23644 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23645 .cindex "directory creation"
23646 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23647 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23648 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23650 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23651 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23652 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23653 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23654 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23658 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23659 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23660 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23661 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23662 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23665 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23666 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23668 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23669 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23671 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23672 to evade the testing.
23673 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23674 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23675 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23676 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23677 &%file_must_exist%&.
23679 In the fourth case,
23680 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23681 existing directory.
23682 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23683 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23685 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23686 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23687 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23688 becomes de-tainted.
23691 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23692 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23693 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23694 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23696 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23697 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23698 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23699 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23700 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23702 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23706 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23708 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23709 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23710 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23711 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23713 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23715 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23716 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23720 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23721 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23722 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23725 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23726 See &%check_string%& above.
23729 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23730 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23731 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23732 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23733 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23734 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23737 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23740 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23741 .cindex "locking files"
23742 .cindex "lock files"
23743 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23744 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23746 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23747 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23750 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23751 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23754 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23755 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23756 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23757 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23758 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23759 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23763 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23764 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23765 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23766 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23767 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23768 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23769 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23770 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23771 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23774 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23775 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23777 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23778 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23779 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23780 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23781 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23782 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23783 delivery is deferred.
23786 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23787 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23788 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23789 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23792 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23793 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23794 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23795 .cindex "locking files"
23796 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23797 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23798 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23799 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23800 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23801 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23802 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23803 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23805 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23806 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23807 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23808 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23810 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23811 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23814 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23816 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23817 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23818 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23820 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23821 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23823 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23826 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23827 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23828 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23829 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23832 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23833 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23834 for details of locking.
23837 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23838 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23839 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23842 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23843 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23844 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23847 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23848 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23849 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23850 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23851 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23854 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23855 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23856 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23857 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23858 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23859 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23860 external source that maintains the data.
23863 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23864 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23865 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23866 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23867 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23868 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23869 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23870 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23874 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23875 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23876 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23877 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23878 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23879 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23880 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23881 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23882 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23883 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23886 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23887 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23888 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23889 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23890 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23891 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23892 calculation. The default value is:
23894 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23896 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23897 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23899 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23901 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23903 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23904 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23905 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23906 directly into that directory.
23909 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23910 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23911 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23914 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23915 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23916 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23919 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23920 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23921 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23922 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23923 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23924 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23925 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23926 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23928 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23929 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23930 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23931 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23932 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23933 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23934 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23935 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23936 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23937 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23940 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23941 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23942 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23943 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23944 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23945 below for further details.
23948 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23949 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23950 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23953 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23954 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23955 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23958 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23959 .cindex "locking files"
23960 .cindex "file" "locking"
23961 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23962 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23963 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23964 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23965 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23966 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23967 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23969 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23970 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23971 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23978 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23979 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23980 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23981 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23982 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23983 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23984 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23985 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23987 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23988 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23989 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23990 append messages to it.
23993 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23994 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23995 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23996 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23997 in which case it is:
23999 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
24000 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
24002 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24003 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24005 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
24006 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24007 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
24008 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
24013 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24014 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24016 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
24017 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
24018 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
24019 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
24020 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
24021 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
24022 value, and this option is ignored.
24025 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
24026 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
24027 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
24028 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
24029 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
24032 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
24033 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
24034 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
24035 on users about incoming mail.
24038 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
24039 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
24040 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
24041 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
24042 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
24043 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
24044 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
24045 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
24046 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
24048 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
24049 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
24050 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
24052 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
24053 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
24054 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
24055 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
24056 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
24057 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
24059 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
24060 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
24061 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
24062 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
24063 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
24066 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
24067 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
24069 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
24071 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
24072 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
24073 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
24074 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
24075 system quota failures.
24077 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
24078 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
24079 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
24080 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
24081 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
24082 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
24083 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
24084 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
24085 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
24086 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
24089 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
24090 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
24091 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
24092 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
24093 delivery directory.
24096 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
24097 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
24098 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
24099 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
24100 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
24103 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
24104 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
24106 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
24107 See &%quota%& above.
24110 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
24111 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
24112 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
24113 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
24114 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
24115 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
24116 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
24118 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
24119 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
24120 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
24121 the file length to the filename. For example:
24123 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
24124 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
24126 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
24127 number of lines in the message.
24129 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
24130 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
24131 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
24133 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
24135 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
24136 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
24137 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
24138 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
24139 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
24140 as is used to adjust the effective size.
24143 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
24144 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
24145 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
24147 quota_warn_message = "\
24148 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
24149 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
24150 This message is automatically created \
24151 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
24152 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
24153 a warning threshold that is\n\
24154 set by the system administrator.\n"
24158 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
24159 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
24160 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
24161 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
24162 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
24163 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
24164 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
24165 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
24166 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
24170 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
24172 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
24173 percent sign is ignored.
24175 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
24176 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
24177 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
24178 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
24179 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
24180 &'From:'& line, the default is:
24182 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
24184 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
24185 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
24188 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
24189 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
24193 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
24194 .cindex "envelope from"
24195 .cindex "envelope sender"
24196 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
24197 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
24198 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
24199 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
24200 for details of batch SMTP.
24203 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
24204 .cindex "carriage return"
24206 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24207 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24208 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
24209 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24211 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
24212 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
24213 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
24214 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
24215 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
24216 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24219 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24220 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
24221 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
24222 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
24223 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24224 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
24227 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
24228 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
24229 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
24230 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
24231 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
24233 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
24234 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
24235 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
24236 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
24238 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
24239 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
24240 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
24241 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
24242 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
24245 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
24246 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
24249 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
24250 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
24251 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
24252 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
24253 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
24254 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
24255 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
24257 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24258 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
24259 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
24260 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
24263 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
24264 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
24265 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
24268 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24269 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
24270 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
24271 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
24272 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
24273 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
24274 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
24275 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
24276 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
24278 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24279 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
24280 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
24281 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
24286 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
24287 .cindex "appending to a file"
24288 .cindex "file" "appending"
24289 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
24292 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
24296 .cindex "directory creation"
24297 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
24298 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24299 &%directory_mode%& option.
24302 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24303 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24307 .cindex "file" "locking"
24308 .cindex "locking files"
24309 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24310 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24311 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24314 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24315 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24316 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24318 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24320 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24321 Unlink the hitching post name.
24323 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24324 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24325 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24326 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24328 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24329 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24330 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24331 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24332 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24333 it before trying again.
24337 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24338 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24339 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24342 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24343 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24344 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24345 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24346 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24347 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24348 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24349 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24350 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24354 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24355 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24356 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24357 delivery is deferred.
24360 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24361 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24362 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24366 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24367 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24368 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24371 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24372 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24373 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24376 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24377 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24378 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24379 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24380 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24381 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24382 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24383 that prevents link following.
24386 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24387 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24388 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24389 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24390 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24393 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24396 .cindex "file" "locking"
24397 .cindex "locking files"
24398 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24399 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24400 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24401 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24402 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24404 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24406 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24407 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24408 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24410 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24411 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24412 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24414 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24415 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24416 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24417 delivery is deferred.
24419 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24420 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24421 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24422 immediately. It retries up to
24424 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24426 times (rounded up).
24429 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24430 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24433 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24434 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24435 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24436 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24437 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24438 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24439 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24440 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24441 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24442 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24444 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24445 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24446 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24447 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24448 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24449 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24450 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24452 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24453 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24454 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24455 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24458 .cindex "maildir format"
24459 .cindex "mailstore format"
24460 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24461 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24462 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24463 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24464 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24466 .cindex "directory creation"
24467 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24468 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24469 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24470 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24471 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24472 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24477 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24478 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24479 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24480 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24481 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24482 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24483 &_new_& subdirectory.
24485 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24486 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24487 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24488 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24489 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24490 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24491 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24493 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24494 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24495 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24496 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24497 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24498 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24499 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24500 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24502 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24503 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24504 folders. Consider this example:
24506 maildir_format = true
24507 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24508 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24509 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24510 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24512 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24513 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24514 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24515 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24516 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24517 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24519 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24520 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24521 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24522 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24523 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24525 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24526 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24527 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24529 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24530 .cindex "maildir++"
24531 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24532 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24533 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24534 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24535 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24536 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24537 amount of space used.
24539 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24540 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24541 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24542 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24543 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24544 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24549 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24550 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24551 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24552 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24553 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24554 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24557 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24558 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24559 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24560 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24561 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24562 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24563 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24564 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24565 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24566 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24567 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24568 backwards compatibility).
24570 For one common implementation, you might set:
24572 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24574 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24576 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24577 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24578 &[stat()]& each message file.
24581 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24582 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24583 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24584 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24585 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24586 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24587 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24588 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24589 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24591 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24592 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24593 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24594 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24595 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24596 need to know the quota.
24598 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24599 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24601 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24602 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24603 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24607 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24608 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24609 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24610 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24611 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24612 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24613 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24614 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24616 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24617 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24618 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24619 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24620 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24621 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24623 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24624 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24625 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24626 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24627 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24628 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24630 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24631 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24632 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24633 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24636 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24637 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24638 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24639 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24640 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24642 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24644 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24645 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24646 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24647 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24648 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24658 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24659 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24660 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24661 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24662 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24663 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24664 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24665 to the rules in RFCs
24666 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822) and
24667 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,3834), respectively.
24669 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24670 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24671 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24672 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24673 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24676 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24677 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24678 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24679 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24680 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24682 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24683 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24684 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24685 transport is run as a consequence of a
24687 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24688 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24689 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24690 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24691 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24692 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24694 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24695 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24696 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24697 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24699 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24700 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24701 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24702 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24703 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24704 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24705 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24707 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24708 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24709 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24710 the transport defers.
24711 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24712 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24714 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24715 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24716 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24717 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24719 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24720 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24721 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24722 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24723 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24724 problems. They are just discarded.
24728 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24729 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24731 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24732 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24733 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24736 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24737 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24738 when the message is specified by the transport.
24741 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24742 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24743 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24744 string comes first.
24747 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24748 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24749 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24752 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24753 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24754 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24757 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24758 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24759 specified by the transport.
24762 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24763 This specifies additional
24764 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
24765 headers that are to be added to the message
24766 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24767 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24770 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24771 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24772 the message is specified by the transport.
24775 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24776 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24780 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24781 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24782 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24783 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24784 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24788 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24789 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24790 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24791 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24793 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24794 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24795 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24796 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24797 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24798 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24799 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24802 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24803 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24804 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24805 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24806 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24808 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24809 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24810 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24811 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24812 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24813 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24816 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24817 See &%once%& above.
24820 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24821 See &%once%& above.
24822 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24825 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24826 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24827 specified by the transport.
24830 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24831 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24832 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24833 configuration option.
24836 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24837 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24838 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24839 automatic responses. For example:
24841 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24843 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24844 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24845 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24846 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24851 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24852 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24853 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24854 the text comes first.
24857 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24858 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24859 when the message is specified by the transport.
24860 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24861 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24869 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24870 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24871 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24872 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24873 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24874 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol
24875 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) over a pipe to a
24877 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24878 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24879 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24880 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24881 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24882 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24886 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24887 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24888 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24891 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24892 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24895 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24896 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24897 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24898 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24899 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24902 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24903 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24904 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24905 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24906 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24907 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24910 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24911 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24912 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24913 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24914 in its response to the LHLO command.
24916 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24917 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24918 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24919 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24922 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24923 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24924 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24925 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24930 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24934 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24935 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24939 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24940 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24942 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24943 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24944 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24945 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24946 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24947 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24948 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24949 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24953 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24954 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24955 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24956 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24957 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24959 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24960 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24961 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24962 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24963 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24964 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24965 that are routed to the transport.
24967 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24968 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24969 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24970 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24971 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24972 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24973 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24977 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24978 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24979 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24981 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24982 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24983 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24984 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24985 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24986 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24987 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24989 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24990 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24991 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24994 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24995 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24996 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24997 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24998 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24999 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
25000 of "1" to enforce serialization.
25005 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
25006 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
25007 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
25008 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
25009 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
25010 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
25011 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
25012 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
25013 &"local delivery failed"&.
25015 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
25016 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
25017 will be sent as normal.
25019 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
25020 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
25021 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
25022 apply in this case.
25024 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
25025 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
25026 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
25027 a non-existent command may be the problem.
25029 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
25030 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
25031 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
25032 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
25033 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
25034 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
25035 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
25040 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
25041 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
25042 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
25043 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
25044 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
25047 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
25048 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
25049 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
25050 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
25052 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
25053 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
25054 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
25055 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
25056 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
25058 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
25060 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
25061 arguments. You have to write
25063 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
25065 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
25066 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
25067 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
25068 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
25069 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
25070 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
25073 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
25076 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25077 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25078 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25079 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
25080 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
25081 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
25082 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
25083 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
25084 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
25085 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
25086 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
25088 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
25089 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
25090 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
25091 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
25092 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
25093 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
25094 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
25095 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
25097 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
25098 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
25099 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
25100 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
25101 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
25102 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
25103 control what is done with it.
25105 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
25106 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
25107 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
25108 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
25109 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
25110 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
25111 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
25112 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
25113 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
25114 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
25115 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
25119 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
25120 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25121 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25122 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
25123 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
25124 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
25125 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
25126 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
25127 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
25128 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
25129 by potential attackers.
25131 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
25132 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
25133 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
25134 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
25135 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
25136 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
25137 &`LOGNAME `& see below
25138 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
25139 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
25140 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
25141 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
25142 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
25143 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
25144 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
25145 &`USER `& see below
25147 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
25148 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
25149 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
25150 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
25151 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
25152 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
25153 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
25156 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
25157 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
25158 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
25162 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
25163 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
25164 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
25165 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
25168 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
25169 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
25173 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
25174 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
25175 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25176 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
25177 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
25178 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
25179 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
25180 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
25181 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
25182 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
25183 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
25186 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
25188 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
25189 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
25190 &%use_shell%& is set.
25193 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
25194 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25197 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
25198 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
25199 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25202 .option check_string pipe string unset
25203 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
25204 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
25205 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
25206 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
25207 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
25208 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
25209 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
25213 .option command pipe string&!! unset
25214 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
25215 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
25216 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
25217 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
25218 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
25219 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
25221 .cindex "tainted data"
25222 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
25225 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
25226 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25227 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25228 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
25229 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
25230 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25231 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
25234 .option escape_string pipe string unset
25235 See &%check_string%& above.
25238 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
25239 .cindex "exec failure"
25240 .cindex "failure of exec"
25241 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
25242 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
25243 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
25244 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
25245 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
25248 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
25249 .cindex "signal exit"
25250 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
25251 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
25252 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
25253 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
25256 .option force_command pipe boolean false
25257 .cindex "force command"
25258 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
25259 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
25260 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
25261 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
25262 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
25263 command. For example:
25265 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
25269 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
25270 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
25271 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
25274 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
25275 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
25276 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
25277 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
25278 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
25279 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
25281 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
25282 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
25285 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
25286 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
25287 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
25288 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
25289 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
25290 written to the main log.
25293 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
25294 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
25295 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
25296 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
25297 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
25298 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
25302 .option log_output pipe boolean false
25303 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25304 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25305 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25306 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25309 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25310 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25311 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25312 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25313 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25314 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25315 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25316 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25319 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25320 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25321 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25324 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25328 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25329 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25330 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25331 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25332 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25337 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25338 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25341 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25342 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25343 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25344 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25348 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25349 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25352 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25353 This option is expanded and
25354 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25355 variable of the subprocess.
25356 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25357 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25358 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25361 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25362 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25363 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25364 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25365 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25366 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25367 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25368 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25369 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25372 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25373 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25374 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25375 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25376 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25377 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25378 accept the message is used.
25381 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25382 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25383 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25384 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25385 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25386 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25389 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25390 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25391 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25392 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25393 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25394 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25395 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25399 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25400 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25401 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25402 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25403 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25404 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25405 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25406 of them may be set.
25410 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25411 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25412 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25413 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25414 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25415 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25416 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25417 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25418 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25419 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25420 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25421 and 73, respectively.
25424 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25425 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25426 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25427 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25428 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25429 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25430 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25432 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25433 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25434 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25435 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25436 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25437 delivery to be deferred.
25439 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25440 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25443 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25444 .cindex "envelope sender"
25445 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25446 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25447 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25448 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25449 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25451 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25452 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25453 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25454 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25455 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25456 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25460 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25461 .cindex "carriage return"
25463 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25464 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25465 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25466 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25468 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25469 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25470 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25471 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25472 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25475 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25476 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25477 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25478 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25479 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25480 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25481 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25482 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25483 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25488 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25489 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25490 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25491 .cindex "external local delivery"
25492 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25493 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25494 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25495 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25496 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25497 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25498 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25499 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25500 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25501 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25506 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25510 check_string = "From "
25511 escape_string = ">From "
25513 user = $local_part_data
25520 transport = procmail_pipe
25522 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25523 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25524 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25525 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25526 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25527 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25529 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25533 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25534 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25537 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25538 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25539 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25540 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25541 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25544 local_delivery_cyrus:
25546 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25547 -- $local_part_data
25559 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25561 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25562 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25564 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25565 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25571 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25572 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25573 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25574 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25575 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25576 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25577 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25578 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25581 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25582 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25586 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25587 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25588 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25589 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25590 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25591 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25592 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25594 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25595 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25596 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25597 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25598 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25599 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25604 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25605 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25606 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25610 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25612 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25613 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25614 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25615 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25616 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25617 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25618 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25619 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25622 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25623 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25624 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25625 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25626 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25627 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25628 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25629 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25630 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25631 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25632 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25633 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25634 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25635 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25637 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25638 and will be removed in a future release.
25641 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25642 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25643 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25646 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25647 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25648 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25649 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25650 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25651 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25652 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25653 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25655 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25656 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25657 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25658 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25659 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25660 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25661 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25662 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25663 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25666 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25668 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25669 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25670 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25671 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25672 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25675 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25676 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25677 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25678 particular connection.
25680 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25681 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25682 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25683 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25685 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25686 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25687 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25689 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25691 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25692 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25694 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25695 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25699 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25700 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25701 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25702 authenticated as a client.
25705 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25706 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25707 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25708 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25709 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25712 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25713 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25714 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25715 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25716 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25717 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25718 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25719 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by
25720 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1123,RFC 1123).
25723 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25724 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25725 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25726 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25727 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25728 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25729 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25732 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25733 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25734 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25735 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25738 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25739 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25740 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25741 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25742 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25743 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25744 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25745 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25746 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25747 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25748 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25749 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25750 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25751 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25754 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25755 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25756 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25757 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25758 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25761 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25762 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25763 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25764 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25765 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25766 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25767 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25768 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25769 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25770 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25771 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25772 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25773 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25774 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25775 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25776 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25777 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25778 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25781 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25782 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25783 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25784 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25785 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25788 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25789 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25790 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25791 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25792 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25793 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25795 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25796 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25797 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25798 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25799 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25800 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25801 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25802 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25806 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25807 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25808 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25809 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25810 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25813 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25814 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25815 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25816 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25820 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25821 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25822 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25823 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25824 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25825 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25826 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25827 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25832 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25833 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25834 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25835 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25836 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25837 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25838 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25839 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25840 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25844 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25845 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25846 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25847 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25848 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25849 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25850 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25852 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25853 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25854 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25855 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25856 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25859 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25860 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25861 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25862 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25863 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25864 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25865 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25866 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25868 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25869 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25870 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25871 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25872 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25873 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25875 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25876 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25877 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25878 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25879 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25881 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25882 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25883 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25884 copy of the message is sent.
25886 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25887 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25888 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25889 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25893 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25894 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25895 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25896 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25899 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25900 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25901 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25902 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25903 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25904 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25906 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25907 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25908 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25909 implementations of TLS.
25911 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25912 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25913 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25914 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25915 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25916 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25917 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25922 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25923 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25924 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25925 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25926 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25927 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25928 interface address, you could use this:
25930 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25931 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25932 {$primary_hostname}}
25934 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25937 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25938 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25939 .cindex TLS resumption
25940 Some mail-accepting sites
25941 (notably Microsoft)
25942 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25943 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25944 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25945 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25947 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25948 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25949 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25951 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25952 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25955 suffices for one known case.
25957 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25958 server's EHLO response.
25960 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25961 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25962 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25963 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25965 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25966 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25968 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25969 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25970 expression for this option.
25971 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25972 will be useful for such work.
25974 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25975 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25976 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25977 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25978 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25979 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25981 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25982 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25983 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25984 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25986 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25987 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25988 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25989 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25990 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25991 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25992 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25994 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25995 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25996 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25997 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25998 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25999 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
26000 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
26003 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
26004 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
26007 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
26008 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
26009 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
26010 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
26011 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
26012 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
26013 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
26014 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
26015 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
26016 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
26019 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
26020 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
26021 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
26022 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
26023 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
26025 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
26026 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
26027 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
26028 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
26029 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
26030 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
26032 The retry hints database is used for the record,
26033 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
26034 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
26035 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
26036 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
26038 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
26041 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
26042 the &%helo_data%& option
26043 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
26045 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
26046 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
26047 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
26048 You have been warned.
26051 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26052 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
26053 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26054 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26056 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26057 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
26058 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
26059 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
26060 to any host that matches this list.
26063 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
26064 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26065 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
26066 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
26067 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
26068 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
26069 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
26070 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
26073 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
26074 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
26075 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
26080 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26081 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
26082 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
26083 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26084 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
26085 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
26086 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
26087 explanation of when this might be needed.
26089 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26090 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
26091 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
26092 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26093 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
26094 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
26095 message on the same session.
26097 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
26098 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
26099 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
26100 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
26101 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
26102 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
26107 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
26108 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
26109 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
26110 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
26111 &%fallback_hosts%&.
26114 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
26115 .cindex "randomized host list"
26116 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
26117 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
26118 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
26119 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
26120 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
26121 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
26122 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
26123 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
26125 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
26126 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
26127 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
26128 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
26130 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
26132 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
26133 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
26134 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
26136 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26137 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
26138 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
26139 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
26140 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
26141 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
26142 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
26143 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
26144 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26147 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
26148 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26149 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
26150 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26151 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26153 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
26154 or if DANE-TA us used.
26155 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
26157 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
26158 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
26160 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26161 If the TLS library supports ALPN
26162 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
26163 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
26164 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
26166 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
26167 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
26169 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
26170 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26171 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
26172 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
26173 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
26174 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
26175 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26176 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26177 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26179 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
26180 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26181 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
26182 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26183 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26185 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26186 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26187 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26188 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26189 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
26190 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
26192 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26193 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
26194 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26195 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
26196 connects. If authentication fails
26197 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
26198 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
26199 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26201 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
26202 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
26203 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
26204 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
26205 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26206 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
26207 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
26208 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
26210 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
26211 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26212 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
26213 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
26214 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
26215 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
26216 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
26217 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26218 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26219 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26221 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
26222 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
26223 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
26224 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
26225 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
26226 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
26227 perform a TCP Fast Open (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7413,RFC 7413).
26228 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
26229 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
26230 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
26232 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
26233 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
26235 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
26236 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
26237 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
26238 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
26239 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
26241 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
26242 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
26243 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
26244 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26245 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
26246 for multi-recipient messages.
26247 The option can usually be left as default.
26249 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
26250 .cindex "bind IP address"
26251 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
26253 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26254 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
26255 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
26256 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
26257 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
26258 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
26259 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
26260 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
26263 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
26264 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
26265 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
26266 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
26267 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
26268 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
26271 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
26273 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
26274 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
26275 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
26276 interface to use if the host has more than one.
26279 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
26280 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
26281 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
26282 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
26283 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
26284 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
26285 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
26286 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
26287 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
26288 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
26292 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
26293 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
26294 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
26295 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
26296 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
26298 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
26299 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
26302 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
26303 SMTP message transaction.
26304 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26306 If a constant is given,
26307 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26308 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26311 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26312 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26313 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26314 that value also constrains the result of this option
26315 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26318 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26319 .cindex "line length" limit
26320 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26321 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26322 (before a transport filter, if any)
26323 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26325 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26327 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26328 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26331 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26332 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26333 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26334 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26335 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26336 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26337 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26338 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26340 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26341 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26342 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26344 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26345 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26346 sent on the connection.
26348 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26349 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26350 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26351 this option is regarded as being false.
26354 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26355 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26356 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26357 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26358 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26359 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26360 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26361 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26363 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26364 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26366 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26367 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26368 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26371 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26372 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26376 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26377 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26378 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26379 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26381 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26382 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26384 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) instead of SMTP.
26385 This protocol is sometimes used for local
26386 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26387 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26389 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26390 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26392 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26393 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26394 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26395 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26396 but as of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314) it is preferred
26397 over STARTTLS for message submission
26398 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26401 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26402 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26403 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26404 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26405 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26406 addresses is not affected.
26408 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26409 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26410 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26411 Exim to use only the host name.
26412 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26415 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26416 .cindex "serializing connections"
26417 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26418 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26419 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26420 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26421 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26422 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26423 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26425 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26426 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26427 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26428 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26429 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26430 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26432 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26433 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26434 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26435 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26436 are used for ETRN serialization.
26438 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26441 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26442 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26443 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26444 .cindex "size" "of message"
26445 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26446 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26447 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26448 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26449 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26450 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26451 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26452 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26454 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26455 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26458 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26459 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26460 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26461 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26464 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26465 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26467 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26468 If this option is set
26469 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26470 the value given is used.
26472 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26473 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26477 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26478 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26479 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26481 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26482 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26483 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26484 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26485 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26488 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26489 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26490 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26491 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26495 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26496 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26497 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26498 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26499 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26502 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26503 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26504 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26505 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26506 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26507 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26510 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26513 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26514 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26516 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26517 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26518 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26519 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26520 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26521 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26522 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26523 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26526 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26527 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26528 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26530 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26531 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26532 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26533 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26534 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26535 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26536 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26537 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26538 ciphers is a preference order.
26541 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26542 .cindex TLS resumption
26543 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26544 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26548 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26549 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26551 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26552 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26553 If this option is set
26554 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26555 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26556 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26557 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26558 certificate and private key for the session.
26560 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26562 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26568 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26569 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26570 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26571 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26572 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26573 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26574 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26575 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26576 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26577 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26581 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26582 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26583 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26584 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26585 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26586 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26587 Note that unless the host is in this list
26588 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26589 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26590 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26591 certificate verification succeeds.
26594 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26595 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26596 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26597 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26598 while verifying the server certificate,
26599 checks will be included on the host name
26600 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26601 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26602 Wildcard names are permitted,
26603 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26605 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26608 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26609 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26610 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26612 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26613 The value of this option must be either the
26615 or the absolute path to
26616 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26617 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26619 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26620 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26621 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26624 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26625 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26627 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26629 either by file or directory
26630 are added to those given by the system default location.
26632 The values of &$host$& and
26633 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26634 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26636 For back-compatibility,
26637 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26638 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26639 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26642 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26643 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26644 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26645 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26646 certificate verification must succeed.
26647 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26648 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26649 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26650 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26651 that connections use TLS.
26652 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26653 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26655 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26656 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26657 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26658 If built with internationalization support,
26659 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26661 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26662 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26663 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26664 set this option to an empty string.
26665 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26670 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26672 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26673 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26674 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26675 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26676 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26679 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26680 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26681 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26682 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26685 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26686 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26687 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26689 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26690 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26691 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26692 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26693 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26695 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26696 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26697 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26698 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26699 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26700 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26701 see below for an exception).
26703 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26704 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26705 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26706 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26707 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26709 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26710 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26711 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26712 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26713 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26714 reached their retry times.
26716 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26717 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26718 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26719 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26720 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26721 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26722 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26723 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26724 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26725 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26728 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26729 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26730 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26731 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26732 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26733 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26735 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26736 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26737 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26738 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26739 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26740 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26746 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26749 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26750 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26751 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26752 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26753 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26754 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26756 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26757 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26758 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26759 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26760 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26761 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26762 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26764 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26765 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26766 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26767 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26770 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26771 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26772 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26773 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26775 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26776 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26777 facility; you do not have to use it.
26779 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26780 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26781 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26782 address to which it applies.
26784 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26785 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26786 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26787 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26788 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26789 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26792 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26793 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26794 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26795 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26798 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26799 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26800 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26801 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26802 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26805 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26806 illustrated by these examples:
26809 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26810 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26811 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26812 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26814 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26815 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26820 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26821 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26822 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26823 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26824 message's processing.
26826 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26827 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26828 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26829 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26830 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26831 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26832 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26833 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26834 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26836 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26837 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26838 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26839 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26840 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26841 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26842 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26843 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26844 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26845 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26847 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26848 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26849 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26850 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26851 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26852 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26854 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26855 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26856 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26858 .cindex "envelope from"
26859 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26860 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26861 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26862 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26863 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26864 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26865 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26866 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26867 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26869 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26870 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26876 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26877 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26878 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26879 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26880 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26881 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full
26882 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
26883 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26884 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26885 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26886 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26888 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26890 might produce the output
26892 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26893 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26894 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26895 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26896 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26897 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26898 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26899 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26901 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26902 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26903 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26904 set for a particular transport.
26907 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26908 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26909 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26912 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26914 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26915 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26916 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26917 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26919 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26920 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26921 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26922 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26925 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26926 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26927 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26929 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26930 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26931 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26932 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26933 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26934 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26935 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26937 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26938 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26939 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26940 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26941 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26945 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26946 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26949 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26950 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26951 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26952 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26953 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26954 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26955 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26956 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26957 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26959 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26960 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26961 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26963 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26964 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26965 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26966 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26967 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26968 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26969 of pattern they are set as follows:
26972 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26973 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26974 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26977 *queen@*.fict.example
26979 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26981 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26985 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26986 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26989 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26990 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26991 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26992 rewriting rule of the form
26994 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26996 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
27002 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
27003 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
27004 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
27005 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
27006 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
27010 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
27011 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
27012 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
27013 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
27014 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
27016 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
27018 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
27021 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27022 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27023 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
27024 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
27025 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
27026 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
27027 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
27028 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
27029 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
27030 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
27031 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
27032 entry written to the panic log.
27036 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
27037 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
27040 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
27043 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
27045 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
27048 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
27049 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
27053 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
27055 .cindex rewriting flags
27056 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
27057 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
27058 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
27059 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
27060 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
27062 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
27063 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
27064 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
27065 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
27066 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
27067 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
27068 &`h`& rewrite all headers
27069 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
27070 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
27071 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
27073 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
27074 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
27075 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
27077 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
27078 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
27081 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
27082 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
27083 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
27084 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
27085 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
27086 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
27087 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
27088 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
27089 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
27091 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27092 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27093 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
27094 compliant with RFCs
27095 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,2821) and
27096 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822)
27097 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
27098 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
27099 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
27100 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
27101 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
27104 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
27105 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
27106 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
27107 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
27110 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
27111 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
27112 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
27114 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
27115 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
27116 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
27117 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
27119 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
27120 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
27121 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
27123 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
27124 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
27125 to the working part of the address, with any comments and
27126 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
27127 &"phrase"& left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
27129 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
27133 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
27136 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
27137 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
27138 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
27139 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete
27140 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
27141 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
27142 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
27143 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to
27144 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). The character set
27145 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
27147 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
27148 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
27152 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
27153 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
27155 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
27156 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
27157 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
27159 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
27160 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
27161 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
27162 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
27163 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
27164 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
27165 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
27166 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
27168 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
27169 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
27171 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
27173 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
27174 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
27176 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
27177 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
27178 messages that originate outside the local host:
27180 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
27181 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
27183 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
27186 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
27187 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
27188 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
27189 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
27190 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
27191 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
27192 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
27193 components. For example, the rule
27195 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
27197 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
27198 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
27199 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
27200 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
27201 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
27202 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
27203 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
27210 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27213 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
27214 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
27215 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
27216 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
27217 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
27218 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
27219 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
27220 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
27221 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
27222 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
27223 address, domain and error.
27225 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
27226 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
27227 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
27228 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
27229 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
27230 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
27231 log selector is set, the message
27232 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
27233 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
27234 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
27235 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
27237 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
27238 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
27239 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
27240 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
27241 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
27242 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
27243 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
27244 domain are maintained independently.
27246 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
27247 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
27248 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
27249 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
27250 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
27251 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
27252 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
27253 the local address is reached.
27255 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
27256 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
27257 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
27258 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
27259 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
27261 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
27262 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
27263 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
27264 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
27265 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
27266 messages that it should now be retaining.
27270 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
27271 .cindex "retry" "rules"
27272 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
27273 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
27274 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
27275 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
27276 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
27277 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
27278 message's sender, respectively.
27281 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
27282 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
27283 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
27284 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
27285 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
27286 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
27289 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27291 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
27294 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27296 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
27297 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
27300 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
27301 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
27302 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
27303 expressions work in address lists.
27305 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
27306 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
27310 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
27311 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
27312 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
27313 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
27314 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27315 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27316 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27317 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27318 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27320 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27321 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27322 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27323 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27326 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27327 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27328 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27329 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27330 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27331 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27332 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27333 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27334 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27335 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27340 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27342 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27343 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27344 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27345 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27346 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27347 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27349 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27353 and the retry rules are
27355 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27356 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27358 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27359 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27360 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27361 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27362 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27363 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27365 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27366 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27367 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27368 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27370 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27371 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27372 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27374 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27376 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27377 textual form of the IP address.
27379 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27380 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27381 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27382 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27385 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27386 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27387 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27389 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27390 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27391 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27393 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27394 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27396 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27397 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27400 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27401 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27402 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27403 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27404 retry rule of this form:
27406 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27408 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27409 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27412 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27413 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27414 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27415 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27418 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27419 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27420 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27421 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27422 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27424 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27425 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27427 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27428 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27431 A connection was refused.
27433 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27434 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27436 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27437 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27439 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27440 A connection attempt timed out.
27442 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27443 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27444 obtained from an MX record.
27446 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27447 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27448 obtained from an MX record.
27451 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27453 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27454 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27455 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27456 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27459 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27462 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27463 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27464 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27465 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27466 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27467 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27471 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27472 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27473 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27474 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27475 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27479 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27480 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27481 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27483 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27484 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27485 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27486 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27487 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27488 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27489 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27491 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27492 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27495 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27496 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27497 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27502 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27503 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27504 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27505 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27506 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27509 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27511 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27513 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27515 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27516 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27519 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27521 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27522 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27523 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27524 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27525 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27527 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27528 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27530 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27532 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27533 list is never matched.
27539 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27540 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27541 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27542 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27544 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27546 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27547 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27548 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27549 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27550 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27552 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27553 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27554 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27555 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27556 The available algorithms are:
27559 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27562 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27563 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27564 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27566 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27567 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27568 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27569 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27570 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27571 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27572 queue processing times.
27575 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27576 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27577 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27578 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27579 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27580 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27581 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27582 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27583 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27584 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27585 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27586 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27588 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27589 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27590 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27591 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27592 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27593 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27596 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27597 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27598 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27599 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27600 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27601 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27602 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27603 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27604 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27605 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27606 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27607 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27609 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27610 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27611 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27612 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27613 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27614 deliveries that have been deferred.
27617 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27618 Here are some example retry rules:
27620 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27621 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27622 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27623 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27624 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27625 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27627 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27628 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27629 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27630 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27631 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27632 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27633 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27636 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27637 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27638 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27639 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27640 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27642 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27643 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27644 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27645 were not obtained from an MX record.
27647 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27648 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27649 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27650 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27651 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27655 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27656 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27657 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27658 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27659 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27660 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27661 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27662 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27663 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27664 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27665 failing for the first time.
27667 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27668 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27669 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27670 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27672 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27673 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27674 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27679 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27680 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27681 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27682 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27683 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27684 default retry rule:
27686 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27688 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27689 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27690 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27692 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27693 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27694 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27695 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27696 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27698 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27699 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27700 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27702 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27703 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27704 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27705 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27706 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27707 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27708 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27709 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27710 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27711 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27712 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27714 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27715 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27716 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27717 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27718 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27721 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27722 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27723 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27724 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27725 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27726 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27727 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27728 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27729 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27732 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27733 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27734 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27735 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27736 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27737 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27738 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27739 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27742 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27743 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27744 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27745 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27746 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27747 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27748 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27749 time out the address.
27751 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27752 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27753 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27754 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27755 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27756 considered immediately.
27757 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27758 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27765 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27768 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27769 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27770 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27771 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27772 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27774 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2554,RFC 2554),
27775 which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27776 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27777 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27778 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27781 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27782 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27785 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27786 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27787 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27790 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27791 the client's EHLO command.
27793 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27794 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27796 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27797 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27798 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27799 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27800 with the AUTH command.
27802 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27804 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27805 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27806 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27809 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27810 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27811 unauthenticated connection.
27814 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27815 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27816 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27817 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27819 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27820 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27821 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27822 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27823 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27824 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27825 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27826 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27831 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27832 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27833 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27834 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27835 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27836 included by setting
27839 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27843 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27848 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27849 authentication mechanism
27850 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195)),
27851 and the second provides an interface to the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27852 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27853 work via a socket interface.
27854 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27855 as defined by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
27856 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27857 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27858 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27859 supporting setting a server keytab.
27860 The seventh can be configured to support
27861 the PLAIN authentication mechanism
27862 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
27863 or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27864 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27865 The eighth authenticator
27866 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27867 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27868 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27870 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27871 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27872 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27873 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27874 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27875 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27876 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27878 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27879 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27880 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27881 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27882 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27883 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27887 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27888 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27890 client_secret = secret2
27892 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27893 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27895 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27896 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27897 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27900 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27901 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27902 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27903 authenticating data.
27905 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27906 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27907 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27908 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27909 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27910 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27911 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27912 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27913 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27914 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27917 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27918 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27919 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27920 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27924 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27925 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27926 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27928 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27929 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27930 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27931 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27932 encrypted by a setting such as:
27934 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27938 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27939 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27940 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27941 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27944 .option driver authenticators string unset
27945 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27946 authenticators is to be used.
27949 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27950 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27951 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27952 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens
27953 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)),
27954 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27955 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27958 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27959 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27960 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27961 mechanism is not advertised.
27962 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27963 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27964 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27967 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27968 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27969 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27972 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27973 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27975 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27976 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27977 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27978 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27979 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27980 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27981 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27982 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27983 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27987 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27988 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27989 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27990 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27991 out the values of variables.
27992 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27993 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27996 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27997 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27998 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27999 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
28000 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
28001 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
28002 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
28003 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
28004 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
28005 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
28006 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
28007 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
28010 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28011 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
28012 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
28013 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
28014 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
28015 remembered for later use.
28016 How it is used is described in the following section.
28022 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
28023 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
28024 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28025 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
28026 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
28030 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
28031 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
28033 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
28035 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
28036 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
28037 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
28038 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
28039 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
28040 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
28041 given for the MAIL command.
28043 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
28044 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
28047 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
28048 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
28049 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
28050 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
28051 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
28052 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
28053 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
28058 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
28059 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
28060 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
28061 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
28063 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
28064 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
28065 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
28066 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
28067 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
28072 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
28073 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
28074 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
28075 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
28079 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
28081 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
28082 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
28085 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
28086 the mechanisms are advertised.
28088 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
28089 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
28090 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
28091 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
28092 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
28093 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
28094 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
28096 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
28098 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
28100 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
28101 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
28102 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
28105 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
28107 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28108 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
28109 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
28111 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
28112 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
28113 command. This is the case if
28116 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
28118 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
28120 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
28121 server authenticators.
28125 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
28126 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
28127 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
28129 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
28130 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
28131 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
28132 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
28133 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
28134 rejected with a 504 error.
28136 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
28137 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
28138 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
28139 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
28140 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
28141 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
28142 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
28143 no successful authentication.
28145 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
28146 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
28147 &%authresults%& expansion item.
28149 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
28150 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
28151 an event of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28152 While the event is being processed the variables
28153 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28154 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
28156 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
28157 instead of the default log line.
28158 See &<<CHAPevents>>& for details on events.
28161 .subsection "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
28162 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
28163 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
28164 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
28165 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
28166 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
28167 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
28171 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
28173 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
28174 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
28175 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
28176 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
28177 command line to run this script on such data might be
28179 encode '\0user\0password'
28181 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
28182 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
28183 whose code value is zero.
28185 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
28186 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
28187 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
28188 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
28190 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
28191 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
28192 example, a command such as
28194 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
28196 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
28198 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
28199 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
28201 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
28203 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
28204 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
28205 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
28206 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
28210 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
28211 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
28212 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
28213 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
28214 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
28215 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
28218 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
28219 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
28220 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
28221 of the authenticator.
28224 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28225 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
28226 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
28227 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
28228 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
28229 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
28230 delivery to be deferred.
28232 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
28233 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
28234 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
28238 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
28239 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
28240 an event of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28241 While the event is being processed the variable
28242 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28244 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
28245 See &<<CHAPevents>>& for details on events.
28248 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
28249 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
28250 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
28251 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
28252 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
28253 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
28254 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
28255 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
28256 deliver the message unauthenticated.
28259 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
28260 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
28261 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
28262 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
28263 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
28264 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
28265 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
28266 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
28268 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
28270 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28271 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
28272 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
28273 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
28274 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
28275 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
28276 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
28277 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
28278 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
28279 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
28280 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
28281 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
28282 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
28289 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28290 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28292 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
28293 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
28294 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
28295 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
28296 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
28297 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
28298 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
28299 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
28300 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
28301 connections as you do for login accounts.
28303 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
28304 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
28305 TLS is not being used:
28307 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
28308 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
28311 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
28312 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
28313 (including their names) have been properly verified.
28315 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
28316 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
28317 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
28319 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28320 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28321 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28323 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28324 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28325 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28328 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28329 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28330 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28331 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28332 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28333 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28334 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28336 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28337 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28338 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28339 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28340 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28341 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28342 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28344 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28345 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28346 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28347 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28349 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28350 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28351 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28353 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28354 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28355 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28356 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28357 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28358 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28359 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28360 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28361 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28362 string as the error text.
28364 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28365 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28366 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28370 .subsection "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28371 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28372 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28373 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28374 The PLAIN authentication mechanism
28375 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
28376 specifies that three strings be
28377 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28378 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28379 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28381 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28382 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28383 configured as follows:
28387 public_name = PLAIN
28389 server_condition = \
28390 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28391 server_set_id = $auth2
28393 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28394 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28395 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28396 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28398 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28399 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28400 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28401 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28405 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28407 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28409 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28410 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28414 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28415 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28417 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28418 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28419 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28420 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28421 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28423 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28424 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28425 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28427 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28428 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28429 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28430 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28431 This is an incorrect example:
28433 server_condition = \
28434 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28436 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28437 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28438 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28439 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28440 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28441 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28442 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28444 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28445 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28447 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28448 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28449 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28450 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28451 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28454 .subsection "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28455 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28456 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28457 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28458 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28459 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28460 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28464 public_name = LOGIN
28465 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28466 server_condition = \
28467 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28468 server_set_id = $auth1
28470 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28471 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28472 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28473 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28475 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28476 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28477 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28478 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28479 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28483 public_name = LOGIN
28484 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28485 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28488 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28489 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28490 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28491 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28493 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28494 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28495 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28496 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28497 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28498 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28499 uninterpreted string.
28502 .subsection "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28503 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28504 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28505 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28506 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28512 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28513 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28514 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28516 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28517 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28518 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28519 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28522 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28523 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28524 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28525 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28526 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28527 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28528 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28529 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28530 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28531 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28532 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28533 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28535 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28536 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28538 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28539 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28540 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28541 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28544 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28545 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28549 public_name = PLAIN
28550 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28552 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28553 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28554 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28555 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28559 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28563 public_name = LOGIN
28564 client_send = : username : mysecret
28566 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28567 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28569 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28570 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28578 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28579 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28580 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28581 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28582 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28583 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in
28584 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195). The server
28585 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28586 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28587 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28588 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28589 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28590 available in plain text at either end.
28593 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28594 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28595 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28596 authenticator as a server:
28598 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28599 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28600 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28601 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28602 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28603 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28604 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28605 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28606 returned to the client.
28608 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28609 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28610 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28611 numeric variables for other things.
28613 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28614 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28615 user name, authentication fails.
28619 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28620 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28621 server_set_id = $auth1
28623 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28624 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28625 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28626 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28630 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28631 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28633 server_set_id = $auth1
28635 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28636 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28638 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28639 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28640 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28645 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28646 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28647 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28648 server_set_id = $auth1
28651 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28652 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28653 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28657 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28658 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28659 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28662 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28663 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28664 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28668 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28669 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28670 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28671 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28672 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28673 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28674 send the message to the current server.
28676 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28681 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28683 client_secret = secret
28685 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28686 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28691 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28693 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28694 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28695 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28696 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28698 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28699 at A L Digital Ltd.
28701 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28702 library implementation of the
28703 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)
28704 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28705 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28706 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28707 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28709 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28710 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28711 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28712 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28714 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28715 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28716 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28717 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28718 depending on the driver you are using.
28720 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28721 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28722 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28723 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28724 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28727 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28728 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28729 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28730 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28731 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28732 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28733 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28734 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28737 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28738 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28739 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28740 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28741 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28742 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28746 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28747 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28748 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28749 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28752 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28753 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28754 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28755 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28759 driver = cyrus_sasl
28760 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28761 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28762 server_set_id = $auth1
28765 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28766 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28769 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28770 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28773 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28774 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28775 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28776 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28779 driver = cyrus_sasl
28780 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28781 server_set_id = $auth1
28784 driver = cyrus_sasl
28785 public_name = PLAIN
28786 server_set_id = $auth2
28788 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28789 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28790 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28791 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28792 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28799 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28800 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28801 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28802 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28803 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28804 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28805 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28806 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28807 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28809 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28811 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28812 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28813 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28814 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28818 public_name = PLAIN
28819 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28820 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28821 server_set_id = $auth1
28826 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28827 server_set_id = $auth1
28830 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28831 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28832 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28834 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28835 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28836 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28837 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28838 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28839 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28841 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28844 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28849 unix_listener auth-client {
28856 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28858 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28861 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28862 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28867 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28868 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28869 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28870 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28871 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28872 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28873 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28874 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28875 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28876 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28877 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28878 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28879 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28880 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28881 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28882 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28883 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28884 without code changes in Exim.
28886 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28887 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28888 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28891 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28892 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28893 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28896 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28897 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28898 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28899 by &%client_username%& option.
28900 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28901 which is the common case.
28903 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28904 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28906 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28907 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28908 the password to be used, in clear.
28910 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28911 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28912 the account name to be used.
28915 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28916 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28917 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28919 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28920 and correctly sized
28921 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28922 The value after expansion should be
28923 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28924 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28926 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28927 supplied by the server.
28928 The option is expanded before use.
28929 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28930 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28931 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28933 The intent of this option
28934 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28935 to save on recalculation costs.
28936 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28937 (eg. an empty string)
28938 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28940 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28941 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28942 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28943 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28944 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28947 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28948 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28949 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28950 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28951 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28954 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28955 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28956 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28959 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28960 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28961 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28963 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28964 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28965 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28967 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28968 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28969 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28971 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28972 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28973 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28974 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28977 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28978 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28979 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28980 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28983 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28984 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28985 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28986 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28991 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28992 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28993 server_set_id = $auth1
28997 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28998 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28999 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
29000 the password itself.
29002 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
29003 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
29004 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
29005 if available, else the empty string.
29006 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
29007 else the empty string.
29009 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
29011 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
29012 option to be simply "true".
29015 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
29016 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
29017 Some mechanisms will use this data.
29020 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
29021 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
29022 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
29023 when this option is expanded.
29025 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
29026 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
29027 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
29028 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
29029 either the iteration count or the salt).
29030 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
29031 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
29033 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
29034 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
29035 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
29036 when this option is expanded.
29037 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
29038 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
29039 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
29040 protocol conversation.
29043 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
29044 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
29045 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
29046 to provide stored information related to a password,
29047 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
29049 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
29050 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
29052 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
29053 When this is so, the macros
29054 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
29055 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
29058 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
29060 If set, the results of expansion should for each
29061 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
29062 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
29063 &%server_password%& option.
29064 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
29066 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
29067 to generate these values.
29070 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
29071 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
29072 Some mechanisms will use this data.
29075 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
29076 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29077 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
29078 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
29080 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
29081 meanings for these variables:
29084 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29085 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
29087 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29088 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
29090 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
29091 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
29094 On a per-mechanism basis:
29097 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
29098 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
29099 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29101 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
29102 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
29103 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29105 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
29106 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
29107 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
29108 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29111 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
29112 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
29113 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
29116 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
29117 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
29119 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
29121 public_name = CRAM-MD5
29122 server_realm = imap.example.org
29123 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
29124 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
29125 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
29126 server_condition = yes
29130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29133 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
29134 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
29135 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
29136 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
29137 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
29138 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
29139 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
29142 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
29143 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
29144 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
29145 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
29147 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
29148 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
29149 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
29150 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
29152 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
29153 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
29154 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
29158 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
29159 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
29160 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
29161 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
29163 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
29164 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
29165 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
29166 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
29168 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29170 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29171 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
29173 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29174 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
29175 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
29180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29181 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29183 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
29184 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
29185 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
29186 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
29187 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
29188 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
29189 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
29190 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
29191 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
29192 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
29193 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
29194 taken from the &url(https://www.samba.org/,Samba project). The code for the
29195 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
29199 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
29200 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
29202 The server sends back a challenge.
29204 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
29205 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
29208 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
29212 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
29213 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
29214 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
29216 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
29217 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
29218 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
29219 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
29220 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
29221 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
29222 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
29223 for other things. For example:
29228 server_password = \
29229 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
29231 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29232 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29238 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
29239 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
29240 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
29244 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
29245 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
29248 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
29249 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
29252 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
29253 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
29254 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
29260 client_username = msn/msn_username
29261 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
29262 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
29264 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
29265 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
29271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29274 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
29275 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
29276 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
29277 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29278 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29279 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29280 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
29281 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
29282 The specification is in
29283 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
29284 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
29285 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
29286 by the server configuration.
29288 The client presents an identity in-clear.
29289 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
29290 and for clients to only attempt,
29291 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
29293 One possible use, compatible with the
29294 &url(https://k9mail.github.io/,K-9 Mail Android client)
29295 is for using X509 client certificates.
29297 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
29298 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
29299 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
29300 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
29301 client certificates only.
29303 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
29304 client-certificate authentication is being done.
29306 The client must present a certificate,
29307 for which it must have been requested via the
29308 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29309 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29310 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
29311 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
29313 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
29314 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
29315 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
29317 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
29318 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
29319 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29320 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
29321 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
29322 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29323 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29325 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29327 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29328 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29329 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29330 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29331 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29332 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29334 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29335 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29336 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29337 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29338 an identity for authentication and
29339 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29341 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29342 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29343 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29344 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29346 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29347 Once an identity has been received,
29348 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29349 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29350 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29351 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29352 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29353 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29354 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29355 string as the error text.
29359 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29361 public_name = EXTERNAL
29363 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29364 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29365 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29366 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29367 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29368 server_set_id = $auth1
29370 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29371 of your configured trust-anchors
29372 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29373 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29375 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29376 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29377 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29381 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29382 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29383 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29385 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29386 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29387 identity being asserted.
29393 public_name = EXTERNAL
29395 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29396 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29400 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29401 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29407 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29410 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29411 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29412 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29413 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29414 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29415 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29416 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29417 authentication based on client certificates.
29419 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29420 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29421 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29422 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29423 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29424 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29426 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29427 for which it must have been requested via the
29428 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29429 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29431 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29432 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29433 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29434 and can authenticate the connection.
29435 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29437 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29440 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29441 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29443 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29444 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29445 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29446 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29447 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29448 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29450 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29451 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29452 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29454 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29461 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29462 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29463 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29466 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29467 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29468 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29470 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29472 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29473 of your configured trust-anchors
29474 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29475 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29477 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29478 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29479 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29481 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29483 . An alternative might use
29485 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29487 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29488 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29489 . This would help for per-device use.
29491 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29492 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29494 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29495 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29498 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29499 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29500 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29504 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29507 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29508 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29509 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29510 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29511 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29514 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29515 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29516 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29517 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29518 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29519 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29520 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29521 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29522 certificates are used.
29524 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3207,RFC 3207)
29525 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29526 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29527 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29528 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29529 between them is encrypted.
29531 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29532 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29533 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29534 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29537 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29538 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29539 in order to get TLS to work.
29543 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29545 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29546 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29547 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29548 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29549 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29550 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29551 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29553 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314),
29554 the common practice of using the historically
29555 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29556 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29557 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29559 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29560 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29561 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29563 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29564 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29565 reassigned for other use.
29566 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29568 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29569 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29570 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29572 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29573 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29574 the most common use is expected to be:
29576 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29578 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29579 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29580 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29581 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29582 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29585 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29586 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29593 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29594 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29595 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29596 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29602 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29608 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29609 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29611 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29614 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29615 cannot be the path of a directory
29616 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29617 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29619 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29621 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29622 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29623 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29624 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with
29625 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2253,RFC 2253). This
29626 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29628 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29629 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29630 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29631 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29632 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29633 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29634 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29637 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29638 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29640 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29641 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29642 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29643 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29645 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29646 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29648 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29649 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29650 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29651 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29653 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29655 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29659 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29660 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29661 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29662 but not the chosen filename.
29663 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29664 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29666 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29667 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29668 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29669 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29671 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29672 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29673 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29674 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29675 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29676 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29677 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29679 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29680 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29681 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29682 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29683 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29685 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29686 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29687 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29688 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29689 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29690 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29692 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29693 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29694 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29696 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29697 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29698 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29699 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29702 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29705 # chown exim:exim new-params
29706 # chmod 0600 new-params
29707 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29708 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29709 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29710 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29711 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29712 # chmod 0400 new-params
29713 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29715 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29716 stalling is removed.
29718 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29719 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29720 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29721 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29722 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29723 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29724 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29725 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29726 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29727 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29728 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29730 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29731 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29732 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29733 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29735 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29736 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29737 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29738 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29739 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29742 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29743 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29744 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29745 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29746 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29747 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29748 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29749 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29750 directly to this function call.
29751 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29752 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29753 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29754 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29757 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29759 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29760 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29761 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29764 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29765 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29766 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29770 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29773 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29774 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29777 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29778 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29780 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29781 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29784 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29785 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29786 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29787 not be moved to the end of the list.
29790 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29793 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29794 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29797 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29798 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29799 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29800 choice of clients used:
29802 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29803 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29808 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29810 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29813 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29814 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29815 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29816 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29818 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29820 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29824 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29826 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29827 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29828 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29829 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29830 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29831 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29832 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29833 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29834 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29835 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29837 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29838 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29840 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29841 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29842 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29843 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29844 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29845 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29847 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29848 "Priority strings". This is online as
29849 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29850 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29851 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29852 then the example code
29853 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29854 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29858 # Disable older versions of protocols
29859 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29862 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29863 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29864 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29866 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29867 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29868 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29869 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29873 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29879 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29880 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29881 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29882 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29883 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29884 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29885 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29886 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29888 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29889 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29891 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29892 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29893 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29896 554 Security failure
29898 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29899 rejected with a 554 error code.
29901 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29902 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29904 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29905 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29906 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29907 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29909 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29911 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29913 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29914 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29916 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29917 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29918 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29919 that goes with it. These files need to be
29920 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29921 always be given as full path names.
29922 The key must not be password-protected.
29923 They can be the same file if both the
29924 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29925 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29926 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29927 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29928 the server's certificate.
29930 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29931 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29932 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29933 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29934 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29935 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29937 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29938 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29939 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29941 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29942 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29943 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29946 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29947 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29948 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29950 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29952 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29953 with the parameters contained in the file.
29954 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29959 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29960 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29961 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29962 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29968 for a way of generating file data.
29970 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29971 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29972 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29973 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29974 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29976 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29977 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29978 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29979 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29980 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29981 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29982 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29983 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29984 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29986 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29987 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29988 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29989 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29990 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29991 documentation for more details.
29993 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29994 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29997 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29998 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29999 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30000 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
30001 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
30002 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
30003 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
30004 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
30005 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
30006 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
30007 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
30008 an explicit file or,
30009 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
30010 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
30012 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
30015 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
30016 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
30017 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
30019 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
30021 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
30023 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
30024 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
30026 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
30027 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
30028 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
30029 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
30030 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
30031 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
30032 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
30033 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
30034 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
30035 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
30037 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
30038 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
30039 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
30040 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
30042 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
30043 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
30044 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
30045 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
30046 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
30047 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
30050 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
30051 .cindex certificate caching
30052 .cindex privatekey caching
30053 .cindex crl caching
30054 .cindex ocsp caching
30055 .cindex ciphers caching
30056 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30057 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30058 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30059 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30060 .cindex tls_crl caching
30061 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
30062 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30063 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30064 .cindex caching certificate
30065 .cindex caching privatekey
30066 .cindex caching crl
30067 .cindex caching ocsp
30068 .cindex caching ciphers
30069 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30070 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
30071 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
30072 expandable elements,
30073 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
30074 It is made available
30075 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
30077 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
30079 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
30080 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
30081 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30083 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30084 containing files specified by these options.
30086 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30087 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30088 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30089 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
30090 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30091 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30092 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30093 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30095 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30096 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30098 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30099 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30105 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
30106 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
30107 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
30108 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
30109 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
30110 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
30111 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
30112 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
30113 within the &(smtp)& transport.
30115 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
30116 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
30117 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
30118 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
30119 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
30120 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
30122 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
30123 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
30124 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
30125 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
30126 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
30129 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
30130 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
30131 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
30132 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
30133 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
30134 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
30135 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
30136 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
30137 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
30138 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
30141 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
30142 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
30144 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
30146 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
30147 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
30149 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
30150 for client use (they are usable for server use).
30151 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
30152 in failed connections.
30154 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
30155 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
30157 the system default set (depending on library version),
30159 or (depending on library version) a directory.
30160 The client verifies the server's certificate
30161 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
30162 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
30163 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
30164 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
30166 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
30167 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
30168 or need not succeed respectively.
30170 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
30171 name checks are made on the server certificate.
30172 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
30173 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
30174 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
30175 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
30176 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
30177 The option defaults to always checking.
30179 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
30180 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
30181 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
30183 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
30184 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
30185 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
30188 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
30189 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
30190 for OCSP to be relevant.
30193 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
30194 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
30195 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
30196 alternative hosts, if any.
30199 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
30200 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
30201 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
30205 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
30206 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
30207 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
30208 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
30209 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
30211 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
30212 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
30213 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
30214 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
30215 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
30216 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
30217 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
30218 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
30219 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
30220 outgoing connection.
30224 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
30225 .cindex certificate caching
30226 .cindex privatekey caching
30227 .cindex crl caching
30228 .cindex ciphers caching
30229 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30230 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30231 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30232 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30233 .cindex tls_crl caching
30234 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30235 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30236 .cindex caching certificate
30237 .cindex caching privatekey
30238 .cindex caching crl
30239 .cindex caching ciphers
30240 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30241 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
30242 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
30243 expandable elements,
30244 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
30245 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
30246 command-line specified message delivery.
30247 It is made available
30248 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
30250 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
30252 If caching is not possible, the load
30253 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30255 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
30256 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30257 containing files specified by these options.
30259 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30260 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30261 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30262 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
30263 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30264 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30265 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30266 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30268 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30269 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30271 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30272 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30278 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
30279 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
30282 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
30283 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
30284 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
30285 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
30286 extensions, documented in
30287 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6066,RFC 6066)
30288 (and before that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4366,RFC 4366)) is
30289 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
30290 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
30291 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
30294 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
30295 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
30298 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
30299 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
30300 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
30301 be of limited use in that environment.
30303 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
30304 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
30305 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
30306 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
30307 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
30309 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
30310 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
30311 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
30312 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
30313 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
30315 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
30316 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
30318 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
30319 received from a client.
30320 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
30322 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
30323 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
30324 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
30327 &%tls_certificate%&
30333 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30338 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30339 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30340 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30341 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30342 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30343 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30344 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30346 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30349 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30350 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30351 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30352 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30354 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30355 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30356 built, then you have SNI support).
30360 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30361 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30362 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30363 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30364 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30366 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30367 the server responds with a selected one.
30368 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30369 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30370 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30371 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30372 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30374 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30375 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30376 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30377 There are no variables providing observability.
30378 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30379 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30380 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30382 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30383 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30384 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30388 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30390 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30391 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30392 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30393 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30394 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30395 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30396 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30397 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30398 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30399 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30401 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30402 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30403 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30404 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30405 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30406 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30407 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30409 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30410 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30411 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30412 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30413 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30414 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30415 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30416 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30417 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30419 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30420 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30421 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30422 information is recorded.
30424 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30425 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30426 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30431 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30432 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30433 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30434 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30435 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30436 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30438 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30439 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30440 document is currently at
30442 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30444 and their FAQ is at
30446 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30449 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30450 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30452 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30453 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30454 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30455 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30458 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30459 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30460 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30461 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30462 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30463 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30464 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30465 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30466 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30467 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30468 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30469 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30470 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30472 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30473 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30474 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30475 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30479 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30480 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30481 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30482 with OpenSSL, like this:
30483 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30484 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30486 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30489 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30490 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30491 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30492 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30493 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30494 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30495 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30497 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30498 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30499 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30500 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30501 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30502 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30504 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30505 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30506 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30507 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30508 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30509 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30510 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30511 be a sensible resolution).
30513 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30514 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30515 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30517 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30518 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30519 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30520 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30521 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30522 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30524 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30525 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30526 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30527 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30530 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30531 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30532 .cindex "revocation list"
30533 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30534 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30535 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30539 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30540 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30541 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30542 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30543 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30545 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30546 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30549 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30550 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30551 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30552 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30553 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30554 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30556 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30557 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30558 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30559 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30562 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30563 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30564 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30565 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30566 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30567 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30568 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30569 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30571 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30572 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30573 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30575 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30576 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30577 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30578 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30579 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30581 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30582 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30583 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30584 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30585 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30588 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30589 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30592 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30593 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30594 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30595 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30596 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30597 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30599 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30600 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30602 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30605 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30606 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30607 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30609 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30610 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30611 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30616 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30617 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30620 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30621 .cindex TLS resumption
30622 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30623 in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5077,RFC 5077) for 1.2).
30624 The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 (or later).
30626 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30627 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30628 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30629 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30630 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30633 Operational cost/benefit:
30635 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30636 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30638 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30639 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30640 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30641 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30642 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30643 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30646 .cindex "hints database" tls
30647 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30648 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30653 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30654 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30655 all connections using the resumed session.
30656 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30657 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30658 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30659 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30660 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30662 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30663 used for session negotiation.
30668 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30671 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30672 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30673 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30674 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30675 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30680 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30681 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30682 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30683 Commonly this can be done like this:
30685 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30687 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30688 is offered and/or accepted.
30690 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30691 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30692 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30693 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30694 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30700 In a resumed session:
30702 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30703 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30705 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30706 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30707 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30713 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30715 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30716 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30717 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30718 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30719 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30720 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30722 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30723 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30724 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30726 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30727 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30729 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30730 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30731 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30733 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30735 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30736 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30737 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30740 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30742 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30745 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30746 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30747 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30748 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30750 .subsection "DNS records"
30751 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30752 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30753 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30754 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30756 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30757 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30758 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30759 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30760 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30761 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30763 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30764 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30765 does require careful arrangement.
30766 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30767 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30768 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30769 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30770 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30772 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30773 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30775 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30776 "MTA-STS", described below.
30778 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30779 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30780 connections to you.
30781 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30782 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30783 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30784 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30785 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30786 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30788 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30789 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30790 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30791 random serial numbers.
30792 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30793 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30794 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30795 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30797 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30798 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30800 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30803 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30804 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30809 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30811 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30814 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30817 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30818 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30821 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30823 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30824 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30825 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30826 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30828 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30829 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30831 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30832 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30833 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30834 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30837 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30838 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30842 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30843 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30844 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30845 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30846 control the OCSP request.
30848 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30849 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30852 .subsection "Client configuration"
30853 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30854 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30855 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30856 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30857 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30859 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30861 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30862 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30863 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30864 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30866 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30867 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30868 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30869 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30870 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30871 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30872 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30874 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30878 tls_try_verify_hosts
30879 tls_verify_certificates
30881 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30885 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30886 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30888 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30889 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30891 .subsection Observability
30892 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30894 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30895 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30896 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30897 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30899 .cindex DANE reporting
30900 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30901 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30902 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30903 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30904 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30905 Section 4.3 of that document.
30907 .subsection General
30908 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30910 DANE is specified in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6698,RFC 6698).
30911 It decouples certificate authority trust
30912 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30914 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30916 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS
30917 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8461,RFC 8461)), which
30918 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30919 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30920 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30923 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30924 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30925 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30928 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30929 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30930 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30932 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30933 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30934 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30935 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30936 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30937 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30938 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30945 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30946 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30947 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30948 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30949 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30950 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30951 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30952 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30953 one very small ACL:
30957 accept hosts = one.host.only
30959 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30960 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30962 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30963 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30964 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30965 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30966 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30967 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30968 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30969 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30972 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30973 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30974 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30977 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30978 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30979 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30980 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30981 .cindex "ATRN" "ACL for"
30982 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30983 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30984 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30985 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30986 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30987 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30988 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30989 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30990 .cindex "QUIT" "ACL for"
30991 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30992 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30993 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30994 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30995 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30996 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30997 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30998 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
31001 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
31002 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
31003 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
31004 .irow &%acl_smtp_atrn%& "ACL for ATRN"
31005 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
31006 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
31007 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
31008 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
31009 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
31010 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
31011 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
31012 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
31013 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
31014 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
31015 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
31016 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
31017 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
31018 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
31019 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
31020 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
31021 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
31022 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
31025 For example, if you set
31027 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
31029 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
31030 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
31031 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
31032 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
31033 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
31034 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
31035 testing as possible at RCPT time.
31038 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
31039 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
31040 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
31041 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
31042 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
31043 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
31044 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
31045 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
31046 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
31047 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
31048 in any of these ACLs.
31050 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
31051 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
31052 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
31053 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
31054 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
31055 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
31056 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
31057 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
31059 control = suppress_local_fixups
31061 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
31062 run, it is too late.
31064 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31065 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31067 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
31068 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
31069 temporary error for these kinds of message.
31072 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
31073 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
31074 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
31075 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
31076 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
31077 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
31078 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
31079 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
31080 &%smtp_banner%& option.
31082 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
31083 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
31084 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
31087 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
31088 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
31089 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
31090 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
31091 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
31092 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
31093 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
31094 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
31095 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
31097 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
31098 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
31099 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
31101 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
31102 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
31103 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
31104 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
31108 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
31109 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
31110 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
31111 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
31112 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
31113 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
31114 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
31115 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
31116 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
31117 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
31119 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
31120 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
31121 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
31122 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
31123 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
31124 associated with the DATA command.
31126 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
31127 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
31128 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
31129 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
31130 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
31131 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
31132 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
31133 the data specified is received.
31135 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
31136 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
31137 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
31138 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
31139 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
31142 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
31143 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
31144 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
31145 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
31147 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
31148 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
31149 enabled (which is the default).
31151 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
31152 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
31153 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
31155 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
31156 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
31157 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
31159 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31161 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31164 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
31165 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31166 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31168 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31171 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
31172 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
31173 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
31174 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31175 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
31176 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
31177 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
31180 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
31181 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
31182 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
31183 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
31184 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
31185 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
31186 for some or all recipients.
31188 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
31189 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
31190 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
31191 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
31192 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
31194 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
31195 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
31196 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
31198 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
31199 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
31201 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31202 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
31203 the feature was not requested by the client.
31205 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
31206 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
31207 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
31208 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31209 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
31211 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
31212 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
31213 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
31214 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
31215 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
31216 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
31217 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
31218 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
31219 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
31220 variable and can be used for building the file path.
31221 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
31227 accept control = wellknown/\
31228 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
31229 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
31230 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
31232 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
31233 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
31234 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
31236 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
31237 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
31239 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
31240 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
31242 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
31245 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
31246 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
31247 facilities documented in
31248 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8615,RFC 8615)
31249 and can be used for a security.txt file
31250 and could be used for ACME handshaking
31251 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8555,RFC 8555)).
31253 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
31254 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
31255 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
31256 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
31257 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
31258 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
31259 and the key is xtext-encoded
31260 (per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
31263 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
31264 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
31265 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
31266 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
31267 does not in fact control any access.
31268 For this reason, it may only accept
31269 or warn as its final result.
31271 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
31272 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
31273 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
31274 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
31276 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
31277 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
31279 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
31280 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
31283 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
31284 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
31285 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
31286 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
31287 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
31290 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
31291 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
31292 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
31293 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
31294 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
31295 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
31296 situation even worse.
31298 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
31299 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
31300 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
31303 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
31304 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
31305 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
31306 connection. The possible values are:
31308 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
31309 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
31310 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
31311 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
31312 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
31313 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
31314 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
31315 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
31316 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
31317 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
31319 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
31320 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
31321 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
31322 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
31323 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
31327 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
31328 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
31329 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
31330 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
31332 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
31333 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
31335 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
31337 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4409,RFC 4409)
31338 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and an
31339 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
31340 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
31341 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
31342 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31344 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31345 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31346 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31349 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31350 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31351 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31352 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31353 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31354 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31356 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31357 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31358 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31360 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31361 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31362 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31363 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31365 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31366 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31367 matches the string.
31369 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31370 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31371 want to have something like
31373 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31375 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31376 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31382 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31383 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31384 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31385 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31386 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31387 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31388 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31389 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31390 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31392 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31393 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31394 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31397 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31398 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31399 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31400 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31402 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31403 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31404 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31405 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31406 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31407 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31408 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31410 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31411 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31414 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31415 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31416 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31420 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31421 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31422 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31423 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31424 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31425 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31427 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31428 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31429 used to accept or reject anything.
31431 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31432 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31433 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31434 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31437 For the others (&%acl_smtp_atrn%&,
31439 &%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31440 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31441 the action when the ACL
31442 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31443 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31444 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31448 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31449 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31451 .vindex &$local_part$&
31452 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31453 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31454 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31455 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31456 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31457 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31458 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31459 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31460 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31462 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31463 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31464 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31467 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31468 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31469 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31470 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31471 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31474 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31475 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31476 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31477 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31478 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31479 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31480 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31481 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31487 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31488 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31489 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31490 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31491 When an ACL is being run for ATRN, AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31492 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31493 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31494 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31495 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31496 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31497 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31498 unencrypted connections.
31501 accept encrypted = *
31502 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31504 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31506 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31507 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31508 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31509 option to do this.)
31513 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31514 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31515 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31516 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31517 Each statement starts
31518 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31519 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31520 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31522 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31523 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31524 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31527 deny dnslists = list1.example
31528 dnslists = list2.example
31530 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31531 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31532 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31533 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31534 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31536 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31537 or a different configuration section starts.
31540 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31541 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31544 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31545 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31546 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31547 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31548 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31549 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31550 check a RCPT command:
31552 accept domains = +local_domains
31556 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31557 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31558 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31559 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31562 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31563 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31564 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31567 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31568 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31569 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31570 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31571 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31572 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31574 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31575 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31577 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31578 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31579 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31581 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31582 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31583 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31588 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31589 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31590 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31591 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31592 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31593 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31594 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31598 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31599 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31600 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31603 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31605 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31609 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31610 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31611 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31612 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31613 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31614 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31615 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31616 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31617 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31619 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31620 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31621 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31625 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31626 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31627 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31629 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31630 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31632 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31633 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31636 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31637 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31638 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31639 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31641 require message = Sender did not verify
31644 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31645 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31646 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31647 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31650 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31651 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31652 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31653 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31654 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31655 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31656 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31658 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31659 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31660 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31661 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31662 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31664 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31665 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31666 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31667 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31668 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31669 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31673 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31674 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31675 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31676 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31678 warn !verify = sender
31679 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31683 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31685 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31686 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31687 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31688 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31689 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31693 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31694 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31695 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31696 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31697 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31698 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31699 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31700 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31701 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31702 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31704 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31705 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31706 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31707 on the same SMTP connection.
31709 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31710 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31711 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31714 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31715 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31716 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31718 accept hosts = whatever
31719 set acl_m4 = some value
31720 accept authenticated = *
31721 set acl_c_auth = yes
31723 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31724 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31725 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31727 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31728 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31729 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31730 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31731 error is generated.
31733 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31734 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31737 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31738 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31739 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31740 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31742 deny domains = *.dom.example
31743 !verify = recipient
31745 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31746 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31747 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31748 two statements are equivalent:
31750 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31751 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31753 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31754 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31756 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31757 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31758 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31760 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31761 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31762 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31763 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31765 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31766 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31767 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31768 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31769 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31770 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31771 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31773 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31774 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31775 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31776 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31777 message is handled.
31779 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31780 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31781 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31782 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31784 require message = Can't verify sender
31786 message = Can't verify recipient
31788 message = This message cannot be used
31790 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31791 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31792 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31793 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31794 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31795 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31797 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31798 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31799 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31800 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31803 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31804 message = Invalid sender from client host
31806 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31807 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31811 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31812 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31813 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31816 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31817 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31818 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31819 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31821 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31822 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31823 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31824 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31825 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31826 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31827 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31828 write rather ugly lines like this:
31830 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31832 Instead, all you need is
31834 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31837 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31838 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31839 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31840 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31841 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31842 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31843 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31844 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31846 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31847 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31848 in several different ways. For example:
31850 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31851 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31852 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31856 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31858 accept ...some conditions
31861 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31862 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31865 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31867 accept ...some conditions...
31869 ...some more conditions...
31871 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31872 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31873 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31877 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31878 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31881 warn ...some conditions...
31885 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31886 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31890 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31891 &%require%& verb. For example:
31893 require control = no_multiline_responses
31897 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31898 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31900 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31901 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31902 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31903 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31904 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31905 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31907 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31910 deny ...some conditions...
31913 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31914 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31917 ...some conditions...
31919 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31920 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31922 warn ...some conditions...
31928 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31929 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31930 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31931 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31932 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31933 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31934 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31938 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31939 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31940 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31941 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31942 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31943 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31944 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31947 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31948 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31949 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31950 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31952 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31953 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31955 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31958 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31959 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31961 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31962 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31963 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31966 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31967 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31968 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31969 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31970 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31971 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31974 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31975 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31976 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31979 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31980 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31981 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31982 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31983 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31984 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31986 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31987 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31988 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31989 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31990 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31991 logging rejections.
31994 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31995 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31996 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31997 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31998 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31999 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
32000 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
32001 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
32003 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
32004 &` log_reject_target =`&
32006 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
32007 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
32011 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32012 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
32013 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
32014 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
32015 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
32016 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
32017 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
32020 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
32021 &` control = freeze`&
32022 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
32024 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
32025 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
32026 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
32029 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
32030 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
32034 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32035 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
32036 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
32037 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
32038 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
32039 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
32040 &%accept%& for details.)
32042 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
32043 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
32044 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
32045 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
32046 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
32048 require message = Host not recognized
32051 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
32054 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
32055 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
32056 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
32057 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
32058 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
32059 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
32060 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
32061 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
32062 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
32065 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
32066 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
32067 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
32069 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
32070 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
32072 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
32073 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
32074 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
32077 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
32078 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
32080 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
32081 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
32083 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
32085 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
32086 on word boundaries if possible.
32088 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32089 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
32090 contains any message previously set.
32091 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
32093 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
32094 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
32095 However, the original message is available in the variable
32096 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
32097 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
32098 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
32099 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
32101 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
32102 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
32103 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
32104 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
32105 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
32106 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
32110 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32111 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
32112 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
32113 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
32115 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
32117 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
32118 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
32119 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
32120 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
32123 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32124 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
32125 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
32126 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
32129 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
32130 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
32131 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
32132 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
32135 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
32136 .cindex "UDP communications"
32137 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
32138 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
32139 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
32140 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
32141 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
32142 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
32143 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
32146 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
32147 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
32154 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
32155 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
32156 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
32159 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
32160 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
32161 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
32162 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
32163 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
32164 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
32165 not work without it. For example:
32167 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
32168 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
32170 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
32171 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
32172 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
32173 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
32174 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
32177 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
32178 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
32179 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
32180 .cindex "case of local parts"
32181 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32182 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
32183 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
32184 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
32185 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
32186 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
32189 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
32190 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
32191 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
32192 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
32193 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
32195 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
32196 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
32199 warn control = caseful_local_part
32200 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
32202 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
32204 control = caselower_local_part
32206 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
32207 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
32210 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
32211 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
32212 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
32213 This control requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
32215 The control is usable in the RCPT ACL.
32216 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
32217 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
32218 is used for all recipients of the message,
32219 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
32220 and data is copied from one to the other.
32222 An attempt to set this control for any recipient but the first
32223 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
32224 If a recipient-verify callout
32225 (with use_sender or use_tpt_sender)
32226 connection is subsequently
32227 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
32228 any subsequent recipients and the data,
32229 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
32231 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
32232 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
32233 Note also that headers cannot be
32234 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
32235 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
32236 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
32237 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
32238 this will affect the timestamp.
32240 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
32241 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
32242 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
32243 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
32246 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
32247 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
32248 before the entire message has been received from the source.
32249 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR or CHUNKING
32252 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
32253 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
32254 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
32255 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
32256 before the acceptance "<=" line.
32258 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
32260 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
32263 Options for this control may be appended, separated by slash (&"/"&)
32265 There are two possible options,
32266 both taking a value string prefixed by an equals (&"="&) character.
32268 The &*defer*& option controls the result of a temporary error
32269 of the cutthrough delivery.
32270 The default value &"spool"& queues the message in the normal way
32271 for later processing.
32272 A value of &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response back to the initiator
32273 and does not queue the message.
32274 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
32276 The &*sender*& option controls the envelope-from used for the
32277 outbound connection.
32278 The default value of &"orig"& uses the address given for envelope-from
32279 in the inbound (originating) connection.
32280 A value of &"transport"& permits the transport used for the outbound
32281 connection to modify the envelope-from, via its &*return_path*& option.
32282 If the control is used on combination with a verify (as described above)
32283 then the envelope-from options must match for the same connection to be used.
32287 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
32288 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
32289 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
32290 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
32291 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
32292 by default called &'debuglog'&.
32294 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
32296 Options are a slash-separated list.
32297 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
32298 an equals character.
32299 Several options are supported:
32301 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
32302 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
32303 is appended to the default name.
32305 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
32306 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
32308 stop Logging started with this control may be
32309 stopped by using this option.
32311 kill Logging started with this control may be
32312 stopped by using this option.
32313 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
32314 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
32316 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
32317 for pre-trigger debug capture.
32318 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
32319 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
32320 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
32321 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
32322 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
32324 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
32325 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
32326 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
32327 on a write to the panic log.
32330 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
32334 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
32335 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
32336 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
32337 control = debug/kill
32338 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
32339 control = debug/trigger=now
32343 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
32344 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
32345 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
32346 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
32347 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
32350 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*& &&&
32351 &*control&~=&~dmarc_enable_forensic*&
32352 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
32353 .cindex DMARC "disable verify"
32354 .cindex DMARC controls
32355 .cindex DMARC "forensic mails"
32356 These control affect DMARC processing. For details on
32357 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
32359 The &"disable"& turns off DMARC verification processing entirely.
32362 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
32363 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
32364 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32365 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32366 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32367 strings or to numeric value.
32368 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32369 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32370 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32372 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32373 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32374 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32375 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32376 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32379 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32380 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32381 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32382 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32383 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32384 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32385 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32386 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32388 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32389 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32390 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32391 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32392 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32393 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32397 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32398 .cindex "fake defer"
32399 .cindex "defer, fake"
32401 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32402 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32403 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32404 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32405 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32407 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32408 .cindex "fake rejection"
32409 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32411 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32412 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32413 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32414 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32415 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32416 the same SMTP connection.
32418 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32419 message is supplied, the following is used:
32421 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32422 550-kept for evaluation.
32423 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32424 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32426 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32428 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32429 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32430 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32431 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32432 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32433 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32436 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32437 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32438 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32439 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32441 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32442 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32443 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32444 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32445 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32446 disables such output flushing.
32448 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32449 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32450 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32451 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32452 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32453 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32455 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32456 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32457 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32458 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32459 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32460 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32461 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32462 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32463 to be useful in production.
32465 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32466 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32467 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32468 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32469 SMTP responses, despite the fact that
32470 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc821,RFC 821)
32471 defined them over 20 years ago.
32473 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32474 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32475 one long line. However,
32476 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
32477 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32478 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32479 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32480 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32483 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32484 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32485 verification failed"&) is sent.
32487 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32491 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32492 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32494 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32495 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32496 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32497 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32498 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32499 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32500 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32501 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32503 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32504 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32505 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32506 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32507 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32508 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32509 .cindex "first pass routing"
32510 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32511 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32512 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32514 If used with no options set,
32515 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32516 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32518 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32519 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32520 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32521 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32522 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32523 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32525 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32526 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32528 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32529 .cindex "message" "submission"
32530 .cindex "submission mode"
32531 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32532 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32533 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32534 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32535 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32536 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32537 late (the message has already been created).
32539 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32540 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32541 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32542 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32543 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32545 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32546 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32547 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32548 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32549 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32552 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32553 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32555 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32557 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32560 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32561 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32562 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32563 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32566 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32567 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32569 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32570 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32572 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32574 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32575 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32576 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32577 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32581 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32582 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32585 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32587 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32588 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32590 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32592 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32597 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32598 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32599 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32600 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32601 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32602 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32604 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32605 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32606 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32608 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32609 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32610 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32611 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32612 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32615 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32616 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32618 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32619 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32620 contains one or more newlines that
32621 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32622 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32623 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32625 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32626 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32627 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32628 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32629 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32630 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32631 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32632 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32633 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32634 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32635 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32637 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32638 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32640 until they are added to the
32641 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32642 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32643 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32644 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32645 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32646 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32647 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32649 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32651 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32652 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32654 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32655 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32657 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32658 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32660 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32661 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32662 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32663 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32666 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32667 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32668 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32669 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32670 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32671 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32672 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32675 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32676 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32677 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32678 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32679 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32681 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32682 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32683 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32684 to be a header name first.) For example:
32686 warn add_header = \
32687 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32689 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32690 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32691 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32692 up in reverse order.
32694 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32695 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32696 system filter or in a router or transport.
32700 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32701 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32702 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32703 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32704 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32705 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32707 warn message = Remove internal headers
32708 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32710 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32711 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32712 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32713 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32714 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32715 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32717 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32718 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32720 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32721 list of header specifiers.
32722 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32723 then it is treated as a header name.
32724 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32725 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32726 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32728 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32729 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32733 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32736 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32737 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32738 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32740 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32741 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32742 warn message = Remove internal headers
32743 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32745 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32746 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32747 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32748 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32749 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32750 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32751 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32752 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32753 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32754 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32755 would have been removed.
32757 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32758 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32759 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32760 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32761 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32762 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32763 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32764 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32765 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32767 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32768 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32770 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32771 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32773 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32774 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32776 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32777 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32778 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32779 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32782 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32783 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32784 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32789 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32790 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32791 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32792 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32793 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32794 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32796 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32797 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32798 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32799 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32800 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32801 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32802 The conditions are as follows:
32806 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32807 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32808 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32809 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32810 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32811 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32812 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32813 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32814 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32815 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32816 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32817 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32819 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32820 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32821 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32822 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32823 The name and values are expanded separately.
32824 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32825 will act as argument separators.
32827 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32828 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32829 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32830 conditions are tested.
32832 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32833 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32834 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32835 for different local users or different local domains.
32838 .vitem &*atrn_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32839 .cindex ATRN "checking for queued messages"
32840 This condition is only usable in the ATRN ACL.
32841 It returns true if there are any messages queued for any of the domains given
32843 The list supplied must not be tainted
32844 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
32845 and should contain only domains relevant for the authenticated user
32846 (to avoid leaking information about other users).
32849 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32850 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32851 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32852 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32853 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32854 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32855 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32860 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32861 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32862 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32863 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32864 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32865 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32866 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32867 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32868 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32869 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32870 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32871 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32874 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32875 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32876 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32877 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32878 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32879 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32880 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32881 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32883 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32884 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32885 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32886 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32887 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32888 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32889 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32890 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32891 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32892 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32894 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32895 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32896 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32897 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32898 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32899 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32900 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32901 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32902 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32905 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32906 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32909 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32910 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32911 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32912 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32913 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32914 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32915 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32921 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32922 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32923 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32924 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32925 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32926 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32927 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32929 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32931 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32932 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32933 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32935 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32936 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32937 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32938 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32939 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32940 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32942 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32943 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32945 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32946 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32948 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32949 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32950 statement can then check the IP address.
32952 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32953 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32954 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32955 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32957 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32958 message = $host_data
32960 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32962 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32963 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32964 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32965 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32966 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32967 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32968 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32969 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32970 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32971 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32973 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32974 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32975 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32976 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32977 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32978 content-scanning extension
32979 and only after a DATA command.
32980 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32981 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32983 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32984 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32985 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32986 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32987 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32988 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32989 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32992 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32993 .cindex "rate limiting"
32994 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32995 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32997 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32998 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32999 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
33000 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
33001 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
33002 recipient address against a list of recipients.
33004 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
33005 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
33006 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
33007 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
33008 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
33009 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
33010 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
33012 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
33013 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33014 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
33015 for example for greylisting.
33016 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
33018 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
33019 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
33020 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
33021 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
33022 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33023 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
33024 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
33025 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
33026 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
33027 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
33028 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
33029 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
33030 influence the sender checking.
33032 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
33033 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
33035 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
33036 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
33037 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
33038 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
33039 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
33040 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
33044 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
33045 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
33047 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
33048 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
33049 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
33050 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
33051 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
33052 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
33054 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
33055 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33056 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
33057 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
33058 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
33059 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
33060 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
33061 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
33062 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
33063 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
33065 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
33066 .cindex "CSA verification"
33067 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
33068 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
33069 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
33071 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
33072 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33073 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
33074 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
33075 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
33076 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33078 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33079 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
33080 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
33081 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
33083 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
33084 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
33085 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
33087 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
33088 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33089 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
33090 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
33091 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
33092 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
33093 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33094 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
33095 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
33096 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
33097 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
33098 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
33099 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
33100 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
33101 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
33103 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
33104 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
33105 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
33106 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
33109 !verify = header_sender
33110 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
33113 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
33114 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33115 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
33116 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
33117 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
33118 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33119 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
33120 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
33121 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
33122 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
33123 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
33124 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
33125 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
33128 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
33129 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
33133 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
33134 common as they used to be.
33136 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
33137 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33138 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
33139 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
33140 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
33141 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
33142 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
33143 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
33144 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
33145 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
33146 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
33147 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
33148 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
33150 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
33151 option), this condition is always true.
33154 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
33155 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
33156 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
33157 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
33158 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
33159 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
33160 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
33161 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
33162 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
33164 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
33165 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
33167 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
33168 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
33171 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
33172 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33173 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
33174 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
33175 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
33176 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33177 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
33178 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
33179 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
33180 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
33181 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
33182 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
33183 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
33184 value for the child address.
33186 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
33187 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33188 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
33189 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
33190 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
33191 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
33192 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
33193 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
33194 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
33195 original IP address.
33197 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
33198 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
33200 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
33201 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
33203 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
33204 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33205 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
33206 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
33207 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
33208 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
33209 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
33210 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
33211 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
33213 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33214 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
33215 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
33216 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
33217 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
33218 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
33219 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
33221 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
33222 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
33223 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
33225 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
33226 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33227 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
33228 verified as a sender.
33230 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
33231 (eg. is generated from the received message)
33232 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
33234 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
33240 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
33241 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
33242 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33243 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
33244 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
33245 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
33246 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
33247 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
33248 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
33249 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
33251 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
33252 dialups.mail-abuse.org
33254 the following records are looked up:
33256 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33257 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
33259 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
33260 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
33261 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
33262 use two separate conditions:
33264 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33265 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33267 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
33268 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
33269 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
33272 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
33273 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
33274 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
33275 following special items in the list:
33276 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
33277 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
33278 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
33279 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
33281 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
33282 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
33283 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
33284 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
33286 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
33288 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
33289 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
33291 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33292 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33293 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
33295 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
33297 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
33298 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
33299 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
33300 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
33301 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
33302 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
33304 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
33305 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
33306 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
33310 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
33311 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
33312 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
33313 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
33314 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
33316 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
33318 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
33319 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
33320 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
33321 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
33326 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
33327 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
33328 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
33329 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
33330 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
33331 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
33332 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
33334 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33335 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
33337 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
33338 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
33339 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
33340 up by this example is
33342 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
33344 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
33345 addresses. For example:
33347 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33348 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33350 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
33351 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
33356 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
33357 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
33358 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
33359 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
33360 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
33361 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
33362 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
33363 either to double the separators like this:
33365 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
33367 or to change the separator character, like this:
33369 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
33371 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
33372 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
33373 occurs. Consider this condition:
33375 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
33377 The DNS lookups that occur are:
33379 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
33380 a.domain.black.list.tld
33382 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33383 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33384 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33385 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33386 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33387 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33388 error for a previous item.
33390 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33391 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33393 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33394 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33396 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33397 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33399 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33400 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33401 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33402 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33403 $sender_address_domain \
33404 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33407 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33408 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33409 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33410 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33412 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33414 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33415 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33417 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33418 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33423 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33424 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33425 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33426 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33427 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33428 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33429 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33430 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33431 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33432 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33433 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33434 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33435 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33436 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33438 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33439 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33440 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33442 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33443 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33444 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33445 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33448 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33449 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33450 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33451 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33452 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33453 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33454 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33455 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33456 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33457 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33458 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33459 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33460 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33461 cases, for example:
33463 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33465 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33466 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33467 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33468 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33470 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33472 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33473 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33475 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33476 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33477 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33478 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33479 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33482 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33483 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33484 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33486 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33487 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33489 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33494 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33495 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33496 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33497 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33500 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33502 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33503 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33504 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33505 describes how multiple records are handled.
33507 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33508 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33509 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33511 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33513 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33514 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33515 first. For example:
33517 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33518 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33521 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33522 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33523 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33524 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33525 tested. For example:
33527 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33529 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33530 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33531 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33533 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33535 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33540 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33541 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33544 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33546 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33547 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33549 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33551 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33552 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33553 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33554 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33556 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33557 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33559 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33560 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33562 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33563 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33565 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33566 Consider this example:
33568 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33570 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33573 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33575 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33577 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33578 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33579 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33581 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33583 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33584 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33585 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33588 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33594 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33595 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33596 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33597 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33598 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33599 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33601 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33603 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33604 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33605 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33606 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33607 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33608 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33611 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33612 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33613 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33615 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33616 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33619 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33621 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33622 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33624 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33626 for the condition to be true.
33629 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33630 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33632 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33633 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33635 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33637 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33638 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33640 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33641 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33643 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33645 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33646 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33648 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33650 for the condition to be false.
33652 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33653 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33658 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33659 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33660 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33661 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33662 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33663 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33664 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33665 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33666 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33669 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33670 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33671 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33672 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33673 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33674 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33675 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33678 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33679 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33681 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33682 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33684 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33685 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33686 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33687 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33688 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33689 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33691 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33692 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33693 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33696 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33697 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33698 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33699 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33701 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33702 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33703 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33707 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33708 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33709 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33710 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33711 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33712 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33714 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33715 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33717 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33718 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33719 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33721 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33723 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33724 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33726 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33727 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33729 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33730 dnslists = some.list.example
33733 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33734 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33735 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33737 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33741 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33742 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33743 .cindex greylisting
33744 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33745 situation has been previously met.
33746 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33747 The syntax of the condition is:
33749 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33754 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33756 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33758 The parameters for the condition are
33759 a possible minus sign,
33761 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33762 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33763 and used for the test.
33764 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33765 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33766 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33769 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33771 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33772 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33774 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33775 no record create or update is done.
33776 If a &%write%& option is given then
33777 a record create or update is always done.
33778 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33779 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33780 a record is created.
33782 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33784 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33785 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33786 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33787 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33788 An explicit interval can be set using a
33789 &%refresh=value%& option.
33791 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33792 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33795 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33796 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33797 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33798 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33799 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33800 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33801 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33802 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33803 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33804 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33806 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33808 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33809 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33811 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33812 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33813 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33816 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33817 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33818 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33819 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33820 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33821 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33822 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33823 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33824 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33826 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33827 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33828 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33829 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33831 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33832 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33833 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33834 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33835 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33836 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33837 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33838 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33839 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33840 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33842 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33843 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33844 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33847 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33848 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33849 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33850 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33851 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33852 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33854 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33855 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33856 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33857 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33858 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33859 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33860 the &%count=%& option.
33863 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33864 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33867 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33868 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33869 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33870 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33873 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33874 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33875 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33876 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33877 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33880 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33881 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33882 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33883 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33884 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33885 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33886 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33887 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33890 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33891 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33892 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33893 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33894 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33895 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33896 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33897 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33900 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33901 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33902 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33903 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33904 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33908 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33909 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33910 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33911 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33912 multiple different commands.
33915 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33916 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33918 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33919 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33920 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33921 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33922 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33923 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33924 The count does not have to be an integer.
33927 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33928 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33932 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33933 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33934 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33935 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33936 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33938 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33939 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33941 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33942 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33943 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33944 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33948 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33949 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33950 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33953 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33954 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33955 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33958 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33959 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33960 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33961 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33962 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33963 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33966 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33967 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33968 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33969 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33970 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33973 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33974 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33975 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33976 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33977 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33978 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33981 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33982 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33983 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33984 up to the given limit.
33985 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33986 consists of refusing the message, and
33987 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33988 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33989 likely not what is wanted.
33991 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33992 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33993 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33994 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33995 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33996 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33997 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33998 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
34000 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
34004 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
34005 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
34006 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
34007 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
34008 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
34009 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
34010 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
34011 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
34012 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
34014 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
34015 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
34016 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
34017 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
34018 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
34019 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
34021 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
34022 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
34025 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
34026 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
34027 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
34028 required increases with larger limits.
34030 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
34031 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
34032 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
34033 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
34034 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
34035 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
34036 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
34037 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
34038 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
34042 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
34043 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
34044 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
34045 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
34046 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
34047 message. For example:
34049 # Log all senders' rates
34050 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
34051 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
34053 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
34054 # at the decimal point.
34055 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
34056 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
34057 $sender_rate_limit }s
34059 # Keep authenticated users under control
34060 deny authenticated = *
34061 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
34063 # System-wide rate limit
34064 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
34065 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
34067 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
34068 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
34069 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
34070 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
34071 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
34072 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
34073 messages per $sender_rate_period
34075 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
34076 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
34077 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
34078 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
34079 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
34080 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
34081 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
34085 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
34086 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
34087 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
34088 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
34089 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
34090 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
34091 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
34092 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
34093 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
34095 verify = sender/callout
34096 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
34098 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
34099 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
34100 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
34101 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
34102 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
34103 The available options are as follows:
34106 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
34107 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
34108 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
34110 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
34111 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
34112 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
34113 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
34115 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
34116 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
34118 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
34119 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
34120 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
34121 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
34123 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
34124 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
34125 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
34126 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
34127 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
34128 not already exceeded (otherwise).
34131 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
34132 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
34133 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
34134 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
34135 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
34136 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
34139 warn !verify = sender
34140 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
34142 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
34143 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
34144 verification failure.
34145 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
34147 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
34148 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
34151 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
34152 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
34154 &%route%&: Routing failed.
34156 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
34157 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
34158 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
34160 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
34162 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
34164 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
34167 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
34168 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
34170 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
34171 address verification to:
34174 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
34180 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
34181 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
34182 .cindex "callout" "verification"
34183 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
34184 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
34185 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
34186 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
34187 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
34188 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
34189 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
34190 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
34191 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
34194 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
34195 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
34196 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
34197 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
34198 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
34199 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
34201 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
34202 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
34203 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
34204 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
34205 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
34207 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
34208 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
34209 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
34210 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
34211 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
34212 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
34213 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
34214 supplies a host list.
34215 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
34217 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
34218 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
34219 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
34220 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
34221 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
34222 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
34223 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
34225 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
34226 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
34227 following SMTP commands are sent:
34229 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
34231 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
34234 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
34237 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
34240 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
34241 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
34242 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
34243 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
34244 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
34249 and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
34251 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
34252 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
34253 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
34254 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
34255 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
34257 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
34258 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
34259 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
34260 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
34261 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
34263 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
34264 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
34265 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
34266 will assign untainted values to the
34267 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
34268 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
34273 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
34274 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
34275 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
34276 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
34278 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
34280 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
34281 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
34282 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
34286 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
34287 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
34288 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
34291 verify = sender/callout=5s
34293 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
34294 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
34295 the &%connect%& parameter.
34298 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34299 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
34300 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
34301 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
34303 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
34305 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
34307 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
34308 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
34309 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
34310 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
34311 updated in this circumstance.
34313 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
34314 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
34315 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
34316 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
34317 accordance with the specification in
34318 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821).
34319 The RFC states that the unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
34322 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34323 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
34324 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
34325 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
34326 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
34327 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
34328 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
34329 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
34330 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
34331 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
34333 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
34335 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
34338 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34339 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
34340 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
34343 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
34345 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
34346 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
34347 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
34348 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
34349 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
34352 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34353 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
34354 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
34355 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
34357 .vitem &*postmaster*&
34358 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
34359 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
34360 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
34361 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
34362 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
34363 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
34364 made, until the cache record expires.
34366 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34367 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
34368 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
34371 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
34373 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
34374 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
34376 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
34378 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
34379 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
34380 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
34381 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
34385 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34386 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34387 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34388 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34389 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34391 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34393 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34394 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34395 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34396 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34397 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34399 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34400 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34401 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34403 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34405 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34406 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34407 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34408 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34409 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34411 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34412 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34414 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34416 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34417 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34418 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34419 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34420 usefulness of callout caching.
34422 .vitem &*use_tptsender*&
34423 This option is similar to &*use_sender*& above,
34424 but additionally permits the replacement of the sender address
34425 by the &*return_path*& option of the transport.
34428 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34430 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34432 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34433 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34434 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34435 when that is used for the connections.
34436 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34437 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34438 if the use_sender option is used,
34439 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34440 and if no other callouts intervene.
34443 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34444 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34445 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34446 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34447 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34448 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34449 these circumstances.
34451 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34452 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34453 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34454 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34455 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34456 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34457 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34459 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34460 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34461 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34462 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34467 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34468 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34469 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34470 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34471 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34472 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34473 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34474 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34475 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34476 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34478 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34479 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34482 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34483 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34484 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34486 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34487 commands up to and including
34491 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34492 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34493 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34494 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34495 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34496 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34497 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34499 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34500 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34501 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34502 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34503 will eventually be noticed.
34505 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34506 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34507 behaviour will be the same.
34511 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34512 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34513 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34514 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34515 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34516 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34517 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34519 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34520 and one hour for a negative result.
34521 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34522 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34525 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34527 Possible parameters are:
34529 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34530 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34531 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34532 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34534 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34535 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34536 As above, for a negative entry.
34538 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34539 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34541 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34542 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34543 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34544 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34545 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34546 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34549 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34551 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34552 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34553 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34554 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34555 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34556 550 Sender verification failed
34558 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34559 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34560 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34561 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34564 verify = sender/no_details
34567 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34568 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34569 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34570 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34571 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34572 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34573 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34576 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34577 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34578 verification also fails.
34580 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34581 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34584 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34585 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34586 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34589 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34591 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34592 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34593 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34594 verification to succeed.
34596 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34597 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34598 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34599 option. For example:
34601 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34603 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34604 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34606 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34607 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34608 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34609 address and a report is output for each of them.
34613 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34614 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34615 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34616 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34617 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34618 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34619 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34623 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34624 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34625 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34626 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34627 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34628 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34630 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34631 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34632 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34633 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34636 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34638 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34640 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34641 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34643 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34644 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34647 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34648 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34650 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34652 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34653 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34654 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34655 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34658 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34660 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34661 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34662 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34664 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34665 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34666 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34667 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34668 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34669 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34670 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34671 of legitimate HELO domains.
34673 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34674 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34675 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34676 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34679 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34681 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34682 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34683 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34688 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34689 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34690 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34691 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34692 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34693 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34694 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34695 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34697 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34698 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34699 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34700 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34701 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34702 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34703 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34704 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34706 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34707 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34710 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34711 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34714 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34715 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34718 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34720 recipients = +batv_senders
34721 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34723 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34725 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34726 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34727 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34728 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34730 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34731 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34732 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34733 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34734 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34736 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34737 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34738 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34739 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34740 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34741 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34742 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34744 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34745 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34746 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34747 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34751 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34753 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34754 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34755 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34758 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34761 external_smtp_batv:
34763 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34764 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34765 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34766 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34769 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34773 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34774 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34775 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34776 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34777 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34778 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34779 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34780 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34781 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34782 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34784 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34785 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34786 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34787 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34788 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34789 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34791 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34793 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34794 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34795 system to arbitrary domains.
34798 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34799 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34800 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34801 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34804 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34805 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34806 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34808 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34809 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34811 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34812 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34816 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34818 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34819 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34820 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34822 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34826 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34827 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34829 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34830 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34831 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34832 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34833 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34834 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34835 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34839 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34840 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34841 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34842 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34843 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34848 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34851 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34852 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34853 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34854 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34855 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34856 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34859 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34860 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34861 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34862 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34863 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34865 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34866 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34867 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34870 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34871 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34873 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34874 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34875 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34877 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34878 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34880 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34883 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34886 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34887 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34888 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34889 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34890 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34891 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34893 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34894 temporarily created in a file called:
34896 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34898 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34899 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34900 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34901 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34902 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34904 control = no_mbox_unspool
34906 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34907 same directory by default.
34911 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34912 .cindex "virus scanning"
34913 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34914 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34915 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34916 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34917 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34918 in memory and thus are much faster.
34920 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34921 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34923 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34924 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34927 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34928 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34930 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34931 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34932 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34933 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34935 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34937 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34939 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34941 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34943 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34944 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34945 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34949 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34950 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34951 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34952 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34953 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34954 This scanner type takes one option,
34955 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34956 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34957 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34958 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34959 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34960 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34961 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34963 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34964 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34965 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34966 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34971 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34972 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34973 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34975 If you omit the argument, the default path
34976 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34978 If you use a remote host,
34979 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34980 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34981 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34983 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34989 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34990 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34991 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34993 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34994 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34995 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34996 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34997 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
35000 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
35005 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
35006 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
35007 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
35008 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
35009 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
35011 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
35012 a UNIX socket specification,
35013 a TCP socket specification,
35014 or a (global) option.
35016 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
35017 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
35018 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
35019 and the second a port number,
35020 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
35021 These per-server options are supported:
35023 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35026 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35027 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
35029 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
35033 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
35034 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
35035 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
35036 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
35037 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
35039 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
35041 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
35042 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
35043 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
35044 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
35046 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
35047 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
35048 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
35049 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
35050 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
35051 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
35052 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
35053 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
35054 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
35056 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
35057 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
35058 (Connection refused)
35061 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
35062 contributing the code for this scanner.
35065 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
35066 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
35067 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
35068 type takes 3 mandatory options:
35071 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
35072 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
35075 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
35076 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
35077 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
35078 the &"trigger"& expression.
35081 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
35082 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
35083 &"name"& expression.
35086 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
35088 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
35090 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
35091 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
35092 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
35093 configuration setting:
35095 av_scanner = cmdline:\
35096 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
35097 found in file:'(.+)'
35100 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
35101 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
35103 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
35104 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
35105 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
35106 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
35109 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
35110 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
35112 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
35113 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
35116 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
35117 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
35118 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
35122 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
35124 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
35126 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
35127 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
35128 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
35129 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
35132 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
35134 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
35137 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
35138 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
35139 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
35141 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
35143 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
35144 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
35146 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
35147 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
35148 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
35149 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
35150 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
35153 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
35155 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
35158 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
35159 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
35160 though some documentation was available in English.
35161 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
35162 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
35163 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
35165 The only option for this scanner type is
35166 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
35167 provided that mksd has
35168 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
35170 av_scanner = mksd:2
35172 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
35175 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
35176 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
35177 running on the local machine.
35178 There are four options:
35179 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
35180 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
35181 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
35182 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
35183 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
35186 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
35188 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
35189 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
35190 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
35191 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
35192 specify an empty element to get this.
35195 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
35196 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
35197 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
35198 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
35199 client communication. For example:
35201 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
35203 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
35207 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
35208 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
35211 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
35212 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
35213 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
35214 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
35215 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
35216 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
35219 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
35220 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
35221 The first element can then be one of
35224 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
35225 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
35228 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
35229 the condition fails immediately.
35231 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
35232 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
35233 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
35234 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
35235 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
35238 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
35239 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
35240 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
35242 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
35243 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
35246 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
35248 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
35250 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35251 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35252 is set to record the actual address used.
35254 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
35255 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
35256 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
35257 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
35260 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
35261 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
35263 Here is a very simple scanning example:
35266 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35268 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
35270 deny malware = */defer_ok
35271 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35273 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
35274 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
35276 av_scanner = $acl_m0
35278 in the main Exim configuration.
35280 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
35282 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35284 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
35286 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35290 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
35291 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
35292 .cindex "spam scanning"
35293 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
35295 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
35296 score and a report for the message.
35297 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
35299 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
35300 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
35301 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
35303 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
35305 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
35307 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
35308 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
35311 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
35312 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
35313 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
35314 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
35315 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
35316 configuration as follows (example):
35318 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
35320 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
35321 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
35322 iptables firewall, consider setting
35323 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
35324 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
35325 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
35326 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
35330 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
35332 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
35334 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
35337 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
35338 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
35339 filename instead of an address/port pair:
35341 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
35343 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
35344 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
35345 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
35346 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
35348 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
35349 192.168.2.11 783 : \
35352 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
35353 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
35354 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
35357 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
35358 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
35359 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
35360 take care to not double the separator.
35362 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
35363 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
35364 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
35365 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
35367 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
35369 The supported options are:
35371 pri=<priority> Selection priority
35372 weight=<value> Selection bias
35373 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
35374 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35375 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
35376 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
35379 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
35380 higher values being tried first.
35381 The default priority is 1.
35383 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
35384 Within a priority set
35385 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
35386 The default value for selection bias is 1.
35388 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
35389 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
35390 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35391 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35393 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35394 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35396 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35397 The default value is two minutes.
35399 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35400 a failed connect is made.
35401 The default is to not retry.
35403 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35404 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35405 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35408 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35409 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35410 is set to record the actual address used.
35412 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35413 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35416 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35418 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35419 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35420 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35421 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35422 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35425 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35426 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35427 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35428 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35429 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35431 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35432 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35434 or the use of PRDR,
35435 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35436 are needed to use this feature.
35438 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35439 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35440 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35443 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35444 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35445 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35448 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35450 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35453 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35454 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35455 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35456 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35458 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35459 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35461 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35462 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35463 available for use at delivery time.
35466 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35467 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35468 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35470 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35471 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35472 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35473 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35474 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35476 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35477 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35478 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35479 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35480 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35481 spam bar is 50 characters.
35483 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35484 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35485 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35486 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35487 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35488 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35489 unencoded in headers.
35491 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35492 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35493 spam score versus threshold.
35494 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35498 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35499 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35500 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35502 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35503 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35504 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35505 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35506 spam condition, like this:
35508 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35509 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35511 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35513 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35516 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35517 warn spam = nobody:true
35518 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35519 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35521 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35522 # is over threshold
35524 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35526 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35527 deny spam = nobody:true
35528 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35529 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35534 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35535 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35536 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35537 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35538 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35539 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35540 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35541 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35542 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35543 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35546 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35547 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35548 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35549 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35550 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35551 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35552 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35554 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35555 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35556 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35557 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35558 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35560 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35561 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35562 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35563 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35564 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35567 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35569 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35573 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35575 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35576 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35577 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35578 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35580 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35581 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35582 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35583 the full path and filename.
35585 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35586 filename, and the default path is then used.
35588 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35589 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35590 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35591 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35592 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35593 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35594 automatically unlinked.
35596 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35597 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35598 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35599 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35600 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35602 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35603 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35604 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35606 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35607 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35608 available in the MIME ACL:
35611 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35612 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35613 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35614 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35615 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35616 the detected issue.
35618 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35619 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35620 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35621 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35622 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35623 contains the empty string.
35625 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35626 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35627 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35628 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35634 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35635 case-insensitively.
35637 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35638 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35639 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35640 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35641 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35642 only used for display purposes.
35644 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35645 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35646 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35647 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35649 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35650 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35651 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35652 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35654 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35655 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35656 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35657 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35658 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35659 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35661 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35662 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35663 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35664 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35665 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35667 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35668 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35669 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35670 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35671 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35675 application/octet-stream
35679 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35682 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35683 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35684 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35685 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35686 containing the decoded data.
35691 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35692 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35693 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35694 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35695 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35696 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) or
35697 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2231,RFC 2231)
35698 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35700 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35702 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35703 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35704 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35705 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35706 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35708 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35709 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35713 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35716 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35717 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35720 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35721 and the rest are attachments.
35724 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35727 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35728 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35729 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35731 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35732 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35733 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35734 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35737 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35738 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35739 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35740 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35741 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35742 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35744 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35745 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35746 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35747 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35748 decoding is fully recursive.
35750 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35751 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35752 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35753 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35754 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35755 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35756 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35757 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35762 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35763 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35764 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35765 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35766 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35768 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35769 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35770 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35771 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35772 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35774 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35775 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35776 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35777 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35778 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35779 32K characters are checked.
35781 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35782 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35783 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35784 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35785 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35787 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35788 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35790 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35791 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35792 matching regular expression.
35793 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35794 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35796 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35805 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35807 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35808 "Local scan function"
35809 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35810 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35811 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35812 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35813 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35815 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35816 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35817 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35818 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35819 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35821 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35822 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35823 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35824 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35826 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35827 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35828 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35829 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35831 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35832 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35833 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35834 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35835 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35836 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35837 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35838 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35839 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35843 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35844 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35845 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35846 function is before building Exim, by setting
35847 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35848 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35849 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35850 directory, so you might set
35852 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35853 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35855 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35856 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35857 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35859 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35860 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35861 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35862 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35863 _src/local_scan.c_.
35865 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35866 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35868 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35870 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35875 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35876 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35877 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35878 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35881 #include "local_scan.h"
35883 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35884 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35885 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35886 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35887 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35888 strings and pointers to character strings:
35890 #define CS (char *)
35891 #define CCS (const char *)
35892 #define CSS (char **)
35893 #define US (unsigned char *)
35894 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35895 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35897 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35899 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35901 The arguments are as follows:
35904 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35905 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35906 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35908 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35909 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35910 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35911 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35912 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35913 case this changes in some future version.
35915 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35916 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35919 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35922 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35923 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35924 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35925 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35926 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35927 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35929 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35930 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35931 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35933 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35934 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35935 queued without immediate delivery.
35937 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35938 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35939 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35940 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35941 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35944 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35945 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35946 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35949 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35950 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35951 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35952 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35953 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35954 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35955 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35957 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35958 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35959 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35962 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35963 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35964 &%-oe%& command line options.
35968 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35969 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35970 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35971 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35972 want to do this, you must have the line
35974 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35976 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35977 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35978 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35981 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35982 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35983 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35984 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35985 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35986 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35988 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35989 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35991 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35992 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35993 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35996 int local_scan_options_count =
35997 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35999 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
36000 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
36004 my_string = some string of text...
36006 The available types of option data are as follows:
36009 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
36010 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
36011 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
36012 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
36013 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
36014 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
36017 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
36018 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
36019 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
36020 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
36023 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
36024 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
36027 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
36028 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
36029 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
36030 printed with the suffix K or M.
36032 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
36033 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
36034 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
36035 always output in octal.
36037 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
36038 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
36039 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
36041 .vitem &*opt_time*&
36042 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
36043 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
36046 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
36047 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
36051 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
36052 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
36053 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
36054 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
36055 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
36056 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
36057 C variables are as follows:
36060 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
36061 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
36062 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
36064 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
36065 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
36066 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
36068 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
36069 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
36070 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
36071 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
36074 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
36075 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
36076 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
36079 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
36080 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
36084 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
36085 selected, you should use code like this:
36087 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36088 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36090 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
36091 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
36092 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
36094 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
36095 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
36098 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
36099 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
36101 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
36102 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
36104 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
36105 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
36106 &%-bh%& command line option.
36108 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
36109 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
36110 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
36112 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
36113 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
36114 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
36115 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
36117 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
36118 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
36119 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
36121 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
36122 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36124 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
36125 The number of accepted recipients.
36127 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
36128 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
36129 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
36130 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
36131 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
36132 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
36133 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
36134 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
36135 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
36136 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
36137 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
36138 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
36140 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
36141 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
36143 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
36144 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
36145 locally-submitted messages.
36147 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
36148 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
36149 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
36151 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
36152 The name of the sending host, if known.
36154 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
36155 The port on the sending host.
36157 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
36158 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
36160 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
36161 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
36163 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
36164 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
36165 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
36169 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
36170 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
36171 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
36172 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
36177 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
36178 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
36180 .vitem &*int&~type*&
36181 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
36182 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
36183 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
36184 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
36185 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
36186 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
36188 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
36189 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
36192 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
36193 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
36194 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
36199 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
36200 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
36203 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
36204 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
36206 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
36207 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
36208 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
36209 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
36211 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
36212 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
36213 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
36214 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
36215 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
36216 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
36217 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
36218 is NULL for all recipients.
36223 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
36224 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
36225 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
36226 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
36230 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
36231 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
36233 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
36234 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
36235 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
36236 for the process in &%newumask%&.
36238 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
36239 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
36240 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
36241 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
36242 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
36244 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
36246 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
36247 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
36248 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
36249 return value is as follows:
36254 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
36260 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
36266 The process timed out.
36270 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
36273 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
36274 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
36275 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
36276 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
36277 forks a subprocess that is running
36279 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
36281 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
36282 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
36283 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
36284 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
36286 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
36287 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
36288 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
36289 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
36292 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
36293 *sender_authentication)*&
36294 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
36297 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
36299 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
36302 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
36303 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'printf()'&. The
36304 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
36305 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
36306 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
36308 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36309 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36312 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
36313 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
36314 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
36315 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
36316 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
36317 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
36318 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
36319 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
36321 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
36322 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
36323 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
36324 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
36325 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
36326 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
36328 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36329 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
36330 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
36331 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
36333 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
36334 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
36335 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
36336 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
36337 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
36338 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
36339 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
36340 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
36341 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
36342 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
36344 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
36345 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
36347 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
36348 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
36351 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
36352 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
36353 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
36354 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
36355 match the specification, the function does nothing.
36358 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36359 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
36360 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
36361 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
36362 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
36363 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
36365 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
36367 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
36368 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
36369 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
36370 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
36371 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
36374 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
36375 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
36376 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
36377 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
36378 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
36379 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
36380 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
36381 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
36383 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
36384 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
36385 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
36386 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
36387 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
36388 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
36389 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36391 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36392 inability to contact a database.
36394 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36396 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36397 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36398 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36400 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36402 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36403 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36404 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36406 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36408 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36411 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36413 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36414 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36415 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36416 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36417 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36418 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36421 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36423 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36424 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36425 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36426 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36427 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36428 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36431 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36432 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36433 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36434 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36436 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36437 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36438 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36439 value afterwards. For example:
36441 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36442 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36443 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36446 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36447 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36448 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36449 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36456 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36457 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36458 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to
36459 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). Typically
36460 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36461 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36462 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36463 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36464 binary string is returned with an error message.
36466 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36467 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36468 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36470 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36471 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36472 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36473 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36474 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36476 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36477 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36478 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36480 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36481 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36482 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36483 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36487 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36488 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36491 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36492 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36493 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36494 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36495 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36496 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36497 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36498 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36501 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36502 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36504 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36505 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36506 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36507 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36509 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36510 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36511 ABI version number was incremented.
36513 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36514 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36515 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36516 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36517 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36518 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36519 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36521 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36522 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36524 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36525 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36526 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36527 multiple output lines.
36529 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36531 guarantee a flush of
36532 pending output, and therefore does not test
36533 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36534 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36535 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36536 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36537 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36540 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36541 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36542 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36543 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36544 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36545 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36546 Exim bombs out if it ever
36547 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36549 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36550 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36551 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36553 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36556 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36559 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36560 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36561 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36562 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36563 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36564 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36570 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36571 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36572 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36573 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36574 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36575 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36576 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36579 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36580 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36581 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36582 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36584 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36585 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36587 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36589 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36590 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36591 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36592 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36594 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36595 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36596 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36597 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36607 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36608 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36609 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36610 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36611 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36612 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36613 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36614 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36616 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36617 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36618 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36619 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36620 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36622 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36623 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36624 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36625 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36626 .cindex retry condition
36627 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36628 prevent it happening on retries.
36630 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36631 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36632 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36633 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36634 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36635 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36636 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36637 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36640 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36641 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36642 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36643 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36644 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36645 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36646 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36648 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36649 system_filter_user = exim
36651 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36652 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36653 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36654 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36655 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36656 by the &%reply%& command.
36659 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36660 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36661 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36662 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36664 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36665 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36669 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36670 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36671 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36672 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36673 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36674 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36677 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36678 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36679 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36680 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36681 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36682 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36683 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36685 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36686 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36687 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36688 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36689 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36691 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36692 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36693 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36694 to which users' filter files can refer.
36698 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36699 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36700 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36701 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36702 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36706 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36707 .cindex "freezing messages"
36708 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36709 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36710 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36711 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36712 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36713 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36714 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36715 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36716 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36717 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36719 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36721 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36723 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36724 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36725 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36726 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36727 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36730 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36731 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36732 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36733 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36735 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36736 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36737 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36738 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36739 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36740 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36741 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36742 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36743 message. For example:
36745 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36746 because it contains attachments that we are \
36747 not prepared to receive."
36750 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36751 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36752 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36753 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36754 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36755 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36758 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36759 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36761 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36762 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36763 generated by the filter.
36765 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36767 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36768 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36774 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36775 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36780 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36781 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36782 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36783 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36784 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36786 headers add <string>
36787 headers remove <string>
36789 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36790 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36791 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to
36792 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) syntax. Leading white
36793 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36794 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36796 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36797 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36798 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36801 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36802 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36805 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36806 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36807 space after input continuations is ignored.
36809 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36810 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36811 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36812 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36813 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36815 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36816 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36817 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36818 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36819 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36820 used for all recipients of the message.
36822 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36823 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36824 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36825 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36826 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36827 until the message is actually being written (see section
36828 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36830 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36831 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36832 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36833 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36834 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36835 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36836 modified more than once.
36838 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36839 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36842 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36843 headers remove "Subject"
36844 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36845 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36850 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36851 .cindex "envelope from"
36852 .cindex "envelope sender"
36853 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36855 errors_to <some address>
36857 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36858 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36859 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36862 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36864 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36865 address if its delivery failed.
36869 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36870 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36871 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36872 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36873 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36874 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36875 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36876 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36877 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36882 domains = +local_domains
36883 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36888 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36889 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36890 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36891 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36893 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36894 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36895 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36896 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36898 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36899 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36900 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36910 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36911 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36912 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36913 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36914 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36915 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36916 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36917 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36919 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36920 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36921 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36922 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36923 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36925 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36926 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36927 loopback interface specially in any way.
36929 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36930 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36935 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36936 .cindex "message" "submission"
36937 .cindex "submission mode"
36938 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36939 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36940 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36941 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36943 control = submission
36945 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36946 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36947 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36948 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36949 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36950 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36952 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36953 control = submission
36955 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36956 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36957 is used to separate options. For example:
36959 control = submission/sender_retain
36961 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36962 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36963 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36964 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36965 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36966 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36967 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36969 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36970 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36973 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36975 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36976 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36977 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36978 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36980 accept authenticated = *
36981 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36982 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36983 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36985 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36986 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36987 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36989 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36991 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36994 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36996 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36997 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36998 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36999 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
37001 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
37002 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
37003 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
37004 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
37005 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
37006 spoof another's address.
37008 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
37009 .cindex "line endings"
37010 .cindex "carriage return"
37012 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
37013 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
37014 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
37015 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
37016 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
37017 use CRLF or just CR.
37019 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
37020 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
37021 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
37022 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
37023 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
37024 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
37025 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
37026 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
37030 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
37033 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
37034 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
37037 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
37038 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
37039 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
37040 people trying to play silly games.
37042 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
37043 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
37044 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
37046 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
37047 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
37054 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
37055 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
37056 .cindex "address" "qualification"
37057 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
37058 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
37059 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
37060 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
37061 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
37063 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
37064 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
37065 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
37066 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
37067 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
37069 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
37070 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
37071 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
37072 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
37073 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
37074 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
37075 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
37076 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
37081 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
37082 .cindex "&""From""& line"
37083 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
37084 .cindex "sender" "address"
37085 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
37086 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
37087 .cindex "envelope from"
37088 .cindex "envelope sender"
37089 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37090 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
37091 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
37092 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
37094 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
37095 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
37097 This line precedes the
37098 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37099 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
37100 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
37101 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
37102 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
37103 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
37104 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
37105 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
37106 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
37107 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
37109 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
37110 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
37111 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
37112 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
37114 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37115 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
37116 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
37117 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
37119 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
37120 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
37121 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
37123 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
37124 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
37125 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
37126 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
37130 .section "Header lines"
37131 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
37133 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37134 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
37135 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
37136 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
37137 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
37138 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
37141 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
37142 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
37145 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
37146 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
37150 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
37151 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
37153 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
37154 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
37155 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
37157 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
37160 For a locally-submitted message,
37161 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
37162 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
37163 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
37164 included in log lines in this case.
37166 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
37167 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
37173 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
37174 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
37175 includes the header line:
37177 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
37180 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
37181 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
37182 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
37183 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
37184 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
37185 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
37188 .subsection Date: SECID223
37190 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
37191 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
37192 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
37194 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
37195 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
37196 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
37197 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37198 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37200 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
37201 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
37202 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
37203 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
37207 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
37208 .chindex Envelope-to:
37209 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
37210 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37211 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) header set.
37212 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
37213 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
37214 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
37215 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
37219 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
37221 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37222 .cindex "message" "submission"
37223 .cindex "submission mode"
37224 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
37225 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
37228 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
37229 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
37231 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37232 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
37234 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37235 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37236 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37238 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
37239 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37241 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37242 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37246 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
37248 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
37249 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
37250 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
37251 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37252 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
37253 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
37254 &%qualify_domain%&.
37256 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
37257 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
37258 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
37259 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37262 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
37263 .chindex Message-ID:
37264 .cindex "message" "submission"
37265 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
37266 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
37267 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
37268 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
37269 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
37270 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
37271 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
37272 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
37273 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
37274 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
37277 .subsection Received: SECID227
37279 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
37280 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
37281 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
37283 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
37284 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
37285 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
37286 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
37288 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
37289 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
37290 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
37293 .subsection References: SECID228
37294 .chindex References:
37295 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
37296 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
37298 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37299 (which states that replies should contain such a header line),
37300 and section 3.14 of &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,RFC 3834)
37301 (which states that automatic
37302 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
37303 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
37304 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
37305 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
37306 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
37310 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
37311 .chindex Return-path:
37312 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
37313 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
37314 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
37315 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
37316 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
37317 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
37321 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
37322 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
37323 .cindex "message" "submission"
37325 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
37326 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
37327 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
37328 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37331 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
37332 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37333 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
37334 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
37335 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
37336 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
37337 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
37338 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
37339 line is added to the message.
37341 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
37342 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
37343 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
37344 options true at the same time.
37346 .cindex "submission mode"
37347 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
37348 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
37349 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
37350 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
37352 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37353 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
37354 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
37355 created as follows:
37358 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37359 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37360 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37362 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
37363 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37365 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37366 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37369 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
37370 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
37371 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
37372 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
37374 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
37375 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
37376 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
37377 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
37381 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
37382 "SECTheadersaddrem"
37383 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
37384 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
37385 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
37386 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
37387 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
37388 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
37389 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
37391 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
37392 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
37393 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
37394 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
37395 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
37396 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
37398 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
37399 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
37400 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
37402 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
37403 option must be in the form of one or more
37404 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37405 header lines, separated by newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37407 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37408 X-added-second: another added header line
37410 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37412 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37413 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37414 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37416 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37417 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37418 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37419 not part of the names. For example:
37421 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37424 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37425 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37426 Each item is separately expanded.
37427 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37428 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37429 will act as list separators.
37431 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37432 items are expanded at routing time,
37433 and then associated with all addresses that are
37434 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37435 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37436 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37438 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37439 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37440 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37441 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37443 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37444 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37445 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37448 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37449 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37450 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37451 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37452 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37453 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37454 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37456 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37457 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37458 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37459 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37461 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37462 the following consequences:
37465 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37466 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37467 to it, at all times.
37469 Header lines that are added by a router's
37470 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37471 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37473 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37474 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37476 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37477 a later router or by a transport.
37479 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37480 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37482 headers_remove = subject
37483 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37487 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37488 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37494 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37495 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37496 .cindex "constructed address"
37497 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37500 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37504 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37506 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37507 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37508 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37509 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37510 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37511 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37512 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37513 there is no password file entry.
37516 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to
37517 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37519 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37520 characters, it is encoded as described in
37521 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047), which defines a way of
37522 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37523 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37524 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37525 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37526 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37530 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37531 .cindex "case of local parts"
37532 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37533 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37534 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37535 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37536 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37537 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37538 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37539 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37542 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37543 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37544 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37545 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37546 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37550 domains = +local_domains
37551 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37552 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37555 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37556 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37557 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37558 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37559 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37563 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37564 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37565 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37566 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37567 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37568 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37569 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37570 empty components for compatibility.
37574 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37575 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37576 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37577 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37578 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37579 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37581 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37582 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37583 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37584 example, a header such as
37588 might get rewritten as
37590 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37592 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37593 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37596 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37597 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37598 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37599 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37600 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37601 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37602 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37609 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37610 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37611 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37612 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37613 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37614 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37615 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37618 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37620 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37622 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37625 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37628 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37630 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37633 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37636 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37637 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37640 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37641 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37642 used to contain the envelope information.
37646 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37647 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37648 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37649 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37650 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37653 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37654 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37655 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37656 processing is the same in both cases.
37658 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37659 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37660 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37661 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37662 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37663 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37664 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37665 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37666 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37669 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37670 pipelining extension to SMTP
37671 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2197,RFC 2197))
37672 to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets required for the transaction.
37674 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37675 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37676 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37677 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37678 is called for verification.
37680 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37681 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37682 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37684 .cindex "carriage return"
37686 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37687 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37688 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37691 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37692 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37693 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37694 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37695 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37696 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37697 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37698 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37699 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37701 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37702 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37703 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37704 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37706 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37707 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37708 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37709 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37711 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37712 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37713 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37714 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37715 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected.
37716 If it finds one, it arranges to attempt that message on the same connection.
37718 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37719 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37721 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37722 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37723 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37724 square bracket of the IP address.
37729 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37730 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37731 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37732 .cindex "host" "error"
37733 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37734 message errors, and recipient errors.
37737 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37738 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37739 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37742 Connection refused or timed out,
37744 Any error response code on connection,
37746 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37748 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37750 I/O errors at any time,
37752 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37753 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37756 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37757 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37758 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37759 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37760 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37761 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37762 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37763 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37765 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37766 .cindex "message" "error"
37767 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37768 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37769 message errors are:
37772 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37775 Timeout after MAIL,
37777 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37778 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37779 connection at any other time.
37782 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37783 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37784 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37785 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37786 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37787 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37788 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37789 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37790 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37791 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37793 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37794 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37795 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37798 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37799 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37800 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37801 recipient errors are:
37804 Any error response to RCPT,
37806 Timeout after RCPT.
37809 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37810 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37811 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37812 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37813 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37814 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37815 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37816 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37817 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37818 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37819 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37820 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37821 the retry clock is reset.
37823 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37824 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37825 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37826 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37827 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37828 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37829 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37830 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37831 recipient's retry time.
37834 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37835 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37836 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37837 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37838 until the next delivery attempt.
37840 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37841 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37842 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37843 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37844 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37847 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37848 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37849 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37850 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37851 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37852 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37853 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37855 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37856 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37857 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37858 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37859 then to be treated as a host error.
37861 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37862 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37863 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37864 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37865 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37870 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37871 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37872 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37875 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37876 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37877 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37879 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37881 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37882 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37883 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37884 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37885 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37886 stream and exits with an error code.
37888 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37889 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37890 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37891 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37893 .cindex "carriage return"
37895 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37896 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37897 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37899 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37900 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37901 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37903 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37904 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37905 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37906 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37907 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37908 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37909 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37910 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37912 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37913 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37914 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37915 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37916 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37917 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37918 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37919 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37920 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37922 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37923 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37924 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37926 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37927 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37928 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37929 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37930 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37932 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37933 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37934 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37935 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37936 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37937 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37938 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37940 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37941 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37942 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37943 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37944 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37946 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37947 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37948 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37949 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37950 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37951 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37952 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37953 a delivery process.
37955 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37956 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37957 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37958 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37959 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37961 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37962 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37963 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37964 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37966 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37967 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37968 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37972 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37973 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37974 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37975 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37976 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37977 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37978 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37979 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37982 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37983 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37984 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37985 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37986 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37987 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37988 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37989 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37990 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37991 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37992 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37996 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37997 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37998 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37999 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
38000 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
38001 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
38002 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
38003 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
38005 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
38006 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
38007 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
38008 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
38009 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
38012 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
38013 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
38014 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
38016 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
38017 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
38018 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
38019 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
38020 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
38025 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
38026 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
38027 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
38028 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
38030 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
38031 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
38032 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
38033 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
38034 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
38035 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
38036 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
38037 SMTP response codes.
38039 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
38040 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
38041 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
38042 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
38043 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
38044 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
38045 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
38046 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
38051 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
38052 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
38053 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
38054 Most modern installations never need to use this.
38055 It is used for managing messages queued for an intermittently-connecting
38056 destination (eg. one using a dialup connection).
38058 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_etrn%&"
38059 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
38060 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_etrn%& option.
38062 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1985,RFC 1985)
38063 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
38064 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
38065 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
38066 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
38067 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
38069 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
38070 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
38071 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
38072 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
38073 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
38074 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
38075 argument. For example,
38083 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
38084 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
38085 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
38086 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
38087 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
38089 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
38090 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
38091 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
38092 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
38093 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
38094 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
38095 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
38096 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
38098 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
38099 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
38100 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
38101 whatever the form of its argument. For
38104 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
38105 $sender_host_address
38107 .vindex "&$domain$&"
38108 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
38109 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
38110 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
38111 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
38112 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
38113 for it to change them before running the command.
38117 .subsection "The ATRN command, and ODMR" SECTODMR
38118 .cindex ATRN processing
38119 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ATRN
38120 .cindex ODMR provider
38121 A second method for handling
38122 On-Demand Message Reception (ODMR)
38123 for intermittently-connecting destinations is specified by
38124 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2645.html,RFC 2645).
38126 This describes an ESMTP command called ATRN which requests
38127 a swap in server/client roles of the communicating SMTP endpoints,
38128 and delivery of queued messages.
38129 Note that this supports customers having IP addresses that
38132 Exim supports both the &"provider"& and &"customer"& sides of ODMR,
38133 to use the terms of that specification.
38135 . need a sub-subsection here
38136 .subsection "ODMR provider connection" SECTODMRPRDVR
38138 In the &"provider"& use case Exim is
38139 initially an SMTP server, then transferring to an SMTP client
38140 role if an ATRN command is accepted.
38142 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_atrn%&"
38143 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
38144 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_atrn%& option.
38145 Per the standard, this should only be for a specific
38146 provider port number (386, named "odmr");
38147 Exim should be configured to listen on that port
38148 (in addition to other duties) via &%daemon_smtp_ports%&
38149 or equivalent commandline options, and restrict the
38150 advertising of the facility to the port:
38152 acl_smtp_atrn = ${if = {$received_port}{386} {check_atrn}{}}
38155 A recieved ATRN command will be rejected unless
38156 authentication has previously been done on the connection.
38158 Any arguments supplied with an ATRN command are (per standard)
38159 a comma-separated list of requested domains,
38160 and will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
38163 The ACL configured may return &"deny"& for any policy reaons
38164 (for example, the authenticated user is not permitted the facility).
38165 Otherwise it should use the ACL &"atrn_domains"& condition,
38166 which returns true if there are queued messages for any of
38167 the given list of domains.
38168 If that condition fails the ACL should return &"defer"&
38169 with a "453 You have no mail" response;
38170 else it should return &"accept"&.
38172 For example (with default domain handling, and one possible de-taint method) :
38175 warn set acl_m0 = clientdom.net
38176 deny condition = ${if def:smtp_command_argument}
38177 set acl_m0 = ${map \
38178 {<, $smtp_command_argument} \
38179 {${if inlist{$item}{clientdom.net:cl2dom.net} {$value}}} \
38181 condition = ${if !def:acl_m0}
38182 defer !atrn_domains = <, $acl_m0
38183 message = 453 You have no mail
38187 Acceptance by the ACL will result in a queue-run for messages
38188 having addresses with the given domains.
38189 A suitable router and transport must be configured for the deliveries.
38191 To access a named queue
38192 .cindex queue named
38193 the ACL should use a "queue =" modifier before the "atrn_domains"
38195 If the ACL does not accept, re-set the queue to an empty value
38196 so as to not disrupt any later SMTP operations on the connection.
38198 Use of the &"atrn_domains"& condition additionally sets up
38199 the &$atrn_host$& variable, which can be used by a manualroute
38200 router. Being otherwise empty, this router will decline in
38201 other situations so can be safely placed in a general router chain.
38207 driver = manualroute
38208 route_data = <;$atrn_host
38209 transport = call_customer
38216 Although not discssed in the specification document,
38217 Exim supports use of ATRN within a STARTTLS-
38218 or TLS-on-connect- encrypted connection
38219 (which is wise if a plaintext authentication mechanism is used).
38220 In such cases the TLS connection will remain open across the
38221 role-swap, and be used for the sending of queued messages.
38223 Note that the RFC requires that the CRAM-MD5 authentication
38224 method be supported.
38225 Exim does not enforce this, but leaves it up to the configuration;
38226 see chapter &<<CHID9>>&.
38229 .subsection "ODMR customer connection" SECTODMRCUST
38230 .cindex ODMR customer
38231 Exim supports the &"customer"& side of ODMR,
38232 with a command-line option &"-atrn"& that requests a connection
38233 to a given host, issuance of an ATRN command then operation
38234 in SMTP server mode.
38235 The option must be followed by two arguments.
38237 The first is the name or IP of the provider to be contacted.
38239 The second, which may be empty, should be a comma-separated list
38240 of domains for which mail is to be requested.
38241 Interpretation of the list is up to the provider;
38242 an empty list is expected to result in some default being returned.
38244 The provider host is placed in &$domain$& for routing;
38245 router and transport must be configured suitably to make the connection.
38250 driver = manualroute
38251 condition = ${if eq {$atrn_mode}{C}}
38252 route_data = <;$domain
38253 transport = call_provider
38260 command_timeout = 10m
38263 Note that the specification requires a long timeout for the ATRN
38264 command, to allow for scanning of queued messages.
38266 Configuration should also include client-side authentication
38267 and processing for receiving messages.
38272 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
38273 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
38274 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
38275 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
38276 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
38277 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
38278 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
38279 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
38280 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
38281 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
38282 runs for RCPT commands:
38286 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
38290 .section "Batched SMTP" "SECTgenbatchSMTP"
38291 .subsection "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
38292 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
38293 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
38294 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
38295 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
38296 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
38297 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
38298 envelope along with the message.
38300 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
38301 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
38302 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
38303 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
38304 can be used to specify it.
38306 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
38307 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
38308 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
38309 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
38310 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
38313 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
38314 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
38315 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
38320 driver = manualroute
38321 transport = smtp_appendfile
38322 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
38326 driver = appendfile
38327 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
38332 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
38333 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
38334 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
38338 .subsection "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
38339 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
38340 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
38341 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
38342 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
38343 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
38344 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
38345 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
38346 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
38347 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
38349 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
38350 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
38352 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
38353 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
38354 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
38355 make some use of automatically, for example:
38357 554 Unexpected end of file
38358 Transaction started in line 10
38359 Error detected in line 14
38361 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
38364 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
38365 The error message was:
38367 501 '>' missing at end of address
38369 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
38370 The error was detected in line 12.
38371 The SMTP command at fault was:
38373 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
38375 1 previous message was successfully processed.
38376 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
38378 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
38379 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
38381 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
38382 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
38386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38389 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
38390 "Customizing messages"
38391 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
38392 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
38393 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
38394 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
38395 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
38397 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
38398 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
38399 option. Exim also adds the line
38401 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
38403 to all warning and bounce messages,
38406 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
38407 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
38408 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
38409 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
38410 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
38411 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
38412 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
38414 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
38415 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
38416 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
38417 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
38418 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
38421 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
38422 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
38423 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
38424 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
38425 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
38426 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
38427 option, rounded to a whole number.
38429 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
38432 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38433 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38435 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
38436 failing addresses with their error messages.
38438 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
38439 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
38441 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
38442 The fields exist for back-compatibility
38445 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
38446 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
38447 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
38449 Subject: Mail delivery failed
38450 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38451 {: returning message to sender}}
38453 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38455 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38456 {that you sent }{sent by
38460 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
38461 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
38463 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
38465 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
38468 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
38470 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
38473 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
38474 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
38475 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
38476 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
38477 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
38481 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38482 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38484 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
38485 the delayed addresses.
38487 The third item then ends the message.
38490 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
38491 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
38493 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
38494 $warn_message_delay
38496 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38498 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
38499 {that you sent }{sent by
38503 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
38504 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
38506 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
38507 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
38508 The date of the message is: $h_date
38510 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
38512 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
38513 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
38514 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
38515 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
38516 the message will be returned to you.
38518 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
38519 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
38520 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
38521 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
38522 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
38523 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
38524 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
38525 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
38531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38534 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
38535 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
38536 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
38540 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
38541 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
38542 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
38543 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
38544 routing explicitly:
38546 send_to_smart_host:
38547 driver = manualroute
38548 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
38549 transport = remote_smtp
38551 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
38552 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
38553 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
38554 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
38555 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
38560 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
38561 .cindex "mailing lists"
38562 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
38563 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
38564 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
38566 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
38567 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
38568 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
38569 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38573 domains = lists.example
38574 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38577 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38580 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38581 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38582 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38583 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38585 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38586 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38589 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38590 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38591 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38592 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38593 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38595 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38596 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38597 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38598 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38599 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38600 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38601 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38602 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38603 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38607 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38608 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38609 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38610 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38611 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38612 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38613 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38615 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38616 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38617 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38618 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38619 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38623 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38624 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38625 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38626 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38627 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38628 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38629 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38630 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38631 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38632 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38634 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38635 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38636 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38637 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38638 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38639 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38640 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38641 pre-existing messages.
38643 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38644 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38645 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38646 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38647 one level of expansion anyway.
38651 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38652 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38653 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38654 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38655 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38656 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38658 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38659 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38663 domains = lists.example
38664 local_part_suffix = -request
38665 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38666 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38671 domains = lists.example
38672 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38673 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38674 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38677 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38682 domains = lists.example
38684 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38686 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38687 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38688 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38691 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38692 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38693 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38694 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38695 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38696 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38697 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38698 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38699 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38701 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38702 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38703 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38708 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38710 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38711 .cindex "envelope from"
38712 .cindex "envelope sender"
38713 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38714 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38715 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38716 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38717 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38718 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38720 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38721 .oindex &%return_path%&
38722 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38723 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38724 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38725 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38726 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38727 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38728 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38734 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38735 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38737 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38738 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38739 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38740 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38741 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38742 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38743 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38746 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38748 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38749 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38750 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38751 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38752 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38753 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38755 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38756 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38757 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38758 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38762 domains = ! +local_domains
38764 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38765 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38768 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38769 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38770 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38771 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38774 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38775 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38776 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38777 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38778 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38782 domains = ! +local_domains
38783 transport = remote_smtp
38785 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38786 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38789 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38790 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38791 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38792 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38795 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38796 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38797 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38798 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38799 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38800 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38808 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38809 .cindex "virtual domains"
38810 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38811 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38815 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38816 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38817 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38819 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38820 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38821 have login accounts on that host.
38824 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38825 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38826 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38827 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38828 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38829 to a router of this form:
38833 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38834 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38837 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38838 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38839 domain that is being processed.
38840 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38841 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38843 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38844 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38845 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38846 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38848 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38849 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38850 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38851 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38853 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38854 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38855 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38859 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38860 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38861 transport = my_mailboxes
38863 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38864 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38865 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38866 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38867 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38871 driver = appendfile
38872 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38875 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38876 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38878 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38879 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38880 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38881 information about the domains.
38885 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38886 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38887 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38888 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38889 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38890 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38891 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38892 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38893 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38894 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38895 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38896 example, consider this router:
38901 file = $home/.forward
38902 local_part_suffix = -*
38903 local_part_suffix_optional
38906 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38907 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38908 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38909 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38911 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38912 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38915 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38916 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38917 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38918 control over which suffixes are valid.
38920 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38921 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38927 local_part_suffix = -*
38928 local_part_suffix_optional
38929 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38932 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38933 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38934 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38935 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38936 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38940 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38941 .cindex "vacation processing"
38942 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38943 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38944 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38945 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38946 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38949 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38950 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38951 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38952 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38954 spqr, vacation-spqr
38957 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38958 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38959 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38960 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38961 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38965 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38966 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38970 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38971 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38972 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38973 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38974 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38975 each day's messages.
38977 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38978 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38979 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38980 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38984 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38985 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38986 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38987 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38988 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38989 permanently connected.
38991 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38992 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38993 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38996 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38997 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38998 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38999 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
39000 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
39001 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
39002 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
39003 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
39005 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
39006 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
39007 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
39008 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
39009 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
39010 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
39013 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
39014 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
39015 intermittent host. For example:
39017 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
39019 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
39020 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
39021 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
39022 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
39023 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
39024 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
39027 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
39028 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
39029 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
39030 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
39031 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
39032 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
39033 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
39037 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
39038 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
39039 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
39040 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
39041 delivered immediately.
39043 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
39044 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
39045 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
39046 .cindex "first pass routing"
39047 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
39048 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
39049 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
39050 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
39051 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
39052 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
39053 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
39054 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
39055 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
39056 single SMTP connection.
39060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39061 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39063 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
39064 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
39065 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
39066 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
39067 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
39068 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
39069 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
39070 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
39071 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
39072 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
39075 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
39076 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
39077 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
39078 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
39079 email is not desirable.
39081 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
39082 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
39083 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
39084 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
39085 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
39086 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
39087 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
39089 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
39090 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
39091 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
39092 before sending a message to the smart host.
39094 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
39095 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
39096 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
39098 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
39099 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
39100 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
39101 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
39102 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
39103 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
39104 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
39106 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
39110 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
39111 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
39113 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
39114 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
39115 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
39116 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
39117 successful, a zero return code is given.
39119 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
39120 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
39121 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
39122 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
39123 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
39126 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
39127 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
39128 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
39130 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
39131 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
39132 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
39133 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
39134 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
39136 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
39137 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
39138 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
39140 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
39141 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
39142 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
39143 are ever generated.
39145 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
39147 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
39148 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
39149 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
39152 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
39153 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
39154 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
39155 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
39156 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
39157 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
39162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39165 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
39166 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
39167 .cindex "log" "types of"
39168 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
39173 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
39174 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
39175 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
39176 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
39177 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
39178 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
39179 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
39180 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
39182 .cindex "reject log"
39183 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
39184 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
39185 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
39186 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
39187 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
39188 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
39189 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
39190 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
39191 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
39194 .cindex "panic log"
39195 .cindex "system log"
39196 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
39197 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
39198 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
39199 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
39200 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
39201 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
39202 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
39203 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
39204 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
39207 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
39208 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
39209 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
39211 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
39214 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
39215 ways of changing this:
39218 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
39223 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
39225 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
39228 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
39232 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39233 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39234 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
39235 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
39236 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
39237 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
39242 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
39243 .cindex "log" "destination"
39244 .cindex "log" "to file"
39245 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
39247 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
39248 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
39249 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
39250 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
39251 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
39252 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
39253 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
39255 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
39256 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
39257 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
39258 references to the host name:
39260 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
39262 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
39263 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
39264 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
39265 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
39266 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
39269 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
39270 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
39271 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
39272 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
39273 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
39274 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
39275 implying the use of a default path.
39277 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
39278 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
39279 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
39280 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
39281 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
39282 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
39284 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
39286 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
39287 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
39288 that is where the logs are written.
39290 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
39291 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
39293 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
39295 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
39296 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
39297 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
39298 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
39300 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
39305 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
39306 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39307 .cindex "cycling logs"
39308 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39309 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
39310 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
39311 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
39312 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
39313 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
39314 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
39316 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
39317 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
39318 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
39319 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
39320 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
39321 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
39322 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
39323 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
39324 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
39325 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
39326 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
39331 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
39332 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
39333 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
39334 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
39335 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
39336 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
39337 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
39338 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
39340 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
39341 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
39342 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
39343 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
39345 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
39346 examples of names generated by the above examples:
39348 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
39349 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
39350 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
39351 /var/log/exim/main.200212
39353 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
39354 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
39355 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
39356 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
39358 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
39359 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
39360 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
39361 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
39362 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
39363 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
39366 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39367 /var/log/exim-panic.log
39368 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39369 /var/log/exim/panic
39373 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
39374 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
39375 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
39376 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
39377 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
39378 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
39379 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
39380 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
39381 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
39382 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
39383 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
39384 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
39385 the time and host name to each line.
39386 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
39389 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
39391 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
39393 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
39396 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
39397 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
39398 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
39399 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
39401 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
39402 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
39403 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
39404 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
39405 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
39406 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
39407 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
39408 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3164,RFC 3164), you should set
39410 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
39412 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
39413 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
39415 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
39416 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
39417 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
39418 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
39419 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
39420 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
39421 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
39422 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
39423 name, and pid as added by syslog:
39425 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
39426 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
39427 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
39428 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
39431 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
39434 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
39435 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
39436 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
39437 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
39439 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
39440 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
39441 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
39442 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
39443 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
39444 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
39446 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
39447 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
39448 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
39451 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
39453 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
39454 without modification.
39456 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
39457 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
39458 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
39463 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
39464 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
39465 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
39466 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
39467 timestamp. The flags are:
39468 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
39469 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
39470 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
39471 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
39472 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
39473 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
39474 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
39475 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
39476 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
39480 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
39481 .cindex "log" "reception line"
39482 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39483 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
39484 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
39486 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
39487 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
39488 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
39490 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
39491 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
39492 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
39496 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
39500 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
39501 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
39502 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
39503 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
39504 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
39505 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
39506 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
39507 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
39508 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
39509 name in parentheses.
39511 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
39512 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
39513 the log containing text like these examples:
39515 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
39516 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
39518 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
39521 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
39522 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
39525 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
39526 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
39527 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
39528 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
39529 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
39530 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
39531 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
39532 suite that was used.
39534 .cindex log protocol
39535 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
39536 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
39537 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
39538 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
39539 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
39540 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
39541 authenticator name.
39543 .cindex "size" "of message"
39544 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
39545 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
39546 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
39547 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
39550 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39551 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39555 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
39556 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
39557 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39558 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
39559 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
39560 to fit it on the page:
39562 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
39563 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
39564 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
39565 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
39566 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
39568 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
39569 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
39570 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
39571 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
39572 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39574 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39575 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39576 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39577 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39578 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39580 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39581 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39583 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39585 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39586 parentheses afterwards.
39588 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39589 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39590 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39591 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39592 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39593 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39594 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39595 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39596 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39597 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39598 TLS cipher information is still available.
39600 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39601 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39602 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39603 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39604 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39606 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39607 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39609 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39610 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39613 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39614 .cindex "discarded messages"
39615 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39616 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39617 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39618 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39620 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39621 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39623 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39624 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39626 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39627 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39631 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39632 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39634 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39635 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39637 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39638 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39639 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39641 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39642 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39644 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39645 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39646 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39650 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39651 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39652 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39653 following form is logged:
39655 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39656 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39658 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39659 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39661 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39662 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39663 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39664 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39665 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39667 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39668 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39669 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39670 flagged with &`**`&.
39674 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39675 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39676 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39677 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39678 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39682 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39685 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39687 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39688 at the end of its processing.
39693 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39694 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39695 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39696 the following table:
39698 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39699 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39700 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39701 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39702 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39703 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39704 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39705 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39706 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39707 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39708 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39709 &`H `& host name and IP address
39710 &`I `& local interface used
39711 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39712 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39713 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39714 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39715 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39716 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39717 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39718 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39719 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39720 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39721 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39722 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39723 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39724 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39725 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39726 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39727 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39728 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39729 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39730 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39731 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39732 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39736 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39737 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39738 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39741 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39742 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39743 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39744 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39745 during the first delivery attempt.
39747 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39748 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39749 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39751 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39752 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39753 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39754 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39755 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39758 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39759 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39762 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39763 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39765 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39766 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39768 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39769 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39770 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39774 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39777 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39778 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39779 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39786 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39787 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39788 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39789 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39790 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39793 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39795 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39796 selection marked by asterisks:
39797 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39798 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39799 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39800 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39801 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39802 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39803 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39804 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39805 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39806 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39807 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39808 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39809 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39810 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39811 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39812 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39813 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39814 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39815 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39816 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39817 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39818 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39819 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39820 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39821 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39822 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39823 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39824 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39825 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39826 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39827 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39828 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39829 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39830 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39831 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39832 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39833 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39834 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39835 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39836 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39837 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39838 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39839 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39840 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39841 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39842 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39843 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39844 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39845 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39846 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39847 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39848 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39849 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39850 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39851 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39852 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39853 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39854 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39856 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39857 section &<<SECID99>>&
39859 More details on each of these items follows:
39863 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39864 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39865 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39866 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39867 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39868 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39870 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39871 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39872 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39873 this log selector is set.
39875 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39876 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39877 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39878 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39879 such users cannot access the log).
39881 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39882 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39883 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39884 parentheses between them.
39886 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39887 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39888 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39889 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39890 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39891 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39892 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39893 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39894 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39895 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39896 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39897 between the caller and Exim.
39899 .cindex log "connection identifier"
39900 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
39901 &%connection_id%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39902 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39903 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39904 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39906 .cindex log "connection rejections"
39907 .cindex connection "rejection logging"
39908 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39909 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39911 .cindex log "delayed delivery"
39912 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39913 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39914 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39915 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39916 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39918 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39919 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39920 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39921 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39922 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39924 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39925 .cindex "size" "of message"
39926 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39927 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39929 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39930 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39931 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39932 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39934 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39935 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39936 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39937 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39938 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39940 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39941 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39942 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39943 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39944 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39947 .cindex dnssec logging
39948 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39949 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39950 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39951 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39952 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39954 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39955 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39956 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39957 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39958 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39959 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39961 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39962 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39963 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39964 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39965 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39967 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39968 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39969 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39970 client's ident port times out.
39972 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39973 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39974 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39975 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39976 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39977 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39978 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39979 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39980 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39981 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39982 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39983 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39984 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39986 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39987 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39988 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39989 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39990 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39991 on a proxied connection
39992 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39993 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39995 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39996 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39997 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39998 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39999 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
40000 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
40001 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
40002 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
40003 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
40004 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
40005 important with the widening use of NAT
40006 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505)).
40008 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
40009 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
40010 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
40012 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
40013 .cindex millisecond logging
40014 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
40015 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
40016 appended to the seconds value.
40018 .cindex "log" "message id"
40019 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
40021 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
40022 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
40023 (submission mode) without one.
40024 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
40026 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
40027 .cindex "log" "local interface"
40028 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
40029 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
40030 .cindex "interface" "logging"
40031 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
40032 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
40033 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
40034 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
40036 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
40037 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
40038 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
40039 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
40040 containing => tags) following the IP address.
40041 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
40042 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
40043 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
40044 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
40045 local port is a random ephemeral port.
40047 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
40048 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
40049 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
40050 immediately after the time and date.
40052 .cindex log pipelining
40053 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
40054 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
40055 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
40056 The field is a single "L".
40058 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
40059 the field has a minus appended.
40061 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
40062 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
40063 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
40064 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
40065 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
40068 .cindex "log" "queue run"
40069 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
40070 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
40072 .cindex "log" "queue time"
40073 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
40074 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
40076 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
40077 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
40079 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
40080 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
40081 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
40083 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
40084 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
40085 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
40086 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
40087 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
40089 .cindex "log" "recipients"
40090 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
40091 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
40092 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
40093 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
40095 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
40098 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
40099 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
40100 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
40101 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
40103 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
40104 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
40105 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
40106 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
40107 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
40109 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
40110 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
40111 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
40112 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
40115 .cindex "log" "return path"
40116 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
40117 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
40118 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
40119 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
40121 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
40122 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
40123 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
40124 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
40125 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
40127 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
40128 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
40129 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
40130 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
40133 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
40134 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
40137 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
40138 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
40139 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
40140 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
40142 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
40143 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
40144 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
40145 &"message is frozen"&.
40147 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
40148 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
40149 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
40150 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
40151 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
40152 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
40155 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
40156 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
40157 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
40158 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
40159 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
40160 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
40161 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
40162 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
40163 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
40164 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
40166 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
40167 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
40168 reset if the daemon is restarted.
40169 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
40170 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
40171 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
40172 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
40173 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
40175 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
40176 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
40177 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
40178 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
40179 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
40180 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
40182 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
40183 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
40184 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
40185 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
40186 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
40187 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
40188 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
40189 already have their own log lines.
40191 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
40192 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
40193 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
40194 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
40195 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
40196 the same logging options.
40198 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
40199 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
40203 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
40204 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
40205 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
40206 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
40207 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
40209 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
40210 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
40211 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
40212 was accepted or used.
40214 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
40215 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
40216 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
40217 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
40218 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
40219 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
40220 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
40221 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
40223 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
40224 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
40225 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
40226 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
40227 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
40228 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
40229 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
40230 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
40231 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
40233 .cindex "log" "subject"
40234 .cindex "subject, logging"
40235 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
40236 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
40237 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
40238 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
40239 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
40241 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
40243 .cindex DANE logging
40244 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
40245 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
40247 using a CA trust anchor,
40248 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
40249 and &`CV=no`& if not.
40251 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
40252 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
40253 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40254 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
40256 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
40257 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
40258 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40259 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
40260 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
40262 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
40263 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
40264 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40265 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
40266 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
40268 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
40269 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
40270 .cindex SNI logging
40271 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
40272 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
40273 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
40275 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
40276 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
40277 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
40278 a bad IP address was in the list.
40282 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
40283 .cindex "message" "log file for"
40284 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
40285 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
40286 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
40287 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
40288 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
40289 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
40290 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
40291 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
40292 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
40293 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
40294 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
40296 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
40297 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
40298 &%message_logs%& option false.
40304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40307 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
40308 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
40309 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
40310 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
40311 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
40313 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
40314 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
40315 "list what Exim processes are doing"
40316 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
40317 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
40318 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
40319 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
40321 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
40322 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
40323 "extract statistics from the log"
40324 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
40325 "check address acceptance from given IP"
40326 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
40327 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
40328 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
40329 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
40330 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
40331 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
40332 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
40335 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
40336 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
40337 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
40342 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
40343 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
40344 .cindex "process, querying"
40346 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
40347 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
40348 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
40349 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
40350 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
40351 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
40352 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
40353 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
40355 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
40356 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
40357 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
40360 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
40361 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
40362 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
40363 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
40364 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
40366 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
40367 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
40368 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
40369 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
40370 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
40372 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
40374 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
40375 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
40376 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
40377 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
40378 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
40379 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
40381 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
40382 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
40386 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
40387 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
40388 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
40389 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
40393 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
40397 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
40398 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
40401 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
40402 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40403 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
40407 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
40408 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40409 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
40411 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
40412 Match against the size field.
40414 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40415 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
40417 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40418 Match messages that are older than the given time.
40421 Match only frozen messages.
40424 Match only non-frozen messages.
40426 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
40427 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
40430 The following options control the format of the output:
40434 Display only the count of matching messages.
40437 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
40441 Display message ids only.
40444 Brief format &-- one line per message.
40447 Display messages in reverse order.
40450 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
40453 The following options give alternates for configuration:
40456 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
40457 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
40458 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
40460 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
40461 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
40462 overriding the built-in one.
40465 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
40466 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
40470 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
40471 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
40472 .cindex "queue" "summary"
40473 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
40474 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
40475 running a command such as
40477 exim -bp | exiqsumm
40479 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
40480 it, as in the following example:
40482 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
40484 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
40485 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
40486 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
40487 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
40489 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
40490 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
40491 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
40492 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
40493 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
40494 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
40497 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
40498 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
40499 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
40500 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
40501 level"& addresses).
40506 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
40508 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
40509 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
40510 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
40511 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
40512 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
40513 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
40514 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
40515 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
40516 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
40517 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
40519 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
40521 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
40523 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
40524 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
40525 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
40527 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
40528 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
40529 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
40530 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
40531 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
40533 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
40534 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
40535 regular expression.
40537 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
40538 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
40540 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
40541 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
40545 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
40546 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
40547 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
40548 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
40549 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
40550 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
40553 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
40554 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
40555 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
40556 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
40557 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
40560 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
40561 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
40562 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
40563 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
40564 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
40565 the &%--help%& option.
40568 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
40569 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
40570 .cindex "cycling logs"
40571 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
40572 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
40573 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
40574 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
40575 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40576 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40577 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40579 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40580 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40582 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40583 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40584 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40588 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40589 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40590 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40591 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40592 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40593 logs are handled similarly.
40595 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40596 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40597 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40598 any existing log files.
40600 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40601 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40602 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40603 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40604 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40606 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40608 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40609 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40613 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40614 .cindex "statistics"
40615 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40616 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40617 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40618 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40619 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40621 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40622 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40623 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40624 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40625 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40627 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40629 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40630 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40631 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40632 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40633 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40634 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40635 also produced per user.
40637 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40638 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40639 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40640 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40641 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40643 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40644 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40645 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40646 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40647 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40648 an entirely separate message.
40650 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40651 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40652 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40653 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40654 least one address that failed.
40656 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40657 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40658 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40659 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40660 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40661 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40662 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40664 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40665 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40666 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40668 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40669 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40670 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40672 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40675 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40676 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40677 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40678 .cindex "checking access"
40679 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40680 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40681 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40682 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40683 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40684 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40686 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40687 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40689 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40691 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40692 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40693 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40694 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40697 550 Relay not permitted
40699 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40700 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40701 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40702 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40705 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40706 -f himself@there.example
40708 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40709 mandatory arguments.
40711 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40712 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40713 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40717 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40718 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40719 .cindex "building DBM files"
40720 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40721 .cindex "lower casing"
40722 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40723 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40724 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40725 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40726 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40727 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40729 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40730 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40731 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40732 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40735 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40736 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40737 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40741 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40742 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40743 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40744 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40746 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40748 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40749 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40751 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40752 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40753 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40754 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40755 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40756 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40758 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40759 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40760 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40761 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40762 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40763 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40764 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40770 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40771 .cindex "retry" "times"
40772 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40773 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40774 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40775 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40776 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40777 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40778 output. For example:
40780 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40781 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40782 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40783 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40784 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40785 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40786 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40787 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40788 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40789 past final cutoff time
40791 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40792 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40793 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40794 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40795 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40796 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40799 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40800 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40801 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40802 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40803 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40804 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40808 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40809 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40810 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40811 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40812 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40813 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40814 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40817 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40819 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40822 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40824 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40826 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40828 &'misc'&: other hints data
40831 The &'misc'& database is used for
40834 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40835 &(smtp)& transport)
40837 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40840 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40842 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40847 .subsection "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40848 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40849 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40850 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40851 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40852 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40853 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40854 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40855 For example, to dump the retry database:
40857 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40859 For the retry database
40860 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40862 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40863 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40865 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40866 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40867 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40868 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40869 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40870 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40871 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40872 and a textual description of the error.
40874 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40875 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40876 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40879 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40880 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40881 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40882 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40883 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40884 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40889 .subsection "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40890 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40891 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40892 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40893 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40894 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40895 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40896 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40897 updated sufficiently often.
40899 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40900 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40901 the retry database:
40903 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40905 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40906 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40907 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40908 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40909 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40910 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40911 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40912 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40913 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40914 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40915 whenever it removes information from the database.
40917 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40918 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40919 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40920 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40921 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40923 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40924 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40925 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40926 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40927 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40928 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40929 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40932 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40933 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40938 .subsection "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40939 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40940 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40941 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40942 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40943 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40944 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40947 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40948 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40949 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40950 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40951 by new data, for example:
40955 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40956 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40957 used as optional separators.
40959 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40960 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40966 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40967 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40968 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40969 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40970 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40971 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40972 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40973 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40974 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40975 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40976 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40977 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40978 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40982 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40985 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40988 .vitem &%-interval%&
40989 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40990 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40992 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40993 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40996 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40999 Suppress verification output.
41001 .vitem &%-retries%&
41002 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
41003 the lock (default 10).
41005 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
41006 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
41007 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
41008 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
41011 .vitem &%-timeout%&
41012 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
41013 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
41014 default), a non-blocking call is used.
41017 Generate verbose output.
41020 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
41021 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
41022 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
41023 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
41024 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
41025 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
41026 more than 30 minutes old.
41028 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
41029 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
41030 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
41031 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
41032 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
41033 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
41035 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
41036 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
41037 suppresses all output except error messages.
41041 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
41043 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
41045 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
41046 <&'some commands'&>
41049 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
41050 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
41053 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
41054 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
41056 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
41057 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
41060 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
41061 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
41062 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
41063 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
41064 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
41066 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
41068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41071 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
41072 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
41073 .cindex "X-windows"
41074 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
41075 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
41076 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
41077 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
41078 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
41079 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
41080 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
41081 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
41085 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
41086 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
41087 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
41088 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
41089 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
41090 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
41091 parameters are for.
41093 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
41094 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
41095 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
41097 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
41099 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
41100 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
41101 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
41102 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
41103 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
41105 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
41106 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
41108 Eximon*background: gray94
41110 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
41111 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
41112 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
41113 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
41114 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
41115 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
41116 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
41119 Eximon*highlight: gray
41122 .cindex "admin user"
41123 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
41124 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
41126 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
41127 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
41128 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
41129 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
41130 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
41132 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
41133 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
41134 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
41135 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
41136 different parts of the display.
41141 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
41142 .cindex "stripchart"
41143 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
41144 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
41145 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
41146 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
41147 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
41148 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
41149 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
41150 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
41151 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
41153 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
41154 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
41155 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
41156 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
41158 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
41159 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
41160 to a single partition.
41162 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
41163 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
41164 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
41165 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
41166 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
41167 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
41168 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
41173 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
41174 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
41175 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
41176 .cindex "window size"
41177 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
41178 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
41179 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
41180 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
41181 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
41182 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
41184 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
41185 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
41186 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
41187 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
41189 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
41190 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
41191 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
41192 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
41193 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
41194 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41196 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
41197 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
41198 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41202 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
41203 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
41204 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
41205 the main log is maintained.
41206 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
41207 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
41208 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
41209 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
41210 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
41212 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
41213 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
41214 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
41215 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
41216 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
41217 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
41218 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
41219 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
41220 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
41221 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
41222 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41224 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
41225 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
41226 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
41227 It cannot go further back up the log.
41229 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
41230 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
41231 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
41232 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
41233 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
41234 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
41236 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
41237 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
41238 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
41239 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
41240 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
41241 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
41243 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
41244 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
41245 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
41246 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
41247 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
41248 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
41249 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
41250 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
41251 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
41256 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
41257 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
41258 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
41259 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
41260 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
41261 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
41262 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
41263 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
41264 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
41265 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
41267 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
41268 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
41269 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
41270 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
41271 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
41272 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
41273 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
41275 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
41276 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
41277 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
41278 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
41279 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
41280 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
41281 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
41283 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
41284 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
41285 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
41286 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
41288 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
41289 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
41290 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
41291 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
41292 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
41293 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
41294 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
41297 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
41298 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
41300 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
41301 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
41302 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
41303 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
41304 display is updated.
41308 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
41309 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
41310 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
41311 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
41312 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
41315 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
41316 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
41317 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
41318 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
41319 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
41321 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
41323 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
41327 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
41328 in a new text window.
41330 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
41331 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
41332 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
41334 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
41335 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
41336 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
41337 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
41339 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
41340 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
41341 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
41342 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
41343 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
41345 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
41346 that the message be frozen.
41348 .cindex "thawing messages"
41349 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
41350 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
41351 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
41352 that the message be thawed.
41354 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
41355 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
41356 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
41357 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
41359 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
41360 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
41363 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
41364 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41365 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41366 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41367 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
41368 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
41369 which case no action is taken.
41371 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
41372 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41373 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41374 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41375 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
41376 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
41377 case no action is taken.
41379 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
41380 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
41382 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
41383 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
41384 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
41385 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
41386 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
41387 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
41388 the address is qualified with that domain.
41391 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
41392 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
41393 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
41394 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
41395 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
41396 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
41397 if no output is generated.
41399 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
41400 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
41401 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
41402 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
41404 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
41405 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
41406 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
41413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41414 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41416 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
41417 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
41418 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
41419 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
41421 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
41422 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
41423 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
41424 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
41425 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
41426 its security as compared with other MTAs.
41428 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
41429 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
41430 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
41431 as soon as possible.
41434 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
41435 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
41436 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
41437 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
41438 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
41439 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
41442 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
41443 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
41444 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
41445 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
41446 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
41447 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
41449 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
41450 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
41451 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
41452 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
41455 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
41456 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
41457 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
41458 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
41459 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
41460 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
41461 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
41462 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
41463 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
41467 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
41468 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
41469 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
41470 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
41471 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
41472 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
41473 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
41475 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
41478 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
41479 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
41480 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
41481 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
41482 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
41487 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
41489 .cindex "root privilege"
41490 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
41491 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
41492 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
41493 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
41494 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
41495 is required for two things:
41498 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
41499 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
41502 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
41503 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
41507 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
41508 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
41509 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
41510 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
41511 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
41512 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
41513 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
41514 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
41516 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
41517 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
41518 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
41520 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
41521 uid and gid in the following cases:
41526 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
41527 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
41528 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
41529 the calling process.
41530 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
41531 option may not be used at all.
41532 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
41533 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
41534 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
41539 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
41540 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
41543 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
41544 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
41545 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
41546 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
41547 testing address verification
41550 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
41553 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
41554 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
41557 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
41560 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
41561 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
41562 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
41563 will be used during message reception.
41565 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
41566 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
41569 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution.,
41570 including while the recipient addresses in a message are being routed.
41573 However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41574 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41575 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41578 Any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
41579 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid.
41582 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox.
41584 For remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used.
41587 Once all the delivery
41588 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
41589 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
41590 generating bounce and warning messages.
41593 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41594 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41600 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41601 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41602 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41603 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41604 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41605 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41606 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41607 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41608 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41609 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41613 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41614 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41615 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41616 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41618 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41619 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41620 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41621 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41622 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41624 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41625 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41626 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41629 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41630 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41631 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41633 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41634 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41635 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41636 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41637 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41638 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41639 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41640 address this problem at this time.
41642 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41643 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41644 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41645 be used in the most straightforward way.
41647 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41648 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41651 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41652 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41653 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41654 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41655 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41657 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41658 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41660 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41661 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41662 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41663 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41665 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41666 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41669 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41670 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41671 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41673 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41674 owned by the Exim user.
41676 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41677 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41678 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41683 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41684 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41685 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41686 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41688 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41689 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41694 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41695 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41696 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41700 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41701 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41702 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41703 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41704 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41705 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41706 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41709 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41710 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41711 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41712 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41713 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41715 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41716 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41717 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41718 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41719 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41720 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41721 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41723 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41724 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41725 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41727 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41728 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41730 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41731 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41732 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41734 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41735 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41736 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41738 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41739 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41740 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41741 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41747 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41748 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41749 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41750 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41751 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41752 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41753 are some issues to be aware of:
41756 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41758 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41760 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41761 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41762 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41763 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41764 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41765 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41768 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41769 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41770 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41772 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41773 expected to yield one result.
41779 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41780 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41781 .cindex "IP source routing"
41782 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41783 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41784 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41785 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41789 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41790 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41791 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41796 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41797 .cindex "trusted users"
41798 .cindex "admin user"
41799 .cindex "privileged user"
41800 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41801 .cindex "user" "admin"
41802 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41803 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41804 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41805 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41806 permit a remote host to be specified.
41809 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41810 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41811 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41812 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41813 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41814 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41816 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41817 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41818 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41819 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41820 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41822 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41823 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41824 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41825 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41826 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41830 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41831 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41832 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41833 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41834 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41835 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41837 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41838 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41839 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41840 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41841 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41842 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41845 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41846 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41847 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41848 This affects most of the checking options,
41849 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41852 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41853 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41854 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41855 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41856 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41857 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41861 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41862 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41863 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41864 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41865 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41870 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41871 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41872 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41873 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41878 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41879 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41880 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41881 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41882 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41886 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41887 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41888 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41892 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41893 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41894 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41895 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41896 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41897 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41898 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41900 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41901 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41906 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41907 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41908 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41909 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41913 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41914 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41915 enough to hold the result.
41916 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41922 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41924 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41925 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41926 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41927 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41928 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41929 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41930 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41931 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41932 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41933 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41934 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41935 themselves are recoverable.
41937 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41938 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41939 and should not be used as such.
41941 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41942 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41943 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41946 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41947 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41948 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41949 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41950 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41952 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41953 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41954 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41955 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41957 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41959 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41962 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41964 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41965 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41966 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41967 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41968 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41969 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41970 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41971 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41974 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41975 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41976 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41977 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41979 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41980 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41981 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41982 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41983 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41984 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41985 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41986 normally the Exim user.
41988 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41989 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41990 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41991 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41992 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41993 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41994 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41995 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41997 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41998 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41999 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
42000 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
42002 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
42003 These contain variables, can appear in any
42004 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
42006 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
42007 the corresponding data is tainted.
42008 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
42010 The following word specifies a variable,
42011 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
42014 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
42015 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
42016 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
42017 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
42018 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
42019 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
42020 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
42021 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
42022 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
42025 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
42026 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
42027 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
42028 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
42029 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
42030 character. It may contain internal newlines.
42032 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
42033 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
42034 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
42035 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
42036 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
42037 character. It may contain internal newlines.
42039 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
42040 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
42041 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
42043 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
42044 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
42045 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
42046 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
42047 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
42049 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
42050 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
42051 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
42052 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
42053 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
42055 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
42056 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
42057 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
42059 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
42060 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
42061 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
42063 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
42064 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
42065 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
42067 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
42068 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
42069 present if the number is greater than zero.
42071 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
42072 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
42073 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
42075 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
42076 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
42077 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
42079 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
42080 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
42083 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
42084 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
42085 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
42088 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
42089 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
42090 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
42091 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
42093 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
42094 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
42095 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
42097 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
42098 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
42099 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
42100 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
42101 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
42102 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
42104 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
42105 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
42106 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
42107 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
42108 supplied by the remote host, if any.
42110 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
42111 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
42112 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
42113 generated messages.
42116 The message is from a local sender.
42118 .vitem &%-localerror%&
42119 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
42121 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
42122 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
42123 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
42124 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
42126 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
42127 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
42128 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
42131 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
42132 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
42135 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
42136 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
42137 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
42139 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
42140 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
42141 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
42143 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
42144 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
42145 of &$spam_score_int$&.
42147 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
42148 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
42149 rather than Unix-format.
42150 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
42151 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
42153 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
42154 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
42155 certificate was verified by the server.
42157 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
42158 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
42159 name of the cipher suite that was used.
42161 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
42162 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
42163 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
42167 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
42168 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
42169 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
42170 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
42171 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
42172 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
42173 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
42174 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
42175 addresses are complete.
42177 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
42178 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
42179 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
42180 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
42181 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
42182 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
42184 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
42185 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
42186 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42188 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
42189 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
42190 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
42191 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
42195 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42196 darcy@austen.fict.example
42198 alice@wonderland.fict.example
42200 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
42201 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
42202 line is of the following form:
42204 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
42205 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
42207 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
42208 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
42209 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
42210 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
42211 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
42212 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
42213 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
42214 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
42217 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
42218 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
42219 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
42220 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
42221 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
42225 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
42226 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
42227 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
42228 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
42229 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
42230 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
42231 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
42232 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
42233 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
42234 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
42237 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
42238 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
42239 typical set of headers:
42241 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
42242 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
42243 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
42244 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
42245 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
42246 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
42247 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
42248 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42249 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
42250 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42251 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
42253 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
42254 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
42255 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
42256 .ecindex IIDforspo1
42257 .ecindex IIDforspo2
42258 .ecindex IIDforspo3
42260 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
42261 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
42262 an ASCII newline character.
42263 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
42264 can have an alternate format.
42265 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
42266 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
42267 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
42268 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
42269 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
42270 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
42272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42275 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
42276 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
42278 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
42281 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
42282 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
42283 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
42284 DKIM is documented in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376).
42286 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
42287 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
42288 any original DKIM signature.
42290 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
42291 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42293 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
42295 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
42296 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
42297 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
42298 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
42299 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
42301 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
42302 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
42303 different signature contexts.
42306 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
42307 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
42308 Exim's standard controls.
42310 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
42311 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
42313 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
42314 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
42315 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
42316 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
42318 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
42319 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
42320 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
42321 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
42324 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
42325 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
42326 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
42327 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
42331 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
42332 .cindex DKIM signing
42334 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
42335 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
42336 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
42338 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42340 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42341 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42344 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
42345 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
42346 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
42347 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
42348 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
42350 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
42351 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
42353 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
42354 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
42355 After expansion, this can be a list.
42356 Each element in turn,
42358 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
42359 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
42360 while expanding the remaining signing options.
42361 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
42362 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42364 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
42365 This sets the key selector string.
42366 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
42367 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
42368 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
42369 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
42370 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
42371 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
42372 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42374 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
42375 this could be be used:
42377 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
42378 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
42381 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
42382 This sets the private key to use.
42383 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
42384 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
42385 The result can either
42387 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
42389 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42390 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
42392 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
42395 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
42396 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
42400 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
42402 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
42403 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
42405 The result file from the first command should be retained,
42406 permissions set so that Exim can read it,
42407 and this option set to use it.
42408 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
42409 for the DNS TXT record.
42410 See section 3.6 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42411 for the record specification.
42415 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
42416 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
42419 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42421 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42422 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42425 EC keys for DKIM are defined by
42426 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8463,RFC 8463).
42427 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
42428 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
42429 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
42430 for some transition period.
42431 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42434 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
42436 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
42437 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
42440 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
42442 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
42443 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
42446 Exim also supports an alternate format
42447 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
42448 of the standard, but not adopted.
42449 A future release will probably drop that support.
42451 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
42452 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
42454 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
42456 &`sha256`& &-- the default
42458 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
42461 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42463 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42466 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
42467 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
42468 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
42469 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
42470 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
42471 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
42473 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
42474 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
42475 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
42476 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
42477 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
42479 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
42480 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
42481 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
42482 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
42483 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
42486 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
42487 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
42488 list of header names.
42489 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
42490 in the message signature.
42491 When unspecified, the header names listed in
42492 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4871,RFC 4871) will be used,
42493 whether or not each header is present in the message.
42494 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
42495 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
42496 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
42498 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
42499 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
42500 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
42502 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
42503 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
42505 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
42506 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
42507 name will be appended.
42509 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
42510 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
42511 If not set, no such information will be included.
42512 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
42513 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
42514 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
42516 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42517 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
42520 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
42521 .cindex DKIM verification
42523 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
42524 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
42526 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
42527 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
42528 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
42529 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
42530 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
42532 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42533 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42534 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42536 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
42537 of this section can be ignored.
42539 The results of verification are made available to the
42540 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
42541 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
42542 By default, the ACL is called once for each
42543 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
42544 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
42545 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
42546 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
42548 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
42549 a large number of expansion variables
42550 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
42551 runtime of the ACL.
42553 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
42554 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
42555 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
42556 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
42558 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
42559 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
42560 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
42561 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
42562 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
42563 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
42566 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
42568 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
42569 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
42570 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
42572 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
42574 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
42575 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
42576 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
42578 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
42581 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
42582 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
42584 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
42585 (such as the From: header)
42586 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
42587 and for the domain part if identities.
42588 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
42590 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
42591 for each matching signature.
42594 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42595 available (from most to least important):
42599 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42600 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42601 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42602 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42604 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42605 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42606 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42607 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42608 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42609 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42611 Within the DKIM ACL,
42612 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42614 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42615 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42617 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42618 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42620 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42621 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42623 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42626 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42627 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42628 hash-method or key-size:
42630 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42631 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42632 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42633 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42634 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42635 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42636 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42639 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42640 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42641 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42643 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42644 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42646 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42647 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42649 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42650 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42651 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42653 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42654 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42655 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42656 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42659 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42661 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42662 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42663 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42664 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42666 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42667 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42668 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42669 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42671 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42672 The key record selector string.
42674 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42675 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42676 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42677 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42678 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42681 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42683 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42685 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42686 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42689 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42690 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42691 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42692 processing of such signatures.
42694 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42695 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42697 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42698 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42700 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42701 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42702 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42703 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42704 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42705 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42706 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42708 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42709 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42710 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42711 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42712 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42713 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42714 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42715 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42717 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42718 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42719 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42721 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42722 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42723 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42724 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42725 integer size comparisons against this value.
42726 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42728 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42729 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42731 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42732 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42734 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42735 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42737 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42738 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42741 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42742 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42745 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42746 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42748 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42749 Number of bits in the key.
42750 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42751 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42753 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42755 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42756 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42759 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42764 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42767 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42768 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42769 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42770 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42771 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42772 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42773 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42776 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42777 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42778 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42780 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42783 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42784 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42786 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42787 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42788 results against the actual result of verification,
42789 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42790 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42792 A basic verification might be:
42794 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42797 A more complex use could be
42798 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42801 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42802 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42803 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42804 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42807 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42808 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42809 for more information of what they mean.
42811 The condition is true if the status
42812 (or any of the list of status values)
42813 is any one of the supplied list.
42819 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42820 .cindex SPF verification
42822 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42823 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by
42824 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7208,RFC 7208).
42825 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42826 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42827 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42828 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42829 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42832 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42833 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42835 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42836 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42837 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42839 .cindex "dynamic modules"
42840 The support can be built as a dynamic-load module if desired;
42841 see the comments in that Makefile.
42844 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42845 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42847 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42848 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42849 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42850 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42853 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42854 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42855 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42856 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42857 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42861 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42864 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42865 domain in the envelope-from address.
42867 .vitem &%softfail%&
42868 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42872 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42875 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42876 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42877 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42879 .vitem &%permerror%&
42880 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42881 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42883 .vitem &%temperror%&
42884 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42885 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42888 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42891 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42892 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42893 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42894 short-circuit fashion.
42899 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42900 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42901 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42902 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42903 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42904 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42905 ip=$sender_host_address
42908 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42909 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42912 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42915 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42917 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42918 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42919 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42920 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42921 it for logging purposes.
42923 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42924 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42925 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42926 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42927 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42928 top of the header list, i.e. with
42930 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42932 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42934 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42935 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42937 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42938 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42939 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42940 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42941 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42943 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42944 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42945 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42946 and required in order to obtain a result.
42948 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42949 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42950 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42951 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42952 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42953 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42954 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42958 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42959 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42960 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42961 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42962 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42963 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42965 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42966 for a description of what it means.
42967 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42969 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42970 of the spf one. For example:
42973 deny spf_guess = fail
42974 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42977 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42978 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42979 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42982 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42983 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42985 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42986 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42987 &%spf_guess%& option.
42988 For example, the following:
42991 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42994 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42997 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42999 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
43000 address as the key and an IP address
43005 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
43008 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
43009 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
43015 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
43016 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
43017 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
43019 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
43020 SPF verification does not object to them.
43021 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
43022 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
43023 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
43024 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
43026 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
43027 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
43028 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
43029 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
43030 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
43033 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
43034 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
43035 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
43036 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
43039 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
43040 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43041 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
43043 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
43045 .cindex SRS excoding
43046 To encode an address use this expansion item:
43048 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
43049 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
43050 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
43051 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
43052 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
43053 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
43055 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
43056 encoding operation.
43057 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
43058 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
43059 it arrived at this system.
43060 All arguments are expanded before use.
43062 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
43066 .cindex SRS decoding
43067 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
43069 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
43070 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
43071 The second argument is the site secret.
43072 Both arguments are expanded before use.
43074 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
43076 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
43077 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
43079 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
43080 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
43081 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
43087 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
43093 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
43094 domains = ! +my_domains
43095 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
43096 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
43097 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
43102 domains = +my_domains
43103 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
43104 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
43105 data = $srs_recipient
43107 inbound_srs_failure:
43110 domains = +my_domains
43111 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
43112 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
43114 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
43116 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
43117 # and any that were not SRS'd
43120 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
43121 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
43122 remote_forwarded_smtp:
43124 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
43126 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
43127 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
43134 .section DMARC SECDMARC
43135 .cindex DMARC verification
43137 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
43138 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
43139 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
43140 should read and understand how it works by visiting the
43141 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/,DMARC website).
43143 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
43144 the libopendmarc library is used.
43146 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
43147 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/,sourceforge)
43148 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
43149 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
43150 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
43151 This description assumes
43152 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
43153 are in /usr/local/lib.
43155 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
43156 .cindex DMARC configuration
43158 There are three main-configuration options:
43159 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
43161 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
43162 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
43163 defines the location of a text file of valid
43164 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
43165 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
43166 the most current version can be downloaded
43167 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
43168 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
43169 The default for the option is unset.
43171 It is expanded before use.
43172 If not set (or empty after expansion), DMARC processing is disabled.
43176 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option
43177 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
43178 defines the location of a file to log results
43179 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
43180 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
43181 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
43182 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
43183 directory of this file is writable by the user
43185 The default for the option is unset.
43187 It is expanded before use.
43188 If not set (or empty after expansion), no history is written.
43191 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
43192 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
43193 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
43194 forensic report detailing alignment failures
43195 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
43196 and you have configured Exim to send them.
43197 If set, this is expanded and used for the
43198 From: header line; the address is extracted
43199 from it and used for the envelope from.
43200 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
43201 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
43204 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
43205 .cindex DMARC controls
43207 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
43208 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
43209 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
43210 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
43211 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
43212 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
43214 control = dmarc_disable_verify
43216 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
43217 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
43218 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
43219 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
43220 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
43221 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
43222 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
43223 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
43224 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
43225 construction might be inadequate.
43227 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
43229 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
43230 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
43231 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
43234 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
43237 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
43238 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
43240 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
43241 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
43242 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
43243 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
43244 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
43245 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
43246 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
43248 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
43249 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
43250 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
43251 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
43252 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43253 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
43254 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
43255 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
43256 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
43257 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
43258 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
43259 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
43260 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
43262 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
43263 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
43264 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
43265 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
43266 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
43267 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
43270 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
43271 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
43272 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
43274 Performing the check sets up information used by the
43275 &%authresults%& expansion item.
43277 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
43278 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
43279 expansion variables are available:
43282 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
43283 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
43284 .cindex DMARC result
43285 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
43286 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
43287 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
43288 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
43289 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
43291 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
43292 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
43293 Slightly longer, human readable status.
43295 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
43296 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
43297 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
43299 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
43300 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
43301 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
43302 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
43303 is any error, including no DMARC record.
43306 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_spf$&
43307 .vindex &$dmarc_alignment_spf$&
43308 The result of the SPF alignment portion of the test status;
43311 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$&
43312 .vindex &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$&
43313 The result of the DKIM alignment portion of the test status;
43318 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
43319 .cindex DMARC logging
43321 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
43322 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
43323 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
43324 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
43325 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
43326 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
43327 processing or failure delivery issues).
43329 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
43330 tools, you need to:
43332 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
43334 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
43335 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
43338 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
43340 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
43342 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
43343 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
43346 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
43347 .cindex DMARC example
43352 warn domains = +local_domains
43353 hosts = +local_hosts
43354 control = dmarc_disable_verify
43356 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
43357 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
43359 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
43360 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
43363 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
43365 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
43367 warn dmarc_status = !accept
43369 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
43371 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
43373 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
43374 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
43376 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
43377 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
43378 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
43380 deny dmarc_status = reject
43382 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
43384 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
43391 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43394 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
43396 .cindex "proxy support"
43397 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
43399 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
43400 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
43403 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
43404 .cindex proxy inbound
43405 .cindex proxy "server side"
43406 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
43407 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
43409 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
43410 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
43411 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
43414 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
43415 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
43417 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
43418 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
43419 to distribute load.
43420 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
43421 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
43422 There is no logging if a host passes or
43423 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
43424 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
43426 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
43427 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
43428 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
43429 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
43430 automatically determines which version is in use.
43432 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
43433 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
43434 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
43435 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
43436 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
43438 The following expansion variables are usable
43439 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
43441 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
43442 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
43443 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
43444 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
43445 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
43446 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
43448 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
43449 there was a protocol error.
43450 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
43451 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
43453 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
43454 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
43455 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
43456 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
43457 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
43458 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
43459 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
43460 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
43461 A possible solution is:
43463 # Set max number of connections per host
43465 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
43466 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
43468 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
43469 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
43474 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
43475 .cindex proxy outbound
43476 .cindex proxy "client side"
43477 .cindex proxy SOCKS
43478 .cindex SOCKS proxy
43479 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
43480 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by
43481 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1928,RFC 1928)).
43482 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
43485 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
43486 on an smtp transport.
43488 If unset (or empty after expansion) then proxying is not done.
43490 Otherwise, expansion should result in a list
43491 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
43492 Each proxy specifier is a list
43493 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
43494 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
43496 Each option is a string of form <name>=<value>.
43497 The list of options is in the following table:
43498 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
43499 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
43500 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
43501 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
43502 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
43503 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
43504 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
43505 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
43508 More details on each of these options follows:
43511 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
43512 .cindex proxy authentication
43513 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
43514 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per
43515 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1929,RFC 1929)
43516 for access to the proxy.
43517 Default is &"none"&.
43519 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
43522 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
43525 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
43528 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
43531 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
43532 higher values being tried first.
43533 The default priority is 1.
43535 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
43536 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
43537 weighted by this value.
43538 The default value for selection bias is 1.
43541 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
43542 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
43543 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
43545 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
43546 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
43547 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
43548 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
43550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43553 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
43554 "Internationalisation""
43555 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
43558 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
43560 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
43561 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
43562 Standards supported are RFCs
43563 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,2060),
43564 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5890.html,5890),
43565 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6530.html,6530) and
43566 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6533.html,6533).
43568 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
43569 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
43570 requirement, upon libidn2.
43572 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
43573 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
43574 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
43575 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
43576 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
43577 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
43578 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
43580 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
43581 international handling for the message is enabled and
43582 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
43584 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
43585 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
43586 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
43587 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
43589 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
43590 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
43591 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
43592 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
43594 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
43595 components expanded to a-label form,
43596 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
43599 .cindex log protocol
43600 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
43601 .cindex i18n logging
43602 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
43603 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
43605 The following expansion operators can be used:
43607 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
43608 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
43609 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
43610 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
43613 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
43614 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
43616 may use the following modifier:
43618 control = utf8_downconvert
43619 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
43621 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
43622 a-label form before smtp delivery.
43623 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
43624 but could be used for any message.
43626 If a value is appended it may be:
43627 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
43628 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43629 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43630 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43632 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43634 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43635 is initially set to -1.
43637 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43638 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43639 or an empty string.
43640 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43641 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43644 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43645 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43646 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43648 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43649 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43650 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43652 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43653 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43657 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43658 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43659 the following expansion operator can be used:
43661 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43664 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43665 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43666 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43668 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by
43669 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,RFC 2060),
43670 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43671 (which has to be a single character)
43672 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43673 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43675 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43676 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43678 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43679 by many other IMAP servers.
43683 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43684 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43685 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43688 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43689 must be representable in UTF-16.
43692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43695 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43699 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43700 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43701 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43702 processing actions.
43704 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43705 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43706 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43708 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43709 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43710 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43712 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43713 An example might look like:
43714 .cindex logging custom
43716 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43717 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43718 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43719 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43720 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43721 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43722 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43723 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43724 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43728 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43729 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43730 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43733 The current list of events is:
43734 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43735 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43736 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43737 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43738 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43739 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43740 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43741 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43742 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43743 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43744 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43745 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43746 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43747 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43748 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43749 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43750 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43751 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43752 .row smtp:fail:protocol after main "per connection"
43753 .row smtp:fail:syntax after main "per connection"
43756 New event types may be added in future.
43758 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43759 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43760 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43762 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43763 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43764 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43766 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43767 should define the event action.
43769 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43770 with the event type:
43772 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43773 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43774 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43775 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43776 .row msg:defer "error string"
43777 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43778 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43779 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43780 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43781 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43782 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43783 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43784 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43785 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43786 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43787 .row smtp:fail:protocol "error string"
43788 .row smtp:fail:syntax "error string"
43792 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43794 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43795 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43796 the course of its processing:
43798 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43801 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43802 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43804 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43805 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43807 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43808 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43809 following will be forced:
43810 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43811 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43812 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43813 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43814 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43816 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43817 no other use is made of it.
43819 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43820 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43821 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43823 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43824 chain element received on the connection.
43825 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43828 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43829 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43831 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43832 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43834 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43835 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43836 .cindex "adding drivers"
43837 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43838 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43839 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43840 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43843 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43844 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43846 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43848 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43850 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43851 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43852 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43854 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43856 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43859 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43860 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43862 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43863 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43864 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43865 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43866 simple form that most lookups have.
43868 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43869 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43870 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43872 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43873 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43875 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43878 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43879 as for other drivers and lookups.
43882 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43883 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43884 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43885 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43886 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43888 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43889 the interface that is expected.
43894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43897 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43898 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43899 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43900 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43902 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43907 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43908 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43912 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43913 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43914 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43917 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43918 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////